Beruflich Dokumente
Kultur Dokumente
CODE: 00ZARM277/A1E
DIGITAL MULTIFUNCTIONAL
SYSTEM
AR-M236/M276
MODEL
AR-M236/M276
AR-M237/M277
AR-M237/M277
CONTENTS
Parts marked with are important for maintaining the safety of the set. Be sure to replace these parts with
specified ones for maintaining the safety and performance of the set.
SHARP CORPORATION
CONTENTS
[1]
[2]
CONFIGURATION
1. Product Line and options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
A. Line of machines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
B. Line of options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
C. Combination of options list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
[3]
SPECIFICATIONS
1. Basic specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
2. Operation specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
A. Common operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
B. Copy mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
3. Engine specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
A. Operation and display section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
B. Paper feed, transport, paper exit section . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
C. Optical (Image scanning) section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
D. Scanner (exposure) section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
E. Image process section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
F. Fusing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
G. Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
4. Additional functions, copy functions, and expanded
functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
5. Safety and environmental protection standards . . . . . . . . . 3-4
6. Environment conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
7. IMC board functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
8. Sharp Printer Language with Compression (SPLC)
Printer function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
A. Basic specification. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
B. Printer driver specification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
C. Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
D. System outline. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
[4]
CONSUMABLE PARTS
1. List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
A. SEC/LAG/SECL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
B. SEEG/SUK/SCA/SCNZ/SEA/SEES/SEZ/SEIS/SEB/
SEN/SEF/SMEF/Russia/Special country . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
C. STCL/SRH/SRS/SRSSC/SBI/Agent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
2. Production number identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
3. Environment conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
A. Ambient conditions for transporting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
B. Ambient storage conditions (sealed) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
C. Operating ambient conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
4. Life (packed conditions). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
[5]
ADJUSTMENTS, SETTING
1. List of adjustment items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2. Copier adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
A. Process section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
B. Mechanism section. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
C. Image density (exposure) adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-1
6-1
6-2
6-2
6-3
6-4
6-4
6-5
6-5
7-1
7-1
7-1
7-2
7-9
[8]
SIMULATION
1. Outline and purpose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
2. Code-type simulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
A. Operating procedures and operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
B. How to change the simulation adjustment value set by the
touch panel in the adjustment value entry process . . . . 8-1
3. Simulation code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3
4. Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6
[9]
11-1
11-1
11-2
11-3
11-3
11-3
11-4
11-4
11-5
11-6
11-6
11-6
11-6
11-6
10) When replacing the lithium battery of the PWB, use a specified one
only.
If a battery of different specification is used, it may be broken,
causing breakdown or malfunction of the machine.
11) When carrying a unit with PWB or electronic parts installed to it, be
sure to put it in an anti-static-electricity bag.
It may cause a breakdown or malfunctions.
[2] CONFIGURATION
1. Product Line and options
A. Line of machines
Model name
AR-M277/M237 (For SEC/SECL)
Composition
Copier/Printer (SPLC) model
Model name
AR-M276/M236
Composition
Copier/Printer (SPLC) model
B. Line of options
AR-RP7
Reversing single pass feeder
AR-VR6
Platen cover (OC)
AR-D21
500-sheet paper feed unit
AR-D22
2X500-sheet paper feed unit
AR-TR3
Job separator tray kit
AR-FN5N
Finisher
AR-FX7
Facsimile expansion kit
AR-MM9
8MB FAX memory
AR-P17
Printer expansion kit
AR-PK1/N
PS3 expansion kit
AR-PF1
Bar code font kit
AR-PF2
Flash ROM kit
AR-NC5J
Print server card
AR-NS2
Network scanner expansion kit
AR-SM5
256MB expansion memory board
AR-SM6
512MB expansion memory board
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 CONFIGURATION 2 - 1
Section
Item
Note
AR-M237/M277 AR-M236/M276
AR-RP7
Standard
AR-VR6
AR-D21
500 x 1 (80g/m2)
AR-D22
500 x 2 (80g/m2)
AR-TR3
AR-FN5N
Staple cartridge
AR-SC1
For AR-FN5N
AR-FX7
AR-MM9
FAX system
AR-P17
AR-NC5J
AR-PF1
AR-PF2
AR-PK1/N
AR-SM5
AR-SM6
AR-NS2
For details of the options, refer to the Service Manual of each option.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 CONFIGURATION 2 - 2
[3] SPECIFICATIONS
1. Basic specifications
Copy magnification
ratio
Zoom width
Fixed magnification
mode
(1) Type
Machine Type
Desktop type
(3) Weight
AR-M276/M236 41.8 kg (including DV), 39.8 kg (excluding DV)
(92 lbs. (including DV), 87.7 lbs. (excluding DV))
AR-M277/M237 49.3 kg (including DV), 47.3 kg (excluding DV)
(108.6 lbs. (including DV), 104.2 lbs. (excluding DV))
Independent
magnification width
Frequency
Power switch
Copy magnification
ratio
Zoom width
Fixed magnification
mode
2. Operation specifications
A. Common operation
Magnification
precision
Under 23 sec.
Yes
About 10sec (Leaving the machine for 60 sec after opening the door,
standard condition, polygon stop.)
b. Copy speed
Mode
1 scan multi
(600 dpi)
copy
(1200 dpi)
B. Copy mode
Density
adjustment step
1 step
5 steps
5 steps
5 steps
5 steps
AR-M276/M277
27 cpm
13.5 cpm
AR-M236/M237
23 cpm
13.5 cpm
When A4/Letter
AR-M276/M277
600 dpi 1200 dpi
15
7.5
17
8.5
27
13.5
18
9
27
13.5
21
10.5
14
7.5
16
8
17
8.5
AR-M236/M237
600 dpi 1200 dpi
12
7.5
14
8.5
23
13.5
16
9
23
13.5
18
10.5
12
7.5
13
8
14
8.5
27
13.5
23
13.5
18
16
27
13.5
23
13.5
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SPECIFICATIONS 3 - 1
999 sheets
Paper kind
Special paper
Paper size
selection
Cassette
attachment/
detachment
Remarks
Error diffusion
Dither
10%
c. Zoom method
Main scanning
direction
Sub scanning direction
Yes
Paper weight
Paper Size
d. Resolution
Paper kind
Read
Main scanning direction
400 dpi
Write
Main scanning direction
Basic
Virtual
resolution
resolution
600 dpi
1200 dpi
Center
3.2 line/mm
3.6 line/mm
5.0 line/mm
5.0 line/mm
5.0 line/mm
Size detection
Guide display
When poor image quality is resulted by the use of OHP sheet, adjust
Position
Copy magnification
ratio
25% to 49%
50% to 69%
70% to 94%
95% to 105%
106% to 141%
142% to 400%
Corners
2.8 line/mm
3.2 line/mm
4.5 line/mm
4.5 line/mm
4.5 line/mm
e. Gradation
Read
Write
Area separation
256 gradations
2 gradations
3. Engine specifications
600 dpi
1200 dpi
Touch panel
Button switch system
Offset function
Stapling
a. Condition
In case of Optional function (printer, FAX) is set up as MFD.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SPECIFICATIONS 3 - 2
f. Separator system
by control of main machine
AB system
Inch system
AB system
Inch system
A3 to A6
11 x 17 to 8.5 x 5.5
A3 to A6
11 x 17 to 8.5 x 5.5
Xenon
Drive voltage
1.5 kV
i. Paper pass
(1) Resolution
j. Exit area/finishing
Upper exit tray (Job separator tray)
Lower exit tray (main machine exit tray)
Face down
Face down
600 dpi
600 dpi
(2) Gradation
k. Power supply
Power supply
Power consumption
l. Method of movement
with original motor (not with main machine)
m. Machine weight
0.6 kg
n. Exit capacity
Upper exit tray (Job separator)
Lower exit tray (main machine exit tray)
100 sheets
500 sheets ()
Yes
Yes
2 gradations
28,800 rpm
Mirror surfaces
6 faces
Laser power
0.4mW/600dpi, 0.2mW/1200dpi
785nm
Photo
conductor
Type
LIFE
75,000 sheets
Toner
Type
Developer (Black)
LIFE
System
p. Concept of function
Upper exit tray (Job separator)
Lower exit tray (main machine
exit tray)
Charge
Transfer
Voltage
System
Transfer roller
Voltage
Exposure
Xenon lamp
Developing
Separation
() DC scorotron
Discharge
(1) Type
Cleaning
Blade
Flat-bed type/monochrome
F. Fusing
Type
Lamp
(3) Resolution
Main scanning direction
400 dpi
(4) Gradation
256 gradations (8-bit)
Heat roller
Type
Halogen lamp
Voltage
100V
Power
consumption
1000W
Fusing temperature
Heat roller
Pressure roller
Separation system
G. Drive
Drive section
Main motor
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SPECIFICATIONS 3 - 3
Motor
DC brushless motor
AMS
Yes
Yes (Copy/Scan)
Rotation copy
Yes
E-sort
Yes
XY zoom
Yes
When the OC is used: Landscape/Portrait
25 400% (50 200% for 1200 dpi)
When the RSPF is used: Landscape/Portrait
50 200% (50 141% for 1200 dpi)
Built-in clock
Yes
1 page memory
1 set 2 copy
Binding margin
Yes
Default AB series: 0 20 mm (Unit of 1 mm)
Inch series: 0 1 inch (Unit of 1/8 inch)
Edge erase
Yes
Default AB series: 0 20 mm (Unit of 1 mm)
Inch series: 0 1 inch (Unit of 1/8 inch)
Yes
Default AB series: 0 20 mm (Unit of 1 mm)
Inch series: 0 1 inch (Unit of 1/8 inch)
Booklet copy
White/black reversion
Yes
Whole surface only (Can be inhibited with
the simulation.)
2 in 1/4 in 1
Yes
Sorter
Yes
Offset function (shifter or finisher) required
Preheating
Message display
Yes
Key operator
program
Yes
Printer status
monitor/Printer
administration utility
48MB
USA: EnergyStar
Canada: ECP, EnergyStar
Germany: Blue angel conformity
Europe: EnergyStar
North Europe: Nordic swan
Safety
acknowledgement
& EMI
USA: UL/FDA/FCC
Canada: cUL/FDA/FCC
Europe: CE/SEMKO/ITSGS
UK: CE/SEMKO/ITSGS
Australia: IEC60950 conformity/C-TICK
Taiwan: Taiwan EMI (Class B)/CNS conformity
Russia: GOST-R
Middle East, Africa: CE conformity/IEC60950
conformity/CISPR22 conformity
China: CCC
Others: ICube/NOM (Mexico)/FCC conformity/
CISPR22 conformity/IS112/IS961-6.1/2
Dust
On standby
Auditor support
Yes
Duplex
Yes (Standard)
Total counter
Yes
Toner save
Yes
Department
management
Job registration/call
Cover paper
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SPECIFICATIONS 3 - 4
6. Environment conditions
* Sort function
(Electronic sort)
Humidity (%)
* Group function
Rotation copy
2 in 1/4 in 1
Temperature (C)
Humidity (%)
Center erase
Binding edge
Compression memory
for electronic sort
* Memory read 600dpi
capacity
Temperature (C)
Humidity (%)
Note: The number of sheets for the columns marked with * is calculated supposing that the same quantity is assigned to the
ROPM memory and the copy expansion memory.
Temperature (C)
Resolution
Smoothing
Toner Save Mode
Input tray
20 to 25C
655%RH
Duplex print
Finisher
Printer driver
Manual (Online
manual)
Platform
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SPECIFICATIONS 3 - 5
Detail
15ppm: 600dpi (including transfer from PC)
27ppm: ROPM (AR-M277/M276)
23ppm: ROPM (AR-M237/M236)
600dpi
1200dpi x 600dpi
Standard
Multi Bypass tray
Tray 1, Tray 2, Tray 3, Tray 4
(Depending on conditions of the machine
and option installation.)
Standard
Option
Standard
Standard
IBM PC/AT (Include compatible machine)
Item
Support OS (Printer
Driver)
Detail
Windows 95/98/Me
Windows NT 4.0 Workstation (SP5 or later)
Windows 2000 Professional
Windows XP Home/Professional Edition
Watermark
Function
Watermark
User setting
Position
OS
Windows 95/98/Me
Windows NT 4.0 Workstation (SP5 or later)
Windows 2000 Professional
Windows XP Home/Professional Edition
Function
Copies
Orientation
Collate
Document Style
Paper Input
N-up printing
N-up Order
N-up Border
User Setting
Paper Size
Content
1-999
Portrait
Landscape
Collate
Uncollate
1-Sided, 2-Sided (Book),
2-Sided (Tablet)
2/4
Z
Yes/No
Yes
A3 / B4 / A4 / B5 / A5 / B6 /
A6 / Ledger (11x17) /
Legal (8.5 x 14) /
Foolscap (8.5 x 13) /
Letter (8.5 x 11) /
Invoice (5.5 x 8.5) / Folio /
Executive / COM-10 /
DL / C5 / 8K / 16K
1 size
Auto
Size
Angle
Gray Scale
Edit Font
On first page only
Configuration Input Trays
Setting
Output Tray Options
Others
2 Gradation print
* Default
Bypass (Auto)
Bypass (Manual)
Tray 1/2/3/4
Tray: Normal paper, letter
head paper, recycle paper,
colored paper
Bypass: Normal paper, letter
head paper, recycle paper,
colored paper, thick paper,
thin paper, label paper, OHP,
postcard, envelope
Transparency print
Yes / No
Paper Output Output Tray Selection Center Tray
Upper Tray
Paper Type
Graphic
Staple
Print Quality
Smoothing
Toner save
Photo Enhancement
Fit to Page
2 Gradation print
Image Adjustment
Content
(None) / TOP SECRET /
CONFIDENTIAL / DRAFT /
ORIGINAL / COPY
Add / Update / Delete
Center
X: 50
Y : 50
6 to 300
90
0 to 255
Yes
Yes / No
Two / Three / Four trays
None / Upper Tray / Staple
Finisher
Yes
Yes
Yes / No
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SPECIFICATIONS 3 - 6
Control
600dpi
(Fixed)
On*
Off
On
Off*
On
Off*
On
Off*
Content
Print quality is selected from
Normal*/Draft/Photo.
Smoothing function is ON.
Smoothing function is OFF.
Toner save function is ON.
Toner save function is OFF.
Photo enhancement function is ON.
Photo enhancement function is
OFF.
2-Gradation print function is ON.
2-Gradation print function is OFF.
Paper size
297 x 420 mm
210 x 297 mm
148 x 210 mm
105 x 148 mm
257 x 364 mm
182 x 257 mm
128 x 182 mm
11 x 17 inch
8.5 x 11 inch
8.5 x 14 inch
7.25 x 10.5 inch
8.3 x 13 inch
5.5 x 8.5 inch
8.5 x 13 inch
270 x 390 mm
195 x 270 mm
110 x 220 mm
162 x 229 mm
4.125 x 9.5 inch
W: 100 to 297 mm
L: 148 to 431.8 mm
Manual
tray
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Tray 1
Tray 2
Tray 3
Tray 4
Yes
Yes
Yes
N/A
Yes
Yes
N/A
Yes
Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
N/A
Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
Yes
Yes
N/A
Yes
Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
N/A
Yes
Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
N/A
Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
Yes
Yes
N/A
Yes
Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
N/A
Yes
Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
N/A
Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
Yes
Yes
N/A
Yes
Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
N/A
Yes
Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
N/A
Center
tray
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Yes
Transfer direction
Transfer direction
Paper
Size
A3
B4
A4
B5
A5
Ledger
Legal
Letter
Invoice
Foolscap
Folio
Executive
COM-10
C5
DL
Function
N/A
Staple
Fit page
Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
Yes
Yes
N/A
Yes
Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
N/A
Yes
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
7014
6070
4960
4298
3508
6600
5100
5100
3300
5100
4980
4350
2474
3826
2598
9920
8597
7014
6070
4960
10200
8400
6600
5100
7800
7800
6300
5700
5408
5196
6730
5786
4676
5770
3224
6300
4800
4800
3000
4800
4680
4050
2174
3542
2314
142
142
142
142
142
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
142
142
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
6814
5870
4760
4098
3308
6400
4900
4900
3100
4900
4780
4150
2274
3626
2398
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Print area
Logic paper size
HP/GL
picture frame
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SPECIFICATIONS 3 - 7
Logic paper
size
HP/GL
picture
frame
Paper
Size
A3
B4
A4
B5
A5
Ledger
Legal
Letter
Invoice
Foolscap
Folio
Executive
COM-10
C5
DL
9920
8597
7014
6070
4960
8400
8400
6600
5100
7800
7800
6300
5700
5408
5196
7014
6070
4960
4298
3508
5100
5100
5100
3300
5100
4980
4350
2474
3826
2598
9684
8361
6778
5830
4720
8160
8160
6360
2860
7560
7560
6060
3460
5172
4960
118
118
118
118
118
120
120
120
120
120
120
120
120
118
118
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
9720
8397
6814
5870
4760
8200
8200
6400
4900
7600
7600
6100
5500
5208
4996
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Origin
ABCDEFGHIJKLMN
12345
abc
Actual page
size
Print area
C. Interface
Interface
D. System outline
The GDI-PWB is provided with IEEE1284 I/F on the host side, and the
16-bit bi-directional data bus I/F and UART on the machine side.
Transfer of image data with the IMC-PWB is performed with this 16-bit
bi-directional data bus. Command status information with the engine is
processed with UART.
This unit is installed to the position of PCL-PWB on the conventional
AR-235/275.
JBIG compression data sent from the host are transferred to the IMC
PWB, where the data are extracted to be VIDEO data, and sent
through the MCU PWB to the LSU.
M-bus
Top margin
CCD
The set value is received from the digital copier, and data are made
according to the set value.
Left margin
Since the paper size sensor is not set, the digital copier cannot recognize the size and direction of paper which is actually inserted.
Therefore, the left margin is set according to the paper size specified in
the print data sent from the computer, and print process is performed.
If the computer does not specify the paper size, or in the case of the
custom size, the left margin is set according to the default paper size.
MCU
Print
Engine
Image
process
ASIC
CPU
IMC
CPU
Page memory
Extraction
JBIGLite
UART
Command status
JBIG
data
GDI
CPU
ASIC
Compressed
memory
: Data flow
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SPECIFICATIONS 3 - 8
IEEE1284
Header + JBIG data PC
10
10
10
1
1
1
2
1
4
1
4
2
2
1
1
1
1
2
10
10
1
Life
25K (10)
75K (10)
Model name
Remarks
AR-270MT Life setting by A4 (8.5"11") 6% document
MT=NT*10
AR-271MD MD=ND*10
75K
150K
AR-271DR
AR-272UH
300K
AR-272LH
150K
AR-272KA1
75K (10)
75K (10)
225K
AR-270MC
AR-270CB
AR-272DU
10 Staple cartridge
Staple cartridge
3 3000 staples
3
1
150K
1
100K
1
150K
AR-SC1
AR-272TX
AR-271IR
AR-272FU
The other maintenance parts than the above are supplied as service parts.
B. SEEG/SUK/SCA/SCNZ/SEA/SEES/SEZ/SEIS/SEB/SEN/SEF/SMEF/Russia/Special country
No.
Item
Content
1 Toner CA (black) w/IC Toner
Vinyl bag
2 Developer
Developer
(Developer; Net weight 500g)
3 Drum kit
Drum
4 Upper heat roller kit
Upper heat roller
Fusing gear
Upper heat roller bearing
Upper cleaning pad
Fusing separation pawl (upper)
5 Lower heat roller kit
Lower heat roller
Fusing separation pawl (lower)
Fusing busing (lower)
6 150K PM kit
Drum separation unit
Transfer roller unit
DV seal
DV side sheet N
DV side sheet N2
DV side mylar
7 MC unit
MC unit
8 Cleaner blade
Cleaner blade
9 Drum frame unit
Drum frame unit
10
10
10
1
1
1
2
1
4
1
4
2
2
1
1
1
1
2
10
10
1
Life
25K (10)
75K (10)
Model name
Remarks
AR-270LT Life setting by A4 (8.5"11") 6% document
LT=T*10
AR-271LD LD=DV*10
75K
150K
AR-271DM
AR-272UH
300K
AR-272LH
150K
AR-272KA
75K (10)
75K (10)
225K
AR-270MC
AR-270CB
AR-272DU
10 Staple cartridge
Staple cartridge
3 3000 staples
3
1
150K
AR-SC1
AR-272TX
The other maintenance parts than the above are supplied as service parts.
C. STCL/SRH/SRS/SRSSC/SBI/Agent
No.
Item
Content
Life
Model name
Remarks
10
10
25K (10)
AR-270CT
Developer
Developer
(Developer; Net weight 500g)
10
75K (10)
AR-271CD
CD=SD*10
Drum kit
Drum
75K
AR-271DR
1
1
2
1
4
150K
AR-272UH
1
4
2
300K
AR-272LH
150K PM kit
2
1
1
1
1
2
150K
AR-272KA
AR-270MC
MC unit
MC unit
10
75K (10)
Cleaner blade
Cleaner blade
10
75K (10)
AR-270CB
225K
AR-272DU
Staple cartridge
3 3000 staples
3
AR-SC1
The other maintenance parts than the above are supplied as service parts.
3. Environment conditions
<TD cartridge>
Serial number
(0001-9999)
September
October
November
December
Destination
Unit version
Production
month
1
January
9
0
X
Y
Humidity (%)
Temperature (C)
Humidity (%)
Label position
<Drum>
The laser print indicates the date (year, month, day) of production.
Temperature (C)
Humidity (%)
Use environment
conditions
Temperature (C)
1. Installation
A. Environment
The performance of this machine is affected by the environment of the
installing site. Avoid installation to the following places:
Avoid installation in direct sunlight, otherwise the plastic parts may
be deformed.
Be sure to have enough space around the machine.
Be sure to allow the required space around the machine for servicing
and proper ventilation.
12" (30cm)
12"
(30cm)
12"
(30cm)
Avoid installation in a place of high temperature, high humidity, low
temperature or low humidity, otherwise paper may be dampened
and frost may be generated in the machine to cause a paper jam
and dirty copy.
B. Power source
Be sure to use only the power outlet (with the earth terminal) of 15A
or more and 100V.
Install the machine near the power outlet to facilitate disconnection
of the power plug.
Earth terminal
Avoid installation to a place of poor ventilation.
C. Transport
When transporting the machine, use manpower of two persons to
hold the grips on the both sides of the machine with both hands.
D. Other precautions
If the machine produces smoke or bad smell, stop the operation of
the machine.
When the exclusive table (option) is used, be sure to use the adjusters (4 pcs.) on the floor.
When it is required to move the machine for rearrangement of the
office, etc., release the adjuster locks and move the machine.
Adjuster
Do not use flammable spray near the machine.
Lock
Release
Fusing section
When it thunders, turn off the power and disconnect the power plug
from the power outlet to prevent against an electric shock or a fire
caused by lighting damage.
If a piece of metal or water enters the machine, turn off the power
and disconnect the power plug from the power outlet.
Do not touch the power plug with a wet hand.
When the machine is not used for a long time, disconnect the power
plug from the power outlet for safety.
When transporting the machine, turn off the power and disconnect
the power plug from the power outlet. (Remove the earth wire after
disconnecting the power plug from the power outlet.)
Be careful not to pinch your fingers when closing the front cover or
the side cover and setting the paper feed tray to supply paper or process a paper jam.
2) Hold the paper pressure plate and turn the fixing pin in the arrow
direction.
3) Store the removed fixing pin and the fixing screw which was
removed in the above procedure, together in the specified storage
place in the tray.
MG roller
Shake the developer bag enough before opening it.
Check that the DV seal is free from developer. If developer is
attached to the DV seal, clean and remove it.
5) Attach the developer tank to the developer cartridge.
Fixing pin
Fixing screw
If power is turned don without removing the fixing pin, it will be difficult to pull out the tray.
Shutter
1) Hold the both sides of the front cover, and pull down to open it.
Tape
When holding the toner cartridge, do not touch the shutter section,
but hold the grips. Do not remove the tape before shaking the cartridge.
2) Loosen the blue screw and pull out the developing cartridge.
2) Press the lock release lever, and insert the unit completely into the
copier along the guide groove. Then fix the blue screw and the
locking screw.
3) Remove the tape from the shutter, and remove the shutter from the
toner cartridge.
Dispose the removed shutter.
PLAIN / 8 x 11
TRAY 2
PLAIN / 8 x 14
TRAY 3
PLAIN / 11x17
5) Select the size and type of paper that is loaded in the tray.
SIZE
PLAIN
LETTER HEAD
11x17
8x14
8x13
RECYCLED
COLOR
8x11
8x11R
5x8
B5 size paper cannot be set to the second tray. (B5R size paper
can be set.)
A. Trays 1 4
LINE
DATA
B STATUS
CUSTOM SETTINGS
LINE
DATA
CUSTOM SETTINGS
TOT L COUNT
CONTRA
ADDRES
CONTRO
TRAY SETTINGS
KEYBOARD
SELECT
KEY
CONTRA
KEYBOARD
SELECT
INCH
When the tray paper size is changed, set the tray paper size in the following procedure.
B STATUS
AB
ADDRES
CONTRO
TYPE / SIZE
TRAY 4
PLAIN / 11x17
BYPASS
TRAY
PLAIN
KEY
2) Cut and remove the cut-out portion from the left rear cabinet.
Cut and remove the cut-out portion from the left rear cabinet using
a tool such as nippers. (Be careful about the direction of the tool so
that the cut surface is flat.)
LETTER HEAD
ENVELOPE
RECYCLED
COLOR
LABELS
HEAVY PAPER
THIN PAPER
TRANSPARENCY
JAPANESE P/C
Cut-out portion
8. Installation of options
A. AR-P17
(1) Parts included
3) Attach the PCL PWB unit.
CD-ROM: 1 pc.
Operation manual
Installation caution
sheet
M3 screws with
spring washer
M3 screws: 3 pcs.
(For installation of
the parallel and the
USB connectors)
M3 screws with
spring washer: 6 pcs.
(For installation of the
PCL PWB)
Support
post
M3 screw
M3 screws
PCL PWB
M3 screws with
spring washer
4) Attach the shielding plate.
Attach the shielding plate using five screws.
Screws
Screws
Screws
Screws
Insert the power plug of the copier to the outlet and turn on the
main switch. Then, carry out the following procedure.
5) Check for the PCL PWB.
Press the PRINT key on the operation panel to check to see if the
copier enters the print mode.
6) Check for the language.
APPLICATION
NUMBER
MACHINE
SERIAL
NUMBER
PRODUCT
KEY
C. AR-PF1/PF2
(1) Parts included
AR-PF1
CD-ROM: 1 pc.
Operation manual
Installation caution sheet
Memory module
(S.O.DIMM)
Bar code board: 1 pc.
AR-PF2
B. AR-PK1
(1) Parts included
Operation manual
Installation caution sheet
CD-ROM: 1*
License agreement
Installation caution sheet
*NOTE: Do not use the CD-ROM packed in AR-PK1, but use the CDROM packed together with the AR-P17 for setting the PS
driver.
(2) Installation
Turn off the main switch of the copier and then remove the power
plug of the copier from the outlet.
Remove five screws and remove the shielding plate.
Screws
If it is not operating normally, follow the AR-P17 Installation Manual to check and modify the system configuration settings and
check the operation.
2) Enable the PS3.
To enable the system configuration, use the keys on the main unit
to set the mode.
Enter the product key with the key operator program. (Refer to the
Operation Manual of Key Operator Program.)
Screws
D. AR-NC5J
(1) Connection to a network
7
5 6
3 4
1 2
Hub
1) Check that the printer power is off, and connect the shield-type,
twisted-pair cable to the 10/100BASE connector of the AR-NC5J.
Screws (silver)
M3 x 8: 2 pcs.
Spacers:
2 pcs. (only the one is
used)
CD-ROM: 1 pc.
Operation manual
Installation caution
sheet
Screws
Font
No.
Code128TT-Regular
15
Code128-NarrowTT-Regular
16
Code128-WideTT-Regular
17
Code39HalfInch-Regular
18
Code39OneInch-Regular
19
Code39QuarterInch-Regular
20
Code39SmallHigh-Regular
21
Code39Slim-Regular
22
Code39SmallLow-Regular
23
Code39SmallMedium-Regular 24
Code39Wide-Regular
25
Codabar-Regular
26
Interleaved2of5-Regular
27
Interleaved2of5-Thin-Regular
28
Font name
Font name
OCR-A
OCR-B
OCR-B-C39-Regular
Upc-Half
Upc-Half-Bars
Upc-HalfMusic
Upc-HalfNarrow
Upc-HalfThin
Upc-Tall-Regular
Upc-TallBarsThin-regular
Upc-TallMusicThin-Regular
Upc-TallNarrow-Regular
Upc-TallThin-regular
ZipCodeBarcode-Regular
Screws
Screws
2) Cut and remove the cut-out portion from the left rear cabinet.
Cut and remove the cut-out portion from the left rear cabinet using
a tool such as nippers. (Be careful about the direction of the tool so
that the cut surface is flat.)
LAN cable
Cut-out portion
Insert the power plug of the copier to the outlet and turn on the
main switch. Then, carry out the following procedure.
6) Check for the print server card.
Use the keys on the operation panel to print a configuration page.
E. AR-NS2
(1) Packed items
Silver screws
(M3 x 8)
This network scanner kit includes the following items in the package.
CD-ROM (Network Scanner Tool and Sharpdesk, Installer, Sharp
TWAIN driver, etc.)
Installation caution sheet and Operation Manual (License numbers
of 10 user clients of Sharpdesk are specified.)
Screws
Screws
F. AR-SM5/SM6
Turn off the main switch of the copier and then remove the power
plug of the copier from the outlet.
AR-SM5
AR-SM6
Screws
Screws
CN2
Memory module
(S.O.DIMM)
CN1
Screws
Screws
7
8
17
9
5
6
13
12
19
10
20
14
11
15
18
21
22
16
No.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Name
Platen cover (optional)
Document feeder tray
Original guides
Document feeder cover
Reversing tray
Exit area
Document transport cover
Document transport cover knob
Document glass
Power switch
Handles
Operation panel
Job separator tray (optional)
Function/Operation
Presses a document.
Place the original(s) that you wish to scan face up here.
Adjust to the size of the originals.
Open to remove misfed originals.
Pull out to remove misfed originals.
Originals exit the machine here after copying.
Open to remove misfed originals.
Pull to open the document transport cover.
Place an original that you wish to scan face down here.
Press to turn the machine power on and off.
Use to move the machine.
Contains operation keys and the touch panel.
Print jobs and received faxes are delivered to this tray.
14
15
16
17
Center tray
Front cover
Paper trays
Upper right side cover
18
19
20
21
Side cover
Side cover handle
Bypass tray paper guides
Bypass tray
22
Note
Optional (AR-M236/M276)
When the reversing single
pass feeder installed. (ARM237/M277: Standard)
B. Internal structure
4
5
No.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Name
Toner cartridge lock release lever
Toner cartridge
Roller rotating knob
Photoconductive drum
Fusing unit release levers
Fusing unit paper guide
Function/Operation
Use to unlock the toner cartridge.
Contains toner.
Turn to remove misfed paper.
Copy images are formed on the photoconductive drum.
To remove a paper misfeed in the fusing unit, push up on these levers and remove the paper.
Open to remove misfed paper.
C. Operation panel
COPY
PRINT
ON LINE
DATA
SCAN
DATA
FAX
LINE
DATA
JOB STATUS
CUSTOM SETTINGS
ACC.#-C
1
No.
1
Name
Touch panel
Function/Operation
The machine status, messages and touch keys are displayed on the panel. The
display will show the status of printing, copying or network scanning according
to the mode that is selected.
Use to change modes and the corresponding display on the touch panel.
Press to select copy mode.
[PRINT] key: Press to select print mode.
ONLINE indicator: Print jobs can be received when this indicator is lit.
DATA indicator: A print job is in memory. The indicator lights steadily while
the job is held in memory, and blinks while the job is printed.
[SCAN] key: Press to select network scan mode when the network scanner
option is installed.
DATA indicator: Lights steadily or blinks while a scanned image is being sent.
[FAX] key: Press to select fax mode when the fax function is installed.
LINE indicator: This lights up while faxes are being sent or received.
DATA indicator: Blinks when a fax has been received to memory and lights
steadily when a fax is waiting in memory for transmission.
Press to display the current job status.
10 11
Note
No.
4
Name
[CUSTOM SETTINGS] key
5
6
Numeric keys
[ACC.#-C] key
[#/P] key
8
9
[CLEAR] key
[START] key
10
11
[INTERRUPT] key
[CLEAR ALL] key
Function/Operation
Use to adjust various settings of the machine including the contrast of the touch
panel and key operator programs.
Use to enter numeric values for various settings.
When auditing mode is enabled, press this key after finishing a job to return the
machine to account number entry standby.
Use this key to execute a job program in copy mode. The key is also used to
dial in fax mode.
Press to clear a copy number setting or cancel a job.
Press in copy mode, scanner mode, or fax mode to begin copying, network
scanning, or faxing.
Use to perform an interrupt copy job.
Resets the settings to the initial settings.
Note
JOB QUEUE
SETS / PROGRESS
JOB QUEUE
STATUS
COPY
003 / 000
PAPER EMPTY*1
SHARP001
003 / 000
WAITING
0666211221
010 / 000
WAITING
1/1
COMPLETE
DETAIL
PRIORITY
STOP/DELETE
PRINT JOB
3
No.
1
Name
Job list
3
4
5
6
7
[PRIORITY] key
[DETAIL] key
E-MAIL/FTP
FAX JOB
Function/Operation
Shows stored jobs and the job currently being executed. Touch one
of keys 3 to 5 in the above illustration to select the type of job. The
icon next to each job name indicates the mode of the job as follows:
Copy mode
Printer mode
Network scanner mode
Fax mode (Send jobs)
Fax mode (Receive jobs)
The jobs in the job list appear in the form of keys. To give priority to a
job or pause or delete a job, touch the key of the job and then use the
key described in 7 or 8.
Use to select the job list mode: "JOB QUEUE" (Stored/currently
executing jobs) or "COMPLETE" (Finished jobs).
"JOB QUEUE": Shows jobs that have been stored and the job that is
currently being executed.
"COMPLETE": Shows the jobs that have been finished. Note that
copy jobs do not appear in this list (print job only).
Use to view the list of output jobs for all modes (print, copy, and fax).
Displays a network scanner job.
This displays stored fax jobs and the fax job currently being executed.
Use to change the page of the displayed job list.
Use to pause or delete a job currently being executed, or to delete a
stored job. Copy jobs and received faxes cannot be paused or
deleted with this key. Copy jobs can be canceled by pressing the
[CLEAR] key or [CLEAR ALL] key.
Select a reserved job in the [Reserve/Execution] job list and touch
this key, and the selected job will be executed by interrupting the
current execution of the other job.
Shows information on the selected job. This cannot be used for a
received fax and copy.
Note
* 1 :"PAPER EMPTY" in the job status
display
"PAPER EMPTY" in the job status display
indicates that the machine is out of the
specified size of paper. Add the specified
size of paper. If the specified size of paper
is not available and you are in printer mode,
another size of paper can be loaded in the
bypass tray to allow printing to take place.
F. Sensor
1
2
30
2
3
6
7
29
19
6
7
8
9
20
10
10
11
12
27
26
25
18
17
23
22
Name
Mirror motor
Code
MIRM
SFTM
OGS
Shifter motor
Paper exit gate
switching solenoid
Duplex motor
DUP-2 motor
Cooling fan
7
8
9
10
Main motor
PS clutch
Paper feed clutch
Manual paper feed
solenoid
Paper feed transfer
clutch
2nd cassette paper
feed clutch
Cassette lift-up motor
Cassette lift-up motor
2nd cassette paper
feed solenoid
Paper feed solenoid
2
3
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
24
16
15
No.
1
13
14
15
28
11
DPXM
VFM
MM
RRC
CPFS1
MPFS
TRC2
14 13 12
Function and operation
Optical mirror base
drive
Shifter drive
Paper exit gate
switcher
Duplex paper switching
and exit motor
Reverse pass for paper
transport
Cools the inside of the
unit.
Main drive
Main unit paper feed
Paper feed roller drive
Manual paper feed
solenoid
Paper feed transfer
clutch
Name
Code
MHPS
OCSW
POD2
TOPF
6
7
8
10
11
Thermostat
12
CPFC1
19
Toner motor
Separation pawl
solenoid
Exhaust fan motor
TM
PSPS
DCFM
20
DCFM2
20
No.
CPFS2
LUM1
LUM2
CPFC2
21
13
14
15
16
17
DSIN3
DSWR0
POD1
SFTHP
PPD2
CD1
PPD1L
MPLS2
MPLS1
MPLD1
MPLD2
19
31 18
17 16
Function and
operation
Mirror (scanner) home
position detection
Document cover
open/close detection
Document size
detection (Inch series:
PD3, 4) (AB series:
PD4, 5)
2nd paper exit
detection
2nd paper exit section
full detection
Right cabinet door
open/close detection
1st paper exit
detection
Shifter home position
sensor detection
Paper exit detection
Fusing temperature
detection
Abnormal high
temperature detection
in the fusing section
1st cassette (paper
tray) empty detection
Sensor of paper entry
from the manual
paper feed tray, the
2nd/multi-stage desk,
or the DUP
Manual feed tray
position detection
Manual feed tray
position detection
Manual feed paper
length detection
Manual feed paper
length detection
No.
18
Name
19
DSWR1
20
DSWR2
21
PFD2
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
Function and
operation
Manual feed paper
empty detection
Front door and side
door open/close
detection
Side door open/close
detection
2nd cassette paper
pass
2nd cassette paper
upper limit detection
Code
MPED
LUD2
PED2
LUD1
PED1
LOEMP
DUP2
Name
High voltage PWB
KEY PWB
OPU PWB
H. Section
1
PSSW
DSIN0
Reverse pass
detection
G. PWB unit
6
23
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
16
17
18
19
22
No.
1
2
Name
Copy lamp
Copy lamp unit
LSU unit
Lens unit
MC holder unit
6
7
8
10
11
12
13
Drum unit
DUP transport follower
roller
DUP transport roller
Transport roller
14
Resist roller
15
16
17
1
2
3
11
4
10
5
9
8
7
18
No.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Name
Inverter PWB
CCD PWB
Option connector PWB
IMC PWB
MCU PWB
Mother board
7
8
PPD1H
No.
9
10
11
19
20
21
22
23
15
21 20
Section
Process section
Mechanism section
Adjustment item
Developing doctor gap adjustment
MG roller main pole position adjustment
Developing bias voltage adjustment
Grid bias voltage adjustment (High mode)
Grid bias voltage adjustment (Low mode)
Print start position adjustment
SPF (RSPF) image lead edge position adjustment
Rear edge void adjustment
Paper off center adjustment
Left edge void area adjustment
Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion
balance adjustment
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
(10)
(11)
(12)
Image density
(exposure) adjustment
(15)
SIM53-8
(1)
Copy mode
SIM46-2
(13)
(14)
2. Copier adjustment
SIM41-2, 41-4
SIM63-7
A. Process section
3) Hold the string and bring the needle close to the MG roller horizontally. (Do not use paper clip, which is too heavy to make a correct
adjustment.) (Put the developing unit horizontally for this adjustment.)
4) Do not bring the needle into contact with the MG roller, but bring it
to a position 2 or 3mm apart from the MG roller. Mark the point on
the MG roller which is on the extension line from the needle tip.
20mm
5) Measure the distance from the marking position to the top of the
doctor plate of the developing unit to insure that it is 18mm.
10mm
10mm
R
20mm
DG:1.5 -+0.1
0.15
If the distance is not within the specified range, loosen the fixing
screw A of the main pole adjustment plate, and move the adjustment plate in the arrow direction to adjust.
C
DG:1.55 -+0.15
0.2
F
DG:1.5 -+0.1
0.15
1.55 +0.15mm
-0.2mm
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 ADJUSTMENTS 7 - 1
SIMULATION 8-1
SIMULATION 8-3
START.
1: AE
1: AE
400
400
2: TEXT
2: TEXT
450
1/1
3: TEXT/PHOTO
3: TEXT/PHOTO
450
4: PHOTO
4: PHOTO
450
5: SUPER/PHOTO
5: SUPER/PHOTO
400
6: TONER SAVE
6: TONER SAVE
376
3
1/1
SIMULATION 8-1
SIMULATION 8-3
400
Output is made with the entered value, and the display returns to
the original state.
<Adjustment specification>
<Adjustment specification>
Item
1
2
3
4
5
6
Content
AE
TEXT
TEXT/PHOTO
PHOTO
SUPER/PHOTO
TONER SAVE
AE
Character
Character/Photo
Photo
Super photo
Toner save
Installation
range
200-550
Item
Default
400 (400V)
450 (450V)
450 (450V)
450 (450V)
400 (400V)
376 (376V)
1
2
3
4
5
6
Content
AE
TEXT
TEXT/PHOTO
PHOTO
SUPER/PHOTO
TONER SAVE
AE
Character
Character/Photo
Photo
Super photo
Toner save
Setting
range
1-8
Default
3 (400V)
5 (450V)
5 (450V)
5 (450V)
3 (400V)
2 (375V)
B. Mechanism section
SIMULATION 8-2
MHV(H) COPY SETTING. INPUT VALUE 1-8, AND PRESS START.
1: AE
2: TEXT
3
1/1
3: TEXT/PHOTO
4: PHOTO
5: SUPER/PHOTO
START.
6: TONER SAVE
1: TRAY1
53
53
2: OPTION
53
1/1
3: MANUAL
53
4: DUPLEX
53
SIMULATION 50-5
SIMULATION 8-2
MHV(H) COPY SETTING. EXECUTING...
5:SUPER PHOTO
Press the
[START] key.
Press the
[P] key.
READY TO COPY
Press the
[START] key.
Output is made with the entered value for 30sec, and the display
returns to the original state.
<Adjustment specification>
1
2
3
4
5
6
AE
TEXT
TEXT/PHOTO
PHOTO
SUPER/PHOTO
TONER SAVE
Content
AE
Character
Character/Photo
Photo
Super photo
Toner save
50
1: TRAY1
Item
Press the
[CUSTOM SETTINGS]
key.
Setting
range
1-8
Default
3 (530V)
5 (580V)
5 (580V)
5 (580V)
3 (530V)
2 (505V)
COPIES IN PROGRESS.
50
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 ADJUSTMENTS 7 - 2
Note: Since the printed copy is used as a test chart, put the scale in
paralleled with the edge lines.
Item
TRAY1
OPTION
MANUAL
DUPLEX
Content
1st cassette
Option cassette
Manual feed
Back print
Setting range
0-99
1-99
Default
53
6) Measure the distance H between the paper lead edge and the
image print start position. Set the image print start position set
value again.
1 step of the set value corresponds to about 0.127mm shift.
Calculate the set value from the formula below.
99 H/0.127 (mm) = Image print start position set value <H:
Print start position measurement value (mm)>
0mm
0mm
5
5) Set the SPF (RSPF) lead edge position set value so that the same
image is obtained as that obtained in the previous OC image lead
edge position adjustment.
<Adjustment specification>
Adjustment
mode
SPF
(RSPF)
image lead
edge
position
SIM
Set value
Spec value
50-6
1 step:
0.127mm
shift
Setting
range
1 99
10
A4 (8.5" x 11")
Fit the print edge with the paper edge, and perform the lead
edge adjustment.
Example:99 5/0.127 = 99 39.4 = about 59
Note: FIf the set value is not obtained from the above formula, perform the fine adjustment.
7) Execute SIM 50-1-2 to adjust the main cassette lead edge void.
1 step of the set value corresponds to about 0.127mm shift.
Calculate the set value from the formula below.
B/0.127 (mm) = Lead edge void adjustment value <B: Lead edge
void (mm)>
2.5mm
Scale image
2.5mm
Paper rear edge
10
4) Execute SIM 50-1 and set the density mode to DEN-B. The currently set adjustment value is displayed.
Example: When setting the lead edge void to 2.5mm:
2.5 /0.127 = about 20
<Adjustment specification>
Adjustment
mode
Main cassette
lead edge void
Print start
position
SIM
50-12
50-5
<Adjustment specification>
Set value
B/0.127
99 H/0.127
Spec value
Lead edge void:
1 4mm
Image loss: 3mm
or less
Setting
range
1 99
Adjustment
mode
Rear edge
void
SIM
50-1-6
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 ADJUSTMENTS 7 - 3
Set value
1 step: 0.127mm
shift
Spec
value
4mm or
less
Setting
range
1 99
SIMULATION 50-10
SIMULATION 50-1
PRESS START.
1: RRC-A
43
2: DEN-A
18
1: BYPASS
50
50
3: DEN-A -MANUAL
18
4: DEN-A -OPTION
18
2: TRAY1
50
1/1
5: DEN-A -DUPLEX
18
6: DEN-B
3: TRAY2
50
7: DEN-B-DUP
50
8: SIDE VOID
18
4: TRAY3
50
9: SIDE VOID-DUP
18
10: LOSS(OC)
5: TRAY4
50
6: DUPLEX
50
Press the
[START] key.
Press the
[P] key.
43
1/1
OK
OK
Press the
[START] key.
Press the
[CUSTOM SETTINGS]
key.
READY TO COPY
Press the
[P] key.
Press the
[CUSTOM SETTINGS]
key.
READY TO COPY
50
43
1: RRC-A
1: BYPASS
Press the
[START] key.
COPIES IN PROGRESS.
Press the
[START] key.
COPIES IN PROGRESS.
50
43
1: RRC-A
1: BYPASS
2) Note down the adjustment value of SIM 50-5 (Items 1, 2, 3, 4), and
change the value to 99.
4) Place a chart with a clear lead edge (or a ruler) on the OC document table.
5) Use SIM 50-1 (Item 1) to execute test print. Check the print out and
adjust so that the lead edge image is printed. (1 99: About
0.127mm/Step)
1
2
3
4
5
6
Item
BYPASS
TRAY1
TRAY2
TRAY3
TRAY4
DUPLEX
Content
Manual feed
1st cassette
2nd cassette
3rd cassette
4th cassette
Back print
Setting range
1-99
Default
50
7) Adjust SIM 50-1 (Items 2, 3, 4, 5) so that the lead edge void on the
print out is the specified value. (1 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
8) Similar to procedure 7, adjust SIM 50-1 (Item 6, 7) so that the rear
edge void is the specified value. (1 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
<Adjustment specification>
Adjustment
mode
Paper off
center
Second
print surface
off-center
SIM
50-10
-2
50-10
-6
Set value
Add 1: 0.127mm
shift to R side.
Reduce 1:
0.127mm shift to L
side.
Spec value
Single:
Center
2.0mm
Duplex:
Center
2.5mm
Setting
range
1 99
2
3
4
5
RRC-A
Content
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 ADJUSTMENTS 7 - 4
Setting
Default
range
1-99
43
1-99
18
1-99
18
1-99
18
1-99
18
1-99
30
Item
Content
DEN-B-DUP
Setting
Default
range
1-99
50
1-99
18
1-99
18
1-5
<Adjustment specification>
Adjustment
mode
Left edge void
SIM
50-18
Set value
1 step: 0.127mm
shift
Spec
value
0.5 4mm
Setting
range
1 99
4) Loosen the set screw of the scanner drive pulley which is not in
contact with No. 2/3 mirror base unit positioning plate.
5) Without moving the scanner drive pulley shaft, manually turn the
scanner drive pulley until the positioning plate is brought into contact with No. 2/3 mirror base unit, then fix the scanner drive pulley.
6) Put No. 2/3 mirror base unit on the positioning plate again, push
the projections on the front frame side and the rear frame side of
the copy lamp unit to the corner frame, and tighten the wire fixing
screw.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 ADJUSTMENTS 7 - 5
La
4) Loosen the mirror base drive pulley fixing screw on the front frame
side or on the rear frame side.
When La < Lb
Turn the mirror base drive pulley on the front frame side in the
arrow direction A. (Do not move the mirror base drive pulley shaft.)
When La > Lb
Turn the mirror base drive pulley on the rear frame side in the
arrow direction A. (Do not move the mirror base drive pulley shaft.)
Rear side
A
Paper exit
direction
Original
Copy
La = Lb
6) Execute the main scanning direction (FR) distortion balance
adjustment previously described in 2) again.
When the copy lamp unit and no. 2/3 mirror unit are replaced.
3) Measure the width of the black background at the lead edge and at
the rear edge.
Original
Copy A
Copy B
Parallel line
Parallel line
10mm
10mm
10mm
10mm
If the width (La) of the black background at the lead edge is equal
that (Lb) at the rear edge, there is no need to execute the following
procedures of 4) 7).
White paper
2) Make a normal (100%) copy of the test sheet on A3 (11" x 17")
paper. (Fit the paper edge and the glass holding plate edge.)
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 ADJUSTMENTS 7 - 6
3) Measure the distances (La, Lb, Lc, Ld) at the four corners as
shown below.
La
Lc
Paper exit
direction
Ld
Spec value
At normal:
1.0%
SIM
481-1
Set value
Add 1: 0.1%
increase
Reduce 1: 0.1%
decrease
Setting
range
1 99
When La > Lb
Shift the mirror base B rail upward by the half of the difference of
LaLb.
When La < Lb
Shift the mirror base B rail downward by the half of the difference
of LbLa.
Example: When La = 12mm and Lb = 9mm, shift the mirror base
B rail upward by 1.5mm.
When Lc >Ld
Shift the mirror base B rail downward by the half of the difference
of LcLd.
When Lc < Ld
When Lc < Ld, move the mirror base B on the paper feed side
upward.
When moving the mirror base rail, hold the mirror base rail with
your hand.
<Adjustment specification>
La = Lb, Lc = Ld
5) After completion of adjustment, manually turn the mirror base drive
pulley, scan the mirror base A and mirror base B fully, and check
that the mirror bases are not in contact with each other.
If the mirror base rail is moved extremely, the mirror base may be in
contact with the frame or the original glass. Be careful to avoid this.
Spec value
SIM
Set value
At normal:
1.0%
48-12
Add 1:
0.05% increase
Reduce 1:
0.05% decrease
Setting
range
1 99
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 ADJUSTMENTS 7 - 7
1) Put a scale on the original table as shown below, and make a normal (100%) copy to make a test chart.
Note: Since the printed copy is used as a test chart, put the scale in
parallel with the front side edge of the glass.
A
2) Set the test chart on the RSPF and make a normal (100%) copy.
3) Compare the scale image and the actual image.
If necessary, perform the following adjustment procedures.
4) Execute SIM 48-1-3.
5) After warm-up, shading is performed.
The current front surface sub scanning direction magnification ratio
correction value is displayed in two digits on the display section.
<Adjustment specification>
Spec value
SIM
Set value
At normal:
1.0%
48-1-3
48-1-4
Add 1:
0.05% increase
Reduce 1:
0.05% decrease
Setting
range
1 99
Spec value
SIM
Set value
Single: Center
3.0mm
Duplex: Center
3.5mm
50-12
Add 1: 0.1mm
shift to R side
Reduce 1: 0.1mm
shift to L side
Setting
range
1 99
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 ADJUSTMENTS 7 - 8
3) Slide the lens unit toward the front side and attach it, then execute SIM.
When the display is 143 or below:
1) Remove the table glass.
2) Remove the dark box.
3) Slide the lens unit toward the rear side and attach it, then execute SIM.
[Operation]
1) With the RSPF or the OC cover open, place a chart of black background on the OC glass. (In the RSPF standard model, the RSPF
glass surface is included.)
Front
below.
Chart size: 310 x 470, prepared with cutting sheet No. 791 (Black) or
an equivalent one.
TEXT/PHOTO
PHOTO
SUPER PHOTO
AE (TONER
SAVE)
TEXT (TONER
SAVE)
Placing the black chart
The black chart must cover
this area.
TEXT PHOTO
(TONER SAVE)
Exposure
level
1.0
Sharp Gray
Chart output
"3" is copied.
"7" is copied.
3.0
5.0
1.0
3.0
5.0
1.0
3.0
5.0
1.0
3.0
5.0
"3" is copied.
"2" is copied.
"6" is copied.
"3" is copied.
"2" is copied.
"5" is copied.
"3" is copied.
"2" is copied.
"5" is copied.
"3" is copied.
"2" is copied.
"3" is copied.
1.0
3.0
"7" is copied.
"3" is copied.
5.0
"2" is copied.
1.0
3.0
5.0
"6" is copied.
"3" is copied.
"2" is copied.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 ADJUSTMENTS 7 - 9
Set value
If too bright,
increase the
quantity displayed
on the copy
quantity display.
If too dark,
decrease the
quantity displayed
on the copy
quantity display.
Setting
range
0 99
[8] SIMULATION
2. Code-type simulation
A. Operating procedures and operations
* Entering the simulation mode
1) #/P key (program) ON Asterisk (*) key ON CLEAR key ON
Asterisk (*) key ON Ready for input of a main code of simulation
2) Entering a main code with the 10-key START key ON
3) Entering a sub code with the 10-key START key ON
4) Select an item with the scroll key and the item key.
5) The machine enters the mode corresponding to the selected item.
Press START key to start the simulation operation.
To cancel the current simulation mode or to change the main code
and the sub code, press the CUSTOM SETTINGS key.
* Canceling the simulation mode to return to the normal mode
1) Press CLEAR ALL key.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 1
YES
Returns to START
(Normal mode).
Do you want
to perform another
simulation ?
NO
2
YES
NO
YES
YES
Is it the same
simulation ?
3
NO
NO
Is there a item
selection?
YES
YES
Operation check ?
Press the START key.
NO
YES
Data clear ?
NO
NO
YES
Do you
want to change the
content ?
NO
YES
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 2
1
2
3
3
2
3
6
7
11
3
5
1
2
3
2
7
1
6
8
1
10
11
12
Code
Main
Sub
8
13
Function
Used to check the operation of the scanner unit
and its control circuit.
Used to check the operation of sensor and
detector in the scanning (read) section and the
related circuit.
Used to check the operation of the SPF/RSPF unit
and the related circuit.
Used to check the operation of sensors and
detectors in the SPF/RSPF unit and the related
circuit.
Used to check the operation of the loads in the
SPF/RSPF unit and the control circuits.
Used to check the operation of sensor and
detector in the finisher and the related circuit.
Used to check the operation of the load in the
finisher and the control circuit.
Used to adjust the alignment position (side
regulation plate, rear edge regulation plate) for
each paper size.
Shifts to the specified paper size position.
Used to adjust the offset tray operations.
Used to check the shifter operation.
Reciprocating operations are continuously
performed or the home position is checked. (The
shifter is shifted to the home position or moved in
one way by the specified steps.)
Used to check the operation of sensor and
detector in the option cassette and the related
circuit.
Used to check the operation of the load in the
option tray and the control circuit.
Used to check the operation of the display (LED),
LCD in the operation panel, and control circuit.
Used to check the operation of the heater lamp
and the control circuit.
Used to check the operation of the copy lamp and
the control circuit.
Used to check the operation of the loads (clutches
and solenoids) in the paper transport system and
the control circuit.
Used to check the operation of each fan motor and
its control circuit.
Used to set the aging operation conditions.
Used to set the cycle of intermittent aging.
Used to set the display of the warm-up time.
Used to check and adjust the operation of the
developing bias voltage in each copy mode and
the control circuit.
Used to check and adjust the operation of the main
charger grid voltage (high mode) in each copy
mode and the control circuit.
Used to check and adjust the operation of the main
charger grid voltage (low mode) in each copy
mode and the control circuit.
Used to check and adjust the operation of the
developing bias voltage in each printer mode and
the control circuit.
Used to check and adjust the operation of the main
charger grid voltage (high mode) in each printer
mode and the control circuit.
Used to check and adjust the operation of the main
charger grid voltage (low mode) in each printer
mode and the control circuit.
14
15
4
5
10
14
16
17
21
22
0
0
1
1
2
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
19
24
2
3
4
5
Function
Used to check and adjust the operation of the
developing bias voltage in FAX mode and the
control circuit.
Used to check and adjust the operation of the main
charger grid voltage (high mode) in FAX mode and
the control circuit.
Used to check and adjust the operation of the main
charger grid voltage (low mode) in FAX mode and
the control circuit.
Used to check and adjust the operation of the load
(motor) in the duplex section and the control
circuit.
Duplex motor RPM setting
Used to adjust the timing of switching from normal
rotation to reverse rotation or from reverse rotation
to normal rotation of the duplex motor.
Used to check the operation of the toner motor and
its control circuit.
Used to cancel excluding the self-diag U2/PF
troubles.
Used to cancel the self-diag U2 trouble.
Used to cancel the self diag "PF" trouble.
Used to set the maintenance cycle.
Used to check the counter value of each section.
Used to check the total numbers of misfeed and
troubles. (When the number of misfeed is
considerably great, it is judged as necessary for
repair. The misfeed rate is obtained by dividing this
count value with the total counter value.)
Used to check the misfeed positions and the
number of misfeed at each position. (When the
number of misfeed is considerably great, it can be
judged as necessary for repair.)
Used to check the total trouble (self diag) history.
Used to check the ROM version of each unit
(section).
Used to print each key operator setting, the
account information, and the machine adjustment
values.
Used to display the key operator code. (Use when
the customer key operator code is forgotten.)
Used to display the original, staple counter.
Used to check the number of use of each paper
feed section. (the number of prints)
Used to check the system configuration.
Used to display the FAX send/receive counter
(FAX reception and print counter).
Used to check the misfeed positions and the
number of misfeed at each position. (When the
number of misfeed is considerably great, it can be
judged as necessary for repair.)
Used to display the CRUM type.
Used to display the scanner counter in the network
scanner mode.
Used to clear the misfeed counter, the misfeed
history, the trouble counter, and the trouble history.
(The counters are cleared after completion of
maintenance.)
Used to clear the number of use (the number of
prints) of each paper feed section.
Used to clear the number data of use of the staple,
the SPF/RSPF and scanning.
Used to reset the maintenance counter.
Used to reset the developer counter. (The
developer counter of the DV unit which is installed
is reset.)
Used to clear the copy counter.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 3
Code
Main
Sub
24
7
10
15
25
2
26
2
3
5
6
10
12
14
18
22
30
35
36
41
46
50
57
60
71
27
1
5
Function
Used to clear the OPC drum (membrane
decrease) correction counter. (This simulation is
executed when the OPC drum is replaced.
Used to clear the printer counter and other
counters. (The counter is cleared after completion
of maintenance.)
FAX counter data clear
Used to clear the scanner counter in the network
scanner mode.
Used to check the operation of the main drive
(excluding the scanner section) and to check the
operation of the toner concentration sensor. (The
toner concentration sensor output can be
monitored.) (To be supported for Ver.00.72 or
later)
Used to make the initial setting of toner
concentration when replacing developer.
Used to set whether the job separator is installed
or not. (Since this cannot be detected by hardware
detection, it is set in this simulation.)
Used to set whether the automatic detection of
paper size is made or not.
Used to set the specifications of the auditor.
Setting must be made depending on the use
condition of the auditor.
Used to set the count mode of the total counter
and the maintenance counter.
Used to set the specifications depending on the
destination.
Network scanner trial mode setting
Used to input the Software Key for E-MAIL RIC.
Used to input the Software Key for the PS
extension kit.
Used to set enable/disable of toner save operation.
Used to set the specification (language display) for
the destination.
Used to set ON/OFF of the heater lamp slow-up
control conforming to the CE mark control.
Used to set whether the same continuous troubles
are displayed as one trouble or the series of
troubles with SIM 22-4 when the same troubles
occur continuously.
Used to set whether the machine is stopped or not
when the maintenance counter life is expired.
Used to set ON/OFF of the automatic
magnification ratio selection (AMS) when setting
the binding function.
Used to set whether to meet with the output
direction of images regardless of the mode when
installing the finisher.
Used to set ON/OFF of the black and white
reversion function.
Used to set the model code.
Used to set enable/disable of the FAX mode key
when FAX is not installed. (When FAX is installed,
the FAX mode is enabled regardless of this setup.)
In the power save time setting, the pre-heat (preheat mode setting) and the auto power shut off
time can be set to the short time setup (pre-heat: 1
min, auto power shut off: 4 min) and the long time
setup (pre-heat: 15min, auto power shut off:
60min).
Used to set PC/MODEM communication trouble
(U7-00) detection Yes/No.
Used to set the tag number.
Code
Main
Sub
30
1
2
40
1
2
3
41
1
2
3
4
43
1
10
44
1
34
35
40
46
2
7
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
18
19
20
30
Function
Used to display the sensor status attached to the
machine.
Used to display the status of the sensors attached
to the standard cassette and the manual feed tray.
(Use SIM 4-2 for the option cassettes.)
The sensor of an uninstalled cassette is not
displayed.
Used to check the sensor of the machine manual
feed tray.
Used to adjust the manual paper feed tray paper
width detector detection level.
The AD conversion value of manual feed width
detection is displayed.
Used to check the document size detection photo
sensor.
Used to adjust the detection level of the document
size photo sensor.
Used to check the light reception level and the
detection level of the original size detection photo
sensor.
Used to adjust the detection level of OC 20
degrees.
Used to set the fusing temperature in 600dpi,
1200dpi, or postcard print.
Used to set the paper feed cycle timing when
printing postcards.
Used to make various setups in each mode of
process control.
Used to set the transfer current value in each
mode.
Used to set the DV-Bias/Grid environment (low
temperature) correction temperature.
Used to set the time from the start of the main
motor rotation (Ready) to the start of toner supply
in previous rotation after turning on the power.
Used to set the exposure level in each exposure
mode.
Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination
value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode
(Super Photo).
Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination
value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode
(Text).
Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination
value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode
(Text/Photo).
Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination
value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode
(Photo).
FAX exposure level adjustment (1 mode automatic
adjustment)
FAX exposure level adjustment (Normal mode
individual adjustment)
FAX exposure level adjustment (Fine text mode
individual adjustment)
FAX exposure level adjustment (Super Fine mode
individual adjustment)
FAX exposure level adjustment (Ultra Fine mode
individual adjustment)
Used to adjust inclination for each exposure mode.
Used to set the control method of the exposure
mode.
Used to set the exposure correction value of SPF/
RSPF for OC exposure.
Used to set the AE and the limit value in AE (Toner
save).
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 4
Code
Main
Sub
46
31
48
39
1
2
50
8
9
1
5
6
8
9
10
12
51
1
2
8
9
53
7
8
61
63
1
1
7
64
Function
Used to set the AE and the limit value in AE (Toner
save).
Used to switch the FAX send image quality.
Used to adjust the copy mode magnification ratio
(main scanning direction, sub scanning direction).
Used to adjust the scanner mode magnification
ratio (main/sub scanning direction).
FAX magnification adjustment (read)
FAX magnification adjustment (print)
Used to adjust the copy lead edge position.
Used to adjust the print image position (top
margin) on the print paper in the print mode.
Used to adjust the print image position (top
margin) on print paper in the copy mode. (SPF/
RSPF)
FAX lead edge adjustment (read)
FAX lead edge adjustment (print)
Used to adjust the print image center position.
(Adjustment can be made for each paper feed
section.)
Used to adjust the print image center position.
(Adjustment can be made for each document
mode.)
Used to adjust the OPC drum separation pawl ON
time.
Used to adjust the contact pressure of paper onto
the resist roller in each section (copier paper feed
section, duplex paper feed section, SPF/RSPF
paper feed section). (When the print image
position varies greatly for the paper or when a lot
of paper jam troubles occur, the adjustment is
required.)
Used to set the OPC drum separation pawl
operation inhibit. (ON/OFF)
Used to adjust the OPC drum separation voltage
ON/OFF timing.
Used to adjust the detection level of the SPF/
RSPF width. The adjustment method is the 4-point
system. Set the guide to Max. (A3/WLetter)
position, A4R/Letter R position, A5R/Invoice R
position, and Min. position for adjustment.
Used to enter the SPF/RSPF width detection
adjustment value.
Used to adjust the SPF/RSPF scan position of the
mirror unit automatically. For the SPF/RSPF scan
position automatic adjustment, the mirror unit is
shifted to 11mm before the SPF/RSPF glass cover
edge, and is operated automatically to scan
images by the unit of 1 step, detecting the position
up to the glass cover automatically.
(Adjustment value)
Default: 50, Adjustment range: 1 - 99
Adjustment unit: 1 = about 0.12mm
Used to check the LSU (polygon motor) operation.
Used to check the result of shading correction.
(The shading correction data are displayed.)
Used to adjust the SPF/RSPF white correction
start pixel position automatically.
This adjustment is performed after the lens unit is
replaced.
Used to check the operation of the printer function
(auto print operation).
Code
Main
Sub
65
1
2
5
66
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
67
19
20
21
22
24
30
31
32
33
34
37
41
1
11
14
15
17
18
20
Function
Used to adjust the touch panel (LCD display
section) detection position.
Used to check the touch panel (LCD display
section) detection position adjustment result.
Used to check the key inputs of the operation
panel.
Used to change and check the FAX-related soft
SW.
Used to clear the FAX-related soft SW. (Except for
the FAX adjustment values)
FAX PWB memory check
Signal send mode (Signal send level: Max.)
Signal send mode (Signal send level soft SW
setting)
Printing the confidential password
Print the screen memory contents
Voice Message send (Signal send level: Max.)
(Japan only)
Used to send the voice message. (Signal send
level: Set by soft SW.)
Image data memory clear
Used to send 300bps signals. (Signal send level:
Max.)
Used to send 300bps signals. (Signal send level:
Set by soft SW)
Used to register the dial numbers.
Used to perform the dial test. (10 PPS send test)
Used to perform the dial test. (20 PPS send test)
Used to perform the dial test. (DTFM signal send
test)
Used to check the DTFM signal send operation.
(Signal send level: Max.)
Used to check the DTFM signal send operation.
(Signal send level: Set by soft SW.)
Used to write the SRAM data to the Flash ROM.
Used to write the Flash ROM data to the SRAM.
FAX information print
Handset sound volume adjustment (Japan only)
Used to clear the FAST storage data. (SEC only)
Used to set the TEL/LIU.
Used to set the TEL/LIU.
Receive data check
Signal detection check
Communication time measurement display
Speaker sound volume adjustment
CI signal check
Used to execute read/write check of the RAM on
the PCL board, and to display the result. (To be
supported for MCU v00.45 or later)
Used to set the select-in signal of the Centro port.
Used to check write/comparison of flash programs.
Used to check the validity of the ROM on the PCL
board and the result is displayed. (To be supported
for MCU v00.45 or later)
Used to clear the printer section setting. (NVRAM
clear)
Used to clear the data area for FLASH ROM
Network Scanner Application.
Used to check the network connection when the
scanner option is installed.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 5
4. Details
1
1-1
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to check the operation of the scanner unit and its
control circuit.
Optical (Image scanning)
Operation
Operation/procedure
Enter the number of operations, and set the magnification ratio and the
original size.
1. Select the desired item, and press the [START] key.
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
The scanner unit operates at the speed corresponding to the set value.
The scan counter is displayed during execution.
Set magnification ratio
Document size
Set number of times
2-2
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to check the operation of sensors and detectors
in the SPF/RSPF unit and the related circuit.
SPF/RSPF
Operation
Operation/procedure
The operations of sensors and detectors in the SPF/RSPF section are
displayed.
The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.
(For the original size, the detection result of the original size displayed
on the copy menu is highlighted.)
1-2
EMPS
DLS1
DLS2
FGOD
DFD
RDD
OPCLS
SWD_LEN
Purpose
Operation test/check
Function
Used to check the operation of sensor and detector in
(Purpose) the scanning (read) section and the related circuit.
Section
Optical (Image scanning)
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
The status of sensors and detectors in the scanner section is displayed. The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.
MHPS
SWD_A/D
2
2-3
2-1
Purpose
Operation test/check
Used to check the operation of the SPF/RSPF unit and
Function
(Purpose) the related circuit.
Section
SPF/RSPF
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
Enter the number of operations, and set the magnification ratio and the
original size.
1. Select the desired item, and press the [START] key.
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to check the operation of the loads in the SPF/
RSPF unit and the control circuits.
SPF/RSPF
Operation
Operation/procedure
Select the load to be checked with the 10-key, and press the [START]
key.
The motor for 10sec, the solenoid ON for 500msec, OFF for 500msec.
(20 times)
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 6
Item
Content
1 DTM-F
SPF/RSPF motor forward rotation
2 DTM-R SPF/RSPF motor reverse rotation
3 DFCL
SPF/RSPF paper feed clutch
4 CLH
SPF/RSPF PS clutch
5 GSOL
Document exit gate solenoid
6 RSOL
Document exit pressure solenoid
Note: Executable only when the SPF/RSPF is installed.
3
3-2
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to check the operation of sensor and detector in
the finisher and the related circuit.
Finisher
Operation
Operation/procedure
Select the load to be checked with the 10-key, and press the [START]
key.
The finisher main motor operates for 10sec, the staple motor 5 times,
the tray lift-up motor one reciprocating operation, other motors max. 20
reciprocating operations from the home position, the solenoid repeats
500msec ON and 500msec OFF 20 times.
The staple operation motor operates only when there is no cartridge
installed.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
Item
JGM1
JGM2
FM-600
FM-1200
EVM
OFM
STM
OGSLR
OGSLL
JGSL1
JGSL2
SHTSL
T2SCL
STGSL
Content
Side guide plate drive motor
Rear edge plate drive motor
Finisher main motor (600dpi)
Finisher main motor (1200dpi)
Tray lift-up motor
Tray offset motor
Staple operation motor
Transport selection gate solenoid (R)
Transport selection gate solenoid (L)
Rear edge plate drive solenoid
Upper alignment plate drive solenoid
Shutter drive solenoid
Paper exit roller clutch
Paper holding solenoid
Operation/procedure
Used to display the operations of sensors and detectors in the finisher
section.
The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.
INPD
FWPS
JGHP1
JGHP2
JGPD
T1OD
T1PF
PGOP
T2OD
OFHP
T2UP
T2DN
JGDSW
EVRE
STHP
READY
LSTS
NCTS
STND
T2PUD
3-6
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Adjustment
Used to adjust the alignment position (side regulation
plate, rear edge regulation plate) for each paper size.
Shifts to the specified paper size position.
Finisher
Operation
Operation/procedure
After the paper size is set, the side guide plate and the rear guide plate
are set.
1. Enter the desired item with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key, and press the [START]
key.
Item
Content
PAPER SIZE
2
3
JOGGER POS X
JOGGER POS Y
Paper size
(1:A3, 2:A4, 3:B4, 4:B5,
5:A4R, 6:WLT, 7:LT,
8:LG, 9:FC, 10:LTR,
11:8K, 12:16K)
Side guide plate
Rear edge guide plate
Setting
range
1-12
1-99
Default
A4
50
There are 6 adjustment values for the side guide plate, and 12 for the
rear guide plate. The adjustment position is determined from the table
below according to the paper size.
3-3
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to check the operation of the load in the finisher
and the control circuit.
Finisher
Operation
Paper size
A3
A4
B4
B5
1
1
3
3
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 7
Item
5
Content
OFFSET INI.POS
Installation
range
0-99
Default
3-7
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Item
Adjustment
Used to adjust the offset tray operations.
Finisher
Operation
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the operation item to be set.
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
Item
1
PAPER PUSH
TMG
PAPER OUT
DOWN
STAPLE UP
STAPLE DOWN
Content
Installation
range
34-66
Default
Paper holder
50
descending timing
in non-staple
Used to adjust the descending timing of
the paper holder lever before lift-up
operation after paper exit or offset
operation. (The paper holder lever
prevents against paper shift in paper top
surface detection and paper stacking .)
Tray descending
0-12
1
distance after nonstaple paper exit
Used to adjust the offset tray descending
distance after non-staple paper exit.
The descending distance is the relative
distance from the non-staple standby
position.
Tray lift distance
0-12
6
before staple paper
exit
The height of the tray standby position in
stapling is changed for that in non-stapling
to improve stacking capacity in stapling.
(The relative distance for the height of the
tray standby position in non-stapling is
set.)
Tray descending
0-12
6
distance after staple
paper exit
Used to adjust the offset tray descending
distance after staple paper exit.
The descending distance is the relative
distance from the non-staple standby
position.
3-11
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Item
Operation test/check
Used to check the shifter operation.
Reciprocating operations are continuously performed
or the home position is checked. (The shifter is shifted
to the home position or moved in one way by the
specified steps.)
Operation
Operation/procedure
Select item "1," and press the [START] key.
The shifter is reciprocated continuously at the specified interval.
1
2
Item
F-R
HP CHECK
Content
Reciprocating operation
Home position check
[Selection 2]
1. Select item "2," and press the [START] key.
2. Move the shifter to the home position or in one way by the specified steps with the following keys.
[*] key
[0 key
[#] key
SFTHP
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 8
4
4-2
Purpose
Operation test/check
Function
Used to check the operation of sensor and detector in
(Purpose) the option cassette and the related circuit.
Section
Paper feed
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
The operating states of the sensor and the detector are displayed.
(Only the installed option cassettes are displayed. For the standard
tray, use SIM 30-2.)
The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.
PED2
LUD2
PFD2
CD2
PED3
LUD3
PFD3
CD3
PED4
LUD4
PFD4
CD4
DSWR2
DSWR3
DSWR4
4-3
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to check the operation of the load in the option
tray and the control circuit.
Paper feed
Operation
Operation/procedure
Select the load to be checked with the 10-key, and press the [START]
key.
5
5-1
Purpose
Operation test/check
Function
Used to check the operation of the display (LED), LCD
(Purpose) in the operation panel, and control circuit.
Section
Operation (screen/operation)
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
The LCD is displayed as follows. (All LEDs are ON.)
With the upper half highlighted and the lower half normally displayed,
contrast changes "Standard MAX MIN." in every 2sec.
(6 sec later)
With the upper half normally displayed and the lower half highlighted,
contrast changes "Standard MAX MIN." in every 2sec.
* When returning to the sub menu selection menu, the display of the
standard contrast is displayed for an instant.
5-2
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to check the operation of the heater lamp and the
control circuit.
Fusing
Operation
The motor for 10sec, the solenoid ON for 500msec, OFF for 500msec.
Operation/procedure
The lift-up motor operates only when the tray is opened. (20 times)
1. Select the lamp to be checked with the 10-key, and press the
[START] key.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
Item
LUM2
CPFC2
CPFS2
TRC2
DM
LUM3
CPFC3
CPFS3
TRC3
LUM4
CPFC4
CPFS4
Content
2nd cassette lift-up motor
2nd cassette pick-up solenoid
2nd cassette paper feed clutch
2nd cassette transport roller clutch
2nd cassette paper transport motor (3rd cassette
paper transport motor)
3rd cassette lift-up motor
3rd cassette pick-up solenoid
3rd cassette paper feed clutch
3rd cassette transport roller clutch
4th cassette lift-up motor
4th cassette pick-up solenoid
4th cassette paper feed clutch
Item
HL1
HL2
Content
Heater lamp 1 (Main) operation
Heater lamp 2 (Sub) operation
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 9
6-2
5-3
Purpose
Operation test/check
Function
Used to check the operation of the copy lamp and the
(Purpose) control circuit.
Section
Optical (Image scanning)
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
Purpose
Operation test/check
Function
Used to check the operation of each fan motor and its
(Purpose) control circuit.
Section
Others
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
When the [START] key is pressed, the copy lamp is lighted for 10sec.
Select the load to be checked with the 10-key, and press the [START]
key.
The selected load is operated for 10sec.
1
2
Item
VFM
DCFM&DCFM2
VFM&DCFM&DCFM2
Content
Only the fusing fan operates
Power cooling fan, power cooling fan 2
operations
Fusing fan, power cooling fan, and
power cooling fan 2 are operated at the
same time.
6-1
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to check the operation of the loads (clutches and
solenoids) in the paper transport system and the
control circuit.
Paper transport (Discharge/Switchback/Transport)
Operation
Operation/procedure
1. Select the load to be checked with the 10-key, and press the
[START] key.
7-1
The motor for 10sec, the solenoid ON for 500msec, OFF for 500msec.
(20 times)
When the [CUSTOM SETTINGS] is pressed, the operation is interrupted.
The lift-up motor operates only when the tray is opened.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
Item
LUM1
CPFC1
CPFS1
MPFS
RRC
PSPS
OGS
LUM2
CPFC2
CPFS2
TRC2
LUM3
CPFC3
CPFS3
TRC3
LUM4
CPFC4
CPFS4
Content
1st cassette lift-up motor
1st cassette pick-up solenoid
1st cassette paper feed clutch
Manual feed pick-up solenoid
Resist roller clutch
Separation pawl solenoid
Paper exit gate switching solenoid
2nd cassette lift-up motor
2nd cassette pick-up solenoid
2nd cassette paper feed clutch
2nd cassette transport roller clutch
3rd cassette lift-up motor
3rd cassette pick-up solenoid
3rd cassette paper feed clutch
3rd cassette transport roller clutch
4th cassette lift-up motor
4th cassette pick-up solenoid
4th cassette paper feed clutch
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Item
Operation/procedure
Setting/Operation test/check
Used to set the aging operation conditions.
Operation
Item
AGING
MISFEED
FUSING
4
5
INTERVL
WARMUP
DV CHK.
Content
Aging enable/disable setting
Jam detection enable/disable setting
Fusing operation enable/disable setting
The fusing temperature is not controlled. The
heater is not turned ON.
Intermittent setting (Valid only when set to AGING.)
Warm-up save setting
The machine goes into the ready state only by
shading, disregarding fusing and process control.
After going into the ready state, normal control is
performed.
Developing unit detection enable/disable setting
*1: When the machine exits from the fusing ignoring state, the roller
may be cooled down. Therefore, reset the machine to warm up
again.
When, therefore, the simulation is canceled by pressing the [CA]
key or when the copy mode display is shifted to the initial menu
display in the simulation mode of one page copy, the machine is
reset.
Note: In SIM 7-1, pressing [CA] key terminates the simulation and the
machine enters the aging mode without resetting. Therefore, to
perform "4. Intermittent setup," the intermittent cycle must be set
with SIM 7-6 in advance.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 10
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the exposure mode to be changed.
The current set value is displayed.
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
3. Press the [START] key.
Output is made with the entered value, and the display returns to the
original state.
Item
7-6
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Item
Setting/Operation test/check
Used to set the cycle of intermittent aging.
Operation
Operation/procedure
1. Enter the interval aging cycle time (sec) with the 10-key pad.
Refer to SIM 7-1.
2. Press the [START] key.
When the [START] key is pressed in aging, copying is performed continuously. This simulation is used to set the time interval between copy
operations in the unit of second.
This setting is valid when SIM 7-1 (Intermittent setting) is enabled.
Setting range
Default
1-255
3
1
2
3
4
5
6
Content
AE ()
Character
Character/Photo
Photo
Super photo
Toner save
AE
TEXT
TEXT/PHOTO
PHOTO
SUPER/PHOTO
TONER SAVE
Installation
range
200-550
Default
400 (400V)
450 (450V)
450 (450V)
450 (450V)
400 (400V)
376 (376V)
7-8
Purpose
Setting/Operation test/check
Function
Used to set the display of the warm-up time.
(Purpose)
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
1. Warm-up starts by the cover open/close.
8-2
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
If the [CA] key is pressed at this time, count-up is interrupted to terminate the simulation. (However, warm-up is continued.)
3. After completion of warming up, "WARM UP COMPLETED" is displayed and the control returns to the initial screen.
Adjustment/Operation test/check
Used to check and adjust the operation of the main
charger grid voltage (high mode) in each copy mode
and the control circuit.
Image process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/
Cleaning)
Photo conductor
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the exposure mode to be changed.
The current set value is displayed.
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
3. Press the [START] key.
Output is made with the entered value for 30sec, and the display
returns to the original state.
Item
8
8-1
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Adjustment/Operation test/check
Used to check and adjust the operation of the
developing bias voltage in each copy mode and the
control circuit.
Image process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/
Cleaning)
Developer/Toner hopper
1
2
3
4
5
6
AE
TEXT
TEXT/PHOTO
PHOTO
SUPER/PHOTO
TONER SAVE
Content
AE ()
Character
Character/Photo
Photo
Super photo
Toner save
Setting
range
1-8
Set value
480
505
530
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 11
Grid High
480V
505V
530V
Grid Low
350V
375V
400V
Default
3 (530V)
5 (580V)
5 (580V)
5 (580V)
3 (530V)
2 (505V)
If, for example, the grid high voltage is set to 480V (pattern 1), the
grid low voltage is 350V.
NO.
Set value
Grid High
Grid Low
4
555
555V
425V
5
580
580V
450V
6
605
605V
475V
7
630
630V
500V
8
655
655V
525V
*1. The negative value of the set value corresponds to the grid high
output voltage.
*2. The set values can be selected from the above 8 patterns only.
*3. The selected pattern determines the grid high voltage and the grid
low voltage.
If, for example, the grid high voltage is set to 480V (pattern 1), the
grid low voltage is 350V.
8-10
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Adjustment/Operation test/check
Used to check and adjust the operation of the
developing bias voltage in each printer mode and the
control circuit.
Image process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/
Cleaning)
Developer/Toner hopper
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the exposure mode to be changed.
The current set value is displayed.
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
8-3
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Adjustment/Operation test/check
Used to check and adjust the operation of the main
charger grid voltage (low mode) in each copy mode
and the control circuit.
Image process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/
Cleaning)
Photo conductor
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the exposure mode to be changed.
The current set value is highlighted.
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
3. Press the [START] key.
Output is made with the entered value for 30sec, and the display
returns to the original state.
Item
1
2
3
4
5
6
AE
TEXT
TEXT/PHOTO
PHOTO
SUPER/PHOTO
TONER SAVE
Content
AE ()
Character
Character/Photo
Photo
Super photo
Toner save
Setting
range
1-8
Default
3 (400V)
5 (450V)
5 (450V)
5 (450V)
3 (400V)
2 (375V)
DENS1(600)
DENS2(600)
DENS3(600)
DENS4(600)
DENS5(600)
TS(600)
DENS1(1200)
DENS2(1200)
DENS3(1200)
DENS4(1200)
DENS5(1200)
Set value
480
505
530
555
580
605
630
655
Grid High
480V
505V
530V
555V
580V
605V
630V
655V
Installation
Default
range
Density 1 (600dpi)
200-550 400 (400V)
Density 2 (600dpi)
450 (450V)
Density 3 (600dpi)
450 (450V)
Density 4 (600dpi)
450 (450V)
Density 5 (600dpi)
500 (500V)
Toner save (600dpi)
350 (350V)
Density 1 (1200dpi)
300 (300V)
Density 2 (1200dpi)
350 (350V)
Density 3 (1200dpi)
376 (376V)
Density 4 (1200dpi)
426 (426V)
Density 5 (1200dpi)
500 (500V)
Content
Grid Low
350V
375V
400V
425V
450V
475V
500V
525V
*1. The negative value of the set value corresponds to the grid high
output voltage.
*2. The set values can be selected from the above 8 patterns only.
*3. The selected pattern determines the grid high voltage and the grid
low voltage.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 12
Operation/procedure
8-11
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Adjustment/Operation test/check
Used to check and adjust the operation of the main
charger grid voltage (high mode) in each printer mode
and the control circuit.
Section
Image process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/
Cleaning)
Photo conductor
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the exposure mode to be changed.
The current set value is highlighted.
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
3. Press the [START] key.
Output is made with the entered value for 30sec, and the display
returns to the original state.
Item
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Content
DENS1(600)
DENS2(600)
DENS3(600)
DENS4(600)
DENS5(600)
TS(600)
DENS1(1200)
DENS2(1200)
DENS3(1200)
DENS4(1200)
DENS5(1200)
Density 1 (600dpi)
Density 2 (600dpi)
Density 3 (600dpi)
Density 4 (600dpi)
Density 5 (600dpi)
Toner save (600dpi)
Density 1 (1200dpi)
Density 2 (1200dpi)
Density 3 (1200dpi)
Density 4 (1200dpi)
Density 5 (1200dpi)
Installation
range
1-8
Default
5 (580V)
5 (580V)
5 (580V)
5 (580V)
7 (630V)
3 (530V)
1 (480V)
3 (530V)
4 (555V)
5 (580V)
7 (630V)
Set value
480
505
530
555
580
605
630
655
Grid High
480V
505V
530V
555V
580V
605V
630V
655V
Grid Low
350V
375V
400V
425V
450V
475V
500V
525V
Content
DENS1(600)
DENS2(600)
DENS3(600)
DENS4(600)
DENS5(600)
TS(600)
DENS1(1200)
DENS2(1200)
DENS3(1200)
DENS4(1200)
DENS5(1200)
Density 1 (600dpi)
Density 2 (600dpi)
Density 3 (600dpi)
Density 4 (600dpi)
Density 5 (600dpi)
Toner save (600dpi)
Density 1 (1200dpi)
Density 2 (1200dpi)
Density 3 (1200dpi)
Density 4 (1200dpi)
Density 5 (1200dpi)
Installation
range
1-8
Default
5 (450V)
5 (450V)
5 (450V)
5 (450V)
7 (500V)
3 (400V)
1 (350V)
3 (400V)
4 (425V)
5 (450V)
7 (500V)
Set value
480
505
530
555
580
605
630
655
Grid High
480V
505V
530V
555V
580V
605V
630V
655V
Grid Low
350V
375V
400V
425V
450V
475V
500V
525V
*1. The negative value of the set value corresponds to the grid high
output voltage.
*2. The set values can be selected from the above 8 patterns only.
*3. The selected pattern determines the grid high voltage and the grid
low voltage.
If, for example, the grid high voltage is set to 480V (pattern 1), the
grid low voltage is 350V.
*1. The negative value of the set value corresponds to the grid high
output voltage.
*2. The set values can be selected from the above 8 patterns only.
*3. The selected pattern determines the grid high voltage and the grid
low voltage.
If, for example, the grid high voltage is set to 480V (pattern 1), the
grid low voltage is 350V.
8-13
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Adjustment/Operation test/check
Used to check and adjust the operation of the
developing bias voltage in FAX mode and the control
circuit.
Section
Image process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/
Cleaning)
Developer/Toner hopper
Operation/procedure
8-12
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
200-550
426
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 13
Output is made with the entered value for 30sec. and the display
returns to the original state.
Setting range
Default
NO.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1-8
5
Set value
480
505
530
555
580
605
630
655
Grid High
480V
505V
530V
555V
580V
605V
630V
655V
Grid Low
350V
375V
400V
425V
450V
475V
500V
525V
8-14
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Adjustment/Operation test/check
Used to check and adjust the operation of the main
charger grid voltage (high mode) in FAX mode and the
control circuit.
Image process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/
Cleaning)
Photo conductor
*1. The negative value of the set value corresponds to the grid high
output voltage.
*2. The set values can be selected from the above 8 patterns only.
*3. The selected pattern determines the grid high voltage and the grid
low voltage.
If, for example, the grid high voltage is set to 480V (pattern 1), the
grid low voltage is 350V.
Operation/procedure
1. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
2. Press the [START] key.
Output is made with the entered value for 30sec. and the display
returns to the original state.
Setting range
Default
NO.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1-8
5 (480-650)
Set value
480
505
530
555
580
605
630
655
Grid High
480V
505V
530V
555V
580V
605V
630V
655V
Grid Low
350V
375V
400V
425V
450V
475V
500V
525V
9
9-1
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to check and adjust the operation of the load
(motor) in the duplex section and the control circuit.
Duplex
Operation
Operation/procedure
*1. The negative value of the set value corresponds to the grid high
output voltage.
*2. The set values can be selected from the above 8 patterns only.
*3. The selected pattern determines the grid high voltage and the grid
low voltage.
If, for example, the grid high voltage is set to 480V (pattern 1), the
grid low voltage is 350V.
Item
DMF600
DMF1200
DMR600
DMR1200
Content
Duplex motor/Duplex 2 motor forward rotation
(600dpi)
Duplex motor/Duplex 2 motor forward rotation
(1200dpi)
Duplex motor/Duplex 2 motor reverse rotation
(600dpi)
Duplex motor/Duplex 2 motor reverse rotation
(1200dpi)
8-15
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Adjustment/Operation test/check
Used to check and adjust the operation of the main
charger grid voltage (low mode) in FAX mode and the
control circuit.
Image process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/
Cleaning)
Photo conductor
Operation/procedure
1. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
2. Press the [START] key.
9-4
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Item
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 14
Operation test/check
Duplex motor RPM setting
Duplex
Operation
Operation/procedure
Enter the set value with the 10-key.
14
When the duplex motor setting is made, the duplex 2motor is also set
accordingly.
14-0
Setting range
Default
1-13
3
Purpose
Clear/Cancel (Trouble etc.)
Function
Used to cancel excluding the self-diag U2/PF troubles.
(Purpose)
Item
Trouble
Error
Operation/procedure
1. Press the [START] key.
2. When "1: YES" is selected, troubles other than U2 and PF are canceled. (When "2: NO" is selected, the simulation is canceled.)
9-5
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Adjustment
Used to adjust the timing of switching from normal
rotation to reverse rotation or from reverse rotation to
normal rotation of the duplex motor.
Operation/procedure
16
Item
600dpi
1200dpi
Installation range
18-76
Default
18
50
16-0
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Item
Operation/procedure
1. Press the [START] key.
2. When "1: YES" is selected, U2 trouble is canceled. (When "2: NO"
is selected, the simulation is canceled.)
10
17
10-0
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Operation test/check
Used to check the operation of the toner motor and its
control circuit.
Image process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/
Cleaning)
Developer/Toner hopper
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
Press the [START] key and operate the toner motor for 30 sec.
17-0
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Item
Operation/Procedure
21
21-1
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Item
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 15
Setting
Used to set the maintenance cycle.
Specifications
Counter
Operation/procedure
22-2
Purpose
Content
5K
10K
20K
25K
50K
75K (Default)
FREE
JAM counter
SPF/RSPF JAM counter
Trouble counter
22-3
Purpose
22
Function
(Purpose)
22-1
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Item
Counter
Operation/procedure
Total
Maintenance
Developer counter *1
Drum counter
Copy counter
Printer counter
IMC counter
Duplex counter
The other counters
FAX Send counter
FAX receive counter
FAX print counter
Item
Operation/procedure
The misfeed history is displayed in the sequence of recentness by the
name of sensors and detectors. Max. 40 items of information can be
stored in memory. (The old ones are deleted sequentially.) The trouble
section may be determined by the data.
(Jam cause code)
Item
TRAY1
TRAY2
TRAY3
TRAY4
BPT
PPD1_ND
PPD1_ST
PPD1_DUP
PPD2_ND
PPD2_ST
POD2_ND
POD2_ST
POD1_ND
POD1_ST
PINT_SHORT
PFD2_ND
PFD2_ST
PFD3_ND
PFD3_ST
PFD4_ND
PFD4_ST
SIZE_SHORT
FIN_INPDND
FIN_T10D
FIN_T20D
FIN_STPL
PPD1_ND2
PPD1_ST2
Jam contents
1st cassette pick-up miss
2nd cassette pick-up miss
3rd cassette pick-up miss
4th cassette pick-up miss
Multi manual feed pick-up miss
Paper-in sensor lead edge jam
Paper-in sensor rear edge jam
Paper-in sensor reverse jam
Duplex sensor lead edge jam
Duplex sensor rear edge jam
Upper stage paper exit lead edge jam
Upper stage paper exit rear edge jam
Lower stage paper exit lead edge jam
Lower stage paper exit rear edge jam
Abnormality between PS papers.
2nd paper pass lead edge jam
2nd paper pass rear edge jam
3rd paper pass lead edge jam
3rd paper pass rear edge jam
4th paper pass lead edge jam
4th paper pass rear edge jam
Duplex short scale error
Finisher paper entry jam
Finisher escape tray jam
Finisher offset tray jam
Finisher staple tray jam
Reverse sensor lead edge jam
Reverse sensor rear edge jam
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 16
Panel
display
NEU
Destination
Selection code
SEF/
SEES/
SEIS/SEN,
etc.
BG/DG/
BD/DD
BA/BN
CHN
SCA/SCNZ
Distributor
area
SOCC
BZ
UE5
TWN
Taiwan
BE/BT
UT1
EFS *1
Special
countries
22-4
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Item
Trouble
Operation/procedure
The trouble error codes are displayed in the sequence of the latest one
first. Max. 40 items of information are stored. (Older ones are deleted
in sequence.) The machine condition can be estimated by this data.
22-5
Purpose
Adjustment/Setting/Check
Function
Used to check the ROM version of each unit (section).
(Purpose)
Item
Software
Operation/procedure
Used to display the ROM version of each section.
[Display example]
ROM version 1.250 [1.25] (up to 2 decimal places)
The display of the protocol monitor and the soft SW follows this display.
S/N
MCU
IMC
OPE
PRINTER
NIC
FINISHER
FAX
22-6
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Item
Operation/Procedure
(Initial screen)
The currently set value is highlighted beside the adjustment item.
1. Select the adjustment item with the 10-key.
2. Press the [START] key.
The display is shifted to the copy menu and the set value is stored.
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
4. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started. (Printing at 1200dpi cannot be made.)
After canceling a jam (After picking up, the [C] key is invalid.)
When the other information is repeatedly printed, the display may show
the message, "Remove original from original table." However, the
operation is performed normally.
EEU
Destination
Selection code
Japan
SEC
SECL
SUK
SEEG/
SEA/East
Europe,
etc.
AJ/AM
AL/AC
BK/BB
GG/GD
1
2
3
4
5
6
Item
ALL
KEY OPE
ALL COUNTERS
AUDITOR NO.
MACHINE SIM
SETTING
FAX SIM SETTING*1
Content
All lists group print
Key operator information list
List of total number of prints
Department number list
Machine simulation setting list
FAX simulation setting list (Only when
the FAX board is installed. The display
does not go to the print data transfer
display, but to the FAX SIM menu.)
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 17
Note: When the simulation is canceled, the display returns to the original state but the machine is not reset.
SIMULATION 22-6
DATA PRINT MODE. SELECT 1-6, AND PRESS START.
1:ALL
1
2:KEY OPE
3:ALL COUNTERS
4:AUDITOR NO.
5:MACHINE SIM SETTING
6:FAX SIM SETTING
SIMULATION 22-6
DATA PRINT MODE. EXECUTING...
1:ALL
2:KEY OPE
22-9
Purpose
3:ALL COUNTERS
4:AUDITOR NO.
5:MACHINE SIM SETTING
6:FAX SIM SETTING
TRAY3
TRAY4
Tray 3 counter
Tray 4 counter
READY TO COPY
1:KEY OPE
1:KEY OPE
22-10
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Item
Option
Operation/procedure
The detected machine composition is displayed.
(The job separator cannot be detected. Based on SIM 26-1 setting.)
22-7
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Item
Operation/procedure
Used to display the key operator code.
22-8
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Item
Operation/procedure
Each counter is displayed.
SPF
SCAN
STAPLE
SPF/RSPF counter
Scan counter
Stapler counter
Item
SPEED
DF
OUTPUT
CASETTE1
CASETTE2
IMC MEM
PRINTER
PS3
NIC
SCANNER
FAX
FAX MEM
HAND SET
Display items
23CPM/27CPM/26CPM
NONE/[1: SPF]/[2: RSPF]
NONE/[3: Finisher]/[4: Job separator]
NONE/[5: One-step paper feed unit]
NONE/[6: Two-step paper feed unit]
NONE/Expansion memory capacity (MB)
NONE/[7: PRINTER]
NONE/[8: PS3]
NONE/[9: NIC]
NONE/[10: SCANNER]
NONE/[11: FAX]
NONE/Memory capacity (MB)
NONE/[12: Handset]
RSPF
Finisher
Item
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Job separator
1 tray paper feed unit
2 tray paper feed unit
PRINTER
PS3
NIC
SCANNER
FAX
Handset
Model code
AR-RP7
AR-FN5N
AR-F14 (Saddle finisher)
AR-TR3
AR-D21 (*1)
AR-D22 (*1)
AR-P17
AR-PK1
AR-NC5J
AR-NS2
AR-FX7
AR-HN4
*1: The number of installed units is displayed beside the model code.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 18
Error code
DFD_ND
DFD_ST
RDD_ND
RDD_ST
JAM_REV
Name
SPF/RSPF paper in
lead edge jam
SPF/RSPF paper in
rear edge jam
SPF/RSPF paper
out lead edge jam
SPF P-IN
sensor
SPF P-IN
sensor
SPF P-IN
sensor
SPF/RSPF paper
out rear edge jam
SPF/RSPF duplex
reverse jam
SPF P-OUT
sensor
SPF P-IN
sensor
Section
Item
FAX
Counter
Sensor name
SPF P-IN
sensor
SPF P-OUT
sensor
SPF P-IN
sensor
Paper Reached/
Not Reached to
the sensor
Not Reached
Reached
Reached,
P_OUT Not
Reached
Reached, P_IN
passed (OFF)
Not Reached
(Paper after
reversing)
Passed (OFF at
JAM)
Reached
Reached
Operation/procedure
Used to display the FAX send/receive counter.
FAX SEND PAGE/TIME
FAX RECEIVE PAGE/TIME
FAX OUTPUT
22-13
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Item
Specifications
Operation/Procedure
22-12
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Item
00
01
02
03
04
05
06
99
Content
Not fixed.
AR-A
AR-B
AR-C
DM (VER)
DM (WEB)
CHINA
Conversion completed.
Operation/procedure
Used to display the SPF/RSPF jam history data sequentially from the
latest one.
Forty SPF/RSPF jam histories are displayed sequentially from the latest.
22-19
Purpose
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 19
24-3
Purpose
Data clear
Function
Used to clear the number data of use of the staple, the
(Purpose) SPF/RSPF and scanning.
Section
Transport/Finisher
Item
Counter
Operation/procedure
24
24-1
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Data clear
Used to clear the misfeed counter, the misfeed history,
the trouble counter, and the trouble history. (The
counters are cleared after completion of maintenance.)
Section
Memory
Item
Counter
Operation/procedure
Jam/trouble counter is cleared individually. (The history of each
counter is deleted when clearing)
Item
SPF
SCAN
STAPLE
Content
SPF/RSPF counter
Scan counter
Stapler counter
Item
JAM
SPF JAM
TROUBLE
Content
JAM counter/JAM history
SPF/RSPF JAM counter/SPF/RSPF JAM history
Trouble counter/Trouble history
24-4
Purpose
Data clear
Function (Purpose) Used to reset the maintenance counter.
Item
Counter
Operation/procedure
1. Press the [START] key. The confirmation menu is shown.
2. Select "1: YES."
1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
24-2
Purpose
Data clear
Function
Used to clear the number of use (the number of prints)
(Purpose) of each paper feed section.
Section
Paper feed
Item
Counter
Operation/procedure
Used to clear each paper feed counter individually.
1. Select the counter to be cleared with the 10-key.
2. Press the [START] key. The confirmation menu is shown.
3. Select "1: YES."
1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
1
2
3
4
5
Item
BYPASS
TRAY1
TRAY2
TRAY3
TRAY4
Content
Manual feed counter
Tray 1 counter
Tray 2 counter
Tray 3 counter
Tray 4 counter
24-5
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Data clear
Used to reset the developer counter. (The developer
counter of the DV unit which is installed is reset.)
Image process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/
Cleaning)
Developer/Toner hopper
Counter
Developer
Operation/procedure
1. Press the [START] key.
The confirmation menu is shown.
2. Select "1: YES."
1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 20
24-10
24-6
Purpose
Data clear
Function (Purpose) Used to clear the copy counter.
Item
Counter
Copier
Operation/procedure
1. Press the [START] key.
The confirmation menu is shown.
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation/procedure
1. Select the "3: NUMBER OF PRINTS", and press the [START] key.
The confirmation menu is shown.
1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
1
2
24-7
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Data clear
FAX counter data clear
FAX
Counter
3
Data clear
Used to clear the OPC drum (membrane decrease)
correction counter. (This simulation is executed when
the OPC drum is replaced.
Image process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/
Cleaning)
Photo conductor
Counter
Operation/procedure
1. Press the [START] key.
The confirmation menu is shown.
2. Select "1: YES."
1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
Item
FAX SEND
(PAGE & TIME)
FAX RECEIVE
(PAGE & TIME)
FAX OUTPUT
Content
FAX send page and time
FAX receive page and time
FAX output (number of prints)
24-15
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Data clear
Used to clear the scanner counter in the network
scanner mode.
Scanner section
Counter
Operation/procedure
1. Press the [START] key.
The confirmation menu is shown.
2. Select "1: YES."
1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
The scanner mode counter and the number of send of the scanner are
cleared.
24-9
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Data clear
Used to clear the printer counter and other counters.
(The counter is cleared after completion of
maintenance.)
Printer
Counter
Printer
Operation/procedure
1. Select the counter to be cleared with the 10-key.
2. Press the [START] key.
The confirmation menu is shown.
25
Item
PRINTER
IMC
DUPLEX
OTHERS
25-1
Content
Printer counter
IMC counter
DUPLEX counter
The other counters
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to check the operation of the main drive
(excluding the scanner section) and to check the
operation of the toner concentration sensor. (The toner
concentration sensor output can be monitored.) (To be
supported for Ver.00.72 or later)
DRIVE
Operation
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 21
Operation/procedure
"EU ERROR"
Error content:
25-2
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Setting
Used to make the initial setting of toner concentration
when replacing developer.
Image process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/
Cleaning)
Developer/Toner hopper
Operation/procedure
1) Open the cover with the power OFF.
2) Turn on the power. (Since the cover is open, the machine does not
perform initializing.)
3) Install the developing tank.
26
26-1
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Setting
Used to set whether the job separator is installed or
not. (Since this cannot be detected by hardware
detection, it is set in this simulation.)
Item
Specifications
Option
Operation/procedure
1. Select the set value with the 10-key.
Connection option
None (default)
Job separator provided.
26-2
Purpose
Setting
Function
Used to set whether the automatic detection of paper
(Purpose) size is made or not.
Section
Paper feed
Item
Specifications
Operation/procedure
1. Select the item with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
Used to set the automatic size detection.
2. Set whether automatic detection of paper size is made or not with
the 10-key.
1:B4/LG,FC
Setup
Detection invalid
Detection valid
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 22
Remarks
Default
Document table/RSPF
Destination
Document size
AB series (Japan)
FC (8.5 x 13)
LG (8.5 x 14)
B4
FC (8.5 x 13)
LG (8.5 x 14)
B4
FC (8.5 x 13)
LG (8.5 x 14)
B4
FC (8.5 x 13)
LG (8.5 x 14)
B4
FC (8.5 x 13)
LG (8.5 x 14)
B4
FC (8.5 x 13)
LG (8.5 x 14)
B4
AB series
Inch series
Paper
All destinations
Japan (AB series)
AB series
Inch series
Set value
0
1
(Invalid)
(Valid)
B4
B4
B4
B4
B4
B4
B4
FC (8.5 x 13)
B4
FC (8.5 x 13)
B4
FC (8.5 x 13)
LG (8.5 x 14) FC (8.5 x 13)
LG (8.5 x 14) FC (8.5 x 13)
WLT (11 x 17) WLT (11 x 17)
Set with key operations.
LG (8.5 x 14)
LG (8.5 x 14)
LG (8.5 x 14)
LG (8.5 x 14)
B4
B4
LG (8.5 x 14) FC (8.5 x 13)
LG (8.5 x 14) FC (8.5 x 13)
B4
B4
LG (8.5 x 14) FC (8.5 x 13)
LG (8.5 x 14) FC (8.5 x 13)
B4
B4
Setup
Detection invalid
Detection valid
Remarks
Default
Document table/RSPF
Destination
Document size
AB series
Inch series
Paper
All destinations
All destinations
A4
LT (8.5 x 11)
A4
LT (8.5 x 11)
Set value
0
1
(Invalid)
(Valid)
A4
LT (8.5 x 11)
A4
LT (8.5 x 11)
LT (8.5 x 11)
A4
LT (8.5 x 11)
A4
Set with key operations.
Regardless of the simulation setup.
2) When SIM 26-6 destination setting is set to "0: Japan," duplex copy
inhibit setting must be set to "0: ON (Inhibit)."
26-3
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Setting
Used to set the specifications of the auditor. Setting
must be made depending on the use condition of the
auditor.
Section
Auditor
Item
Specifications
Operation/procedure
Select the mode corresponding to the auditor specification mode with
the 10-key.
Item
Content
Setting
range
0-2
Default
0 P10
Built-in auditor mode
0
Coin vendor mode
1 VENDOR
2 OTHER
Others
When "1: VENDOR (Coin vendor mode)" is set, the following three
items of key operation setting are changed.
1) Set the LCD backlight change inhibit to "1: OFF (Enable)."
26-5
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Item
Setting
Used to set the count mode of the total counter and the
maintenance counter.
Specifications
Counter
Operation/procedure
Used to set the count up number (1 or 2) when an A3/WLT paper
passes through.
For the drum counter and the developer counter, double count is
employed unconditionally.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 23
Item
TOTAL COUNTER
MAINTENANCE COUNTER
When the scanner is not set and the scanner trial counter value is less
than 500, if "1" is entered in SIM26-10, the trial mode setting is started.
If "0" is entered in SIM26-10, the trial mode setting is canceled.
Content
Total
Maintenance
After recognition of the scanner, the trial mode setting cannot be made.
(Entering "1" is invalid and a beep sound is produced.)
Item
1:SINGLE COUNT
2:DOUBLE COUNT
Content
Single count
Double count
Setting range
1-2
Default
2
When this setting is made, the machine must be reset after canceling
the simulation. When "1: Trial mode start" is selected, the scanner
function is valid. If "0: Trial mode cancel" is selected, the scanner function is invalid.
When setting is invalid (when the scanner is recognized or the scanner
trial counter value is 500 or more) in the key operations of the trail
mode setting, an invalid sound (beep sound) is made. In the other
case, a valid sound is made.
* When the scanner trial counter value is changed from 500 or more to
less than 500, the trail setting is changed from "END" to "SETTING
START."
Note: Executable only when the PCL/SCANNER is installed.
26-6
Purpose
Setting
Function
Used to set the specifications depending on the
(Purpose) destination.
Item
Specifications
Destination
Operation/procedure
Select the destination with the 10-key.
By changing the destination, some other setting items may be
changed.
Item
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
JAPAN
SEC
SECL
SEEG
SUK
SCA
SEF
INEG
ABEG
INEF
ABEF
CHINESE
TAIWAN
SEEG2
Setting
range
0-13
Content
Japan
SEC
SECL
SEEG
SUK
SCA
SEF
EX inch series
EX AB series
EX inch series (FC)
EX AB series (FC)
China
Taiwan
SEEG2
Default
0
26-12
Purpose
Setting
Function
Used to input the Software Key for E-MAIL RIC.
(Purpose)
Section
E-MAIL RIC
Item
Specifications
Operation/procedure
The current setup is displayed with ON or OFF.
Enter an input (20 digits) of the E-MAIL RIC soft key with the 10-key
and press the [START] key, and the collating result is displayed with
OK or NG.
After canceling the simulation, if OK, the E-MAIL RIC function is
enable; if NG, the E-MAIL RIC function is disabled.
This setting must be reset after the simulation cancel.
* If recognition is OK, the E-Mail RIC can be set to Enable. If the FAX
is installed, however, the operation cannot be made actually.
Note: Executable only when the PCL/NIC is installed.
26-14
26-10
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Operation/procedure
Setting
Network scanner trial mode setting
Scanner
Enter the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
0
1
Item
END
START
Content
Trail mode cancel
Trial mode start
Purpose
Setting
Function
Used to input the Software Key for the PS extention kit.
(Purpose)
Section
Printer
Item
Specifications
Operation/procedure
Default
0
Enter an input (20 digits) of the PS expansion kit soft key with the 10key and press the [START] key, and the collating result is displayed
with OK or NG.
After canceling the simulation, if OK, the PS expansion kit function is
enable; if NG, the PS expansion kit function is disabled.
If the trial scanner counter value is less than 500, the trial mode setting
can be repeatedly made. If the scanner trial counter value is 500 or
more, the trial mode setting cannot be made.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 24
26-18
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Item
Setting
Used to set enable/disable of toner save operation.
Specifications
Operation/procedure
Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
Item
0
1
OFF
ON
Content
Disable
Enable
Setting
range
0-1
Default
0
26-30
Purpose
Setting
Function
Used to set ON/OFF of the heater lamp slow-up
(Purpose) control conforming to the CE mark control.
Item
Specifications
Operation mode (Common)
Operation/procedure
Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
This setup varies in connection with SIM 26-6 (Destination setup).
Item
0
1
OFF
ON
Default
Japan, SEC, SECL,
SCA, SEF, Taiwan
0
Others
1
26-22
Purpose
Setting
Function
Used to set the specification (language display) for the
(Purpose) destination.
Item
Specifications
Operation/procedure
Select the display language (language code) with the 10-key according
to the table below, and press the [START] key.
This setup varies in connection with SIM 26-6 (Destination setup).
Language
ASIC
Remarks
code
expression
0 JAPANESE
ja
6A 61
1 ENG.US
en
65 6E
2 ENG.UK
gb
67 62
3 FRENCH
fr
66 72
4 GERMAN
de
64 65
5 ITALY
it
69 74
6 DUTCH
nl
6E 6C
7 SWEDISH
sv
73 76
8 SPANISH
es
65 73
9 PORTUGUESE
pt
70 74
10 TURKISH
tr
74 72
11 GREEK
el
65 6C
12 POLISH
pl
70 6C
13 HUNGARIAN
hu
68 75
14 CZECH
cs
63 73
15 RUSSIAN
ru
72 75
16 FINNISH
fi
66 69
17 NORWEGIAN
no
6E 6F
18 DANISH
da
64 61
19 CHINESE
zh
7A 68
20 TAIWANESE
tw
74 77
Traditional Chinese
supported locally
21 SLOVAK
sk
73 6B
22 HEBREW
he
68 65
Supported locally
Item
26-35
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Setup
Used to set whether the same continuous troubles are
displayed as one trouble or the series of troubles with
SIM 22-4 when the same troubles occur continuously.
Item
Specifications
Operation/procedure
Enter the set value with 10-key, and press [START] key.
0
Item
ONCE
ANY
Content
When two or more troubles occur, only one
is registered.
All the troubles occurred are registered.
Default
0
26-36
Purpose
Setting
Function
Used to set whether the machine is stopped or not
(Purpose) when the maintenance counter life is expired.
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
0
1
Item
STOP
NON STOP
Content
Stop
Non stop
Default
1
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 25
26-41
26-57
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Purpose
Setting
Function (Purpose) Used to set the model code.
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
Setting
Used to set ON/OFF of the automatic magnification
ratio selection (AMS) when setting the binding
function.
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
0
1
Item
OFF
ON
Content
AMS is not set automatically.
AMS is set automatically.
Default
0
Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Item
AR-M236
AR-M276
AR-M237
AR-M277
AR-266S
AR-266G
AR-266FG
AR-266FP
Default
1
26-46
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Setting
Used to set whether to meet with the output direction of
images regardless of the mode when installing the
finisher.
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
When this setting is made, the image output direction in the staple
mode and that in the normal mode become the same. Therefore, the
user who uses printed paper (logo, house style, etc) need not change
the original direction in the staple mode. (When the finisher is used,
images are rotated 180 degrees in the staple mode.)
Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
0
Item
OFF
ON
Content
No setting (The output image direction is
changed in the staple mode of the finisher.)
Setting (The output image direction is the
same regardless of stapling or not.)
Default
0
26-60
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Setting
Used to set enable/disable of the FAX mode key when
FAX is not installed. (When FAX is installed, the FAX
mode is enabled regardless of this setup.)
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
Item
0
ON
OFF
Content
Effective (The message with
FAX uninstalled is displayed.)
Disable (Error Beep)
Default
JAPAN,
SEC, SECL, Others
SUK, SCA
0
1
Setting
Used to set ON/OFF of the black and white reversion
function.
Operation
Operation/procedure
26-71
Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
Item
0 ON
1 OFF
Content
Enable
Disable
Default
0
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Setting
In the power save time setting, the pre-heat (pre-heat
mode setting) and the auto power shut off time can be
set to the short time setup (pre-heat: 1 min, auto power
shut off: 4 min) and the long time setup (pre-heat:
15min, auto power shut off: 60min).
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 26
Operation/procedure
Select the short time setup or the long time setup of the pre-heat time
and the auto power shut off time with the 10-key, and press the
[START] key.
Item
1
2
Content
Pre-heat: 1min, auto power shut off: 4min
Preheat: 15min, auto power shut off: 60min
Default
2
Note: When the sub code 71 is entered to display the setting menu,the
default values are always displayed. (However,the default time is
not always set.)
30
30-1
Purpose
Operation test/check
Function
Used to display the sensor status attached to the
(Purpose) machine.
Section
Others
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.
27
27-1
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Setting
Used to set PC/MODEM communication trouble (U700) detection Yes/No.
Communication (RIC/MODEM)
Specifications
Operation mode
(Common)
Operation/procedure
PPD1H
PPD1L
PPD2
POD1
DVCH
DRST
DSWR1
SFTHP
POD2
TOPF
DSWR0
LOEMP
DUP2
Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
0
Item
OFF
ON
Content
In case of the communication trouble, U7-00 is
not displayed.
In case of the communication trouble, U7-00 is
displayed.
Default
0
30-2
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Operation test/check
Used to display the status of the sensors attached to
the standard cassette and the manual feed tray. (Use
SIM 4-2 for the option cassettes.)
The sensor of an uninstalled cassette is not displayed.
Section
Paper feed
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.
27-5
Purpose
Setting
Function (Purpose) Used to set the tag number.
Item
Data
Operation/procedure
1. The currently set number is displayed on the PRESENT column.
2. Enter the new tag number (Max. 8 digits) with the 10-key.
The entered number is displayed on the NEW column.
3. Press the [START] key.
The set value is stored and "PRESENT" is revised.
PED1
LUD1
CD1
PED2
LUD2
CD2
PFD2
DSWR2
MPED
MPLS1
MPLS2
MPLD1
MPLD2
Width detection size of the manual feed tray (one of them is displayed.)
A4/A3, LT/WLT, B5/B4, INV/LTR, A5/A4R, B5R, POSTCARD, EXTRA,
8K/16K
(At detection, highlighted)
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 27
Operation/procedure
40
40-1
Purpose
Operation test/check
Function
Used to check the sensor of the machine manual feed
(Purpose) tray.
Section
Paper feed
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
41
41-1
Width detection size of the manual feed tray (one of them is displayed.)
A4/A3, LT/WLT, B5/B4, INV/LTR, A5/A4R, B5R, POSTCARD, EXTRA,
8K/16K
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to check the document size detection photo
sensor.
Others
Operation
Operation/procedure
The operation status of the sensors and detectors in the original size
detection section are displayed. The active sensors and detectors are
highlighted.
OCSW
40-2
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
PD1 to 5
Adjustment
Used to adjust the manual paper feed tray paper width
detector detection level.
Paper feed
Operation
Operation/procedure
The adjustment method is of the 4-point system. Set the guide to Max.
(A3/WLetter) position, A4R/Letter R position, A5R/Invoice R position,
and Min. position for adjustment.
1) Set A3/W Letter and fit the guide, then press the [START] key.
2) Set A4R/LetterR and fit the guide, then press the [START] key.
41-2
3) Set to A5R/INVOICE R and fit the guide, then press the [START]
key.
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Yes
No
Yes
No
MID-L ADJ.ON
MID-L ADJ.OFF
NID-S ADJ.ON
MID-S ADJ.OFF
Inch series
Adjustment
Used to adjust the detection level of the document size
photo sensor.
Others
Operation
Operation/procedure
Place an A3 (or WLT) document on the document table, and press
[START] key with the OC cover open.
The adjustment is performed and the result is displayed.
OCSW
1 to 5
40-3
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Adjustment
The AD conversion value of manual feed width
detection is displayed.
Paper feed
Operation
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 28
Operation/procedure
41-3
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Operation test/check
Used to check the light reception level and the
detection level of the original size detection photo
sensor.
Section
Others
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
The detection output level of each sensor is displayed in real time.
OCSW
1 to 5
600dpi
600dpi
Setting
range
155-200
2
3
4
1200dpi
POST CARD
CARDBOARD
1200dpi
Postcard
Thick paper
140-200
155-200
155-200
Item
Content
Default
190 (Europe)/
175 (Japan, SEC,
SECL)/
185 (Others)
165
190
190
43-10
41-4
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Adjustment
Used to adjust the detection level of OC 20 degrees.
Others
Operation
Operation/procedure
Set the OC cover at 20 degrees detection and press the [START] key.
The detection output level of each sensor is displayed in real time.
OCSW
1 to 5
Purpose
Setting
Function
Used to set the paper feed cycle timing when printing
(Purpose) postcards.
Section
Paper feed
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
Setting range
Default
1-99
50
44
44-1
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Setting
Used to make various setups in each mode of process
control.
Image process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/
Cleaning)
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
Item
Content
1 ENVIRONMENT
Environmental correction Allow/
ADJ.
Inhibit (0: Inhibit, 1: Allow)
2 DUPLEX PRINT ADJ. Duplex print correction Allow/
Inhibit (0: Inhibit, 1: Allow)
43
43-1
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Setting
Used to set the fusing temperature in 600dpi, 1200dpi,
or postcard print.
Fixing (Fusing)
Operation
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 29
Default
1
0
Item
44-34
Purpose
Setting
Function
Used to set the transfer current value in each mode.
(Purpose)
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the item to be set.
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
To support an individual necessity in paper and the environment, it is
variable in the range of 5 to 30uA in the increment of 1uA in each
mode.
When changing +V2, check with +V1 unchanged. If there is any trouble
in the half tone image of graphics, keep the relationship between +V1
and +V2 at the default and change it.
When the image quality is deteriorated because the user selects the
OHP mode and use other than the recommended OHP, decrease the
transfer current to adjust deterioration of black background picture
quality. If some of characters are not printed, increase the transfer current.
This setting is changed in linkage with SIM 26-6 destination setting.
*1: SECL/SCA/SEF/EX inch series/EX AB series/EX inch series (FC)/
EX AB series (FC)/China/Taiwan/SEEG2
*2: SEC/SEEG/SUK
Item
1 +V1F (600)
Content
Setting Default
range *1 *2
5-30
5 5
5-30
5-30
18 20
5-30
14 18
5-30
5-30
5-30
22 22
5-30
18 18
5-30
5-30
14 14
5-30
5-30
18 18
5-30
5-30
18 18
5-30
Content
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 30
Setting Default
range *1 *2
5-30 18 18
5-30
5-30
18 18
5-30
5-30
18 18
5-30
5-30
5-30
5-30
5-30
5 5
14 14
5 5
18 18
5 5
5-30
26 26
5-30
5-30
26 26
5-30
5-30
5-30
12 14
5-30
10 10
5-30
5-30
5-30
14 14
5-30
12 12
5-30
5-30
10 10
5-30
5-30
12 12
5-30
5-30
12 12
5-30
5-30
12 12
5-30
5-30
12 12
5-30
5-30
12 12
Item
Content
Setting Default
range *1 *2
5-30
5 5
5-30
8 8
5-30
5 5
5-30
12 12
1200dpi postcard/envelope
> 100mm +V1
1200dpi postcard/envelope
> 100mm +V2
1200dpi postcard/envelope
100mm +V1
1200dpi postcard/envelope
100mm +V2
5-30
5-30
16 16
5-30
5-30
16 16
46
46-2
Purpose
Adjustment
Function
Used to set the exposure level in each exposure mode.
(Purpose)
Item
Picture quality
Density
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the item to be adjusted. (Automatic adjustment)
The currently set value is highlighted beside the adjustment item.
2. Press the [START] key.
The display is shifted to the copy menu.
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
Use the 10-key to set the exposure level.
4. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started.
(Exposure mode)
Item
44-35
Purpose
Setting
Function
Used to set the DV-Bias/Grid environment (low
(Purpose) temperature) correction temperature.
Operation/procedure
Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
Correction is performed when the temperature sensor installed to the
MCU indicates 15C or below.
The content of correction is to raise the DVB-Bias and Grid by 50V.
The simulation allows to vary the correction threshold value in the
range of 0 to 20C.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
AE
TEXT
TEXT/PHOTO
PHOTO
SUPER PHOTO
AE(TS)
TEXT(TS)
TEXT/PHOTO(TS)
Setting
Default
range
1-99
50
Content
AE
Character
Level 3.0
Character/Photo
Level 3.0
Photo
Level 3.0
Super photo
Level 3.0
AE (TS)
Character (TS)
Level 3.0
Character/Photo (TS)
Level 3.0
If, however, the set temperature is increased, correction at a high voltage is performed in normal temperatures.
Setting range
Default
0-20
15C
44-40
46-7
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Setting
Used to set the time from the start of the main motor
rotation (Ready) to the start of toner supply in previous
rotation after turning on the power.
Operation/procedure
Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
Set the toner supply previous rotation time.
Setting range
Default
1-99 (sec)
4 (sec)
Adjustment
Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination
value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode
(Super Photo).
Item
Picture quality
Density
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.
2. Press the [START] key.
The display is shifted to the copy menu.
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
Use the 10-key to set the exposure level.
4. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 31
1.0(SHIFT)
1.0(GAMMA)
2.0(SHIFT)
2.0(GAMMA)
3.0(SHIFT)
3.0(GAMMA)
4.0(SHIFT)
4.0(GAMMA)
5.0(SHIFT)
5.0(GAMMA)
Content
Super photo level 1.0 (shift qty)
Super photo level 1.0 (slant)
Super photo level 2.0 (shift qty)
Super photo level 2.0 (slant)
Super photo level 3.0 (shift qty)
Super photo level 3.0 (slant)
Super photo level 4.0 (shift qty)
Super photo level 4.0 (slant)
Super photo level 5.0 (shift qty)
Super photo level 5.0 (slant)
Setting
Default
range
1-99
32
1-99
50
1-99
41
1-99
50
1-99
50
1-99
50
1-99
56
1-99
61
1-99
62
1-99
66
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display returns to the initial
menu but the machine is not reset.
Item
Content
Setting
range
1-99
Default
14 TS 2.0
Character (TS) level 2.0
47
(GAMMA)
(slant)
15 TS 3.0 (SHIFT) Character (TS) level 3.0
1-99
50
(shift qty)
16 TS 3.0
Character (TS) level 3.0
1-99
50
(GAMMA)
(slant)
17 TS 4.0(SHIFT) Character (TS) level 4.0
1-99
61
(shift qty)
18 TS 4.0
Character (TS) level 4.0
1-99
55
(GAMMA)
(slant)
19 TS 5.0 (SHIFT) Character (TS) level 5.0
1-99
72
(shift qty)
20 TS 5.0
Character (TS) level 5.0
1-99
60
(GAMMA)
(slant)
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display returns to the initial
menu but the machine is not reset.
46-9
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Adjustment
Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination
value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode
(Text).
Item
Picture quality
Density
Operation/procedure
46-10
Adjustment
Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination
value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode
(Text/Photo).
Item
Picture quality
Operation/procedure
Content
Setting
range
1-99
Default
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
22
Item
1-99
1-99
44
36
1-99
1-99
47
50
1-99
1-99
50
61
1-99
1-99
55
72
1-99
1-99
60
22
1-99
44
1-99
36
1 1.0 (SHIFT)
2 1.0 (GAMMA)
3 2.0 (SHIFT)
4 2.0 (GAMMA)
5 3.0 (SHIFT)
6 3.0 (GAMMA)
7 4.0 (SHIFT)
8 4.0 (GAMMA)
9 5.0 (SHIFT)
Content
Character/Photo level 1.0
(shift qty)
Character/Photo level 1.0
(slant)
Character/Photo level 2.0
(shift qty)
Character/Photo level 2.0
(slant)
Character/Photo level 3.0
(shift qty)
Character/Photo level 3.0
(slant)
Character/Photo level 4.0
(shift qty)
Character/Photo level 4.0
(slant)
Character/Photo level 5.0
(shift qty)
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 32
Setting
Default
range
1-99
30
1-99
37
1-99
40
1-99
43
1-99
50
1-99
50
1-99
57
1-99
61
1-99
64
Item
Setting
Default
range
1-99
66
Content
46-12
Purpose
Adjustment
Function
FAX exposure level adjustment (1 mode automatic
(Purpose)
adjustment)
Section
FAX
Item
Image quality
Operation/procedure
1. Select "1: COPY START."
The currently set value is displayed beside the item.
2. Enter the set value of the exposure level with the 10-key, and
press the [#/P] key.
3. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started and the set value is stored.
Normal display
Error display
NOW PRINTING
DOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY
Item
COPY START
FAX EXP.LEVEL
Setting range
0-99
Default
50
Adjustment
Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination
value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode
(Photo).
Picture quality
Density
1
50
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.
2. Press the [START] key.
The display is shifted to the copy menu.
Purpose
Adjustment
Function
FAX exposure level adjustment (Normal mode
(Purpose) individual adjustment)
Section
FAX
Item
Image quality
Operation/procedure
1.0(SHIFT)
1.0(GAMMA)
2.0(SHIFT)
2.0(GAMMA)
3.0(SHIFT)
3.0(GAMMA)
4.0(SHIFT)
4.0(GAMMA)
5.0(SHIFT)
5.0(GAMMA)
Content
Photo level 1.0 (shift qty)
Photo level 1.0 (slant)
Photo level 2.0 (shift qty)
Photo level 2.0 (slant)
Photo level 3.0 (shift qty)
Photo level 3.0 (slant)
Photo level 4.0 (shift qty)
Photo level 4.0 (slant)
Photo level 5.0 (shift qty)
Photo level 5.0 (slant)
46-13
Setting
range
1-99
Default
32
50
41
50
50
50
56
61
62
66
NOW PRINTING
DOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display returns to the initial
menu but the machine is not reset.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 33
Item
1 COPY START
2 EXP.LEVEL
Content
Setting range
Copy start
Exposure level
selection
0-99
3 AE
Normal text AE
4 MANUAL
Normal text MANUAL
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
Default
2. Enter the set value of the exposure level with the 10-key, and
press the [#/P] key.
3. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started and the set value is stored.
50
Normal display
Error display
NOW PRINTING
DOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY
Item
46-14
Purpose
Adjustment
Function
FAX exposure level adjustment (Fine text mode
(Purpose) individual adjustment)
Section
FAX
Item
Image quality
Operation/procedure
Content
1
2
3
COPY START
EXP.LEVEL
AE (PHOTO ON)
4
5
AE (PHOTO OFF)
MANUAL
(PHOTO ON)
MANUAL
(PHOTO OFF)
Copy start
Exposure level selection
Super Fine AE (Half
tone)
Super Fine AE
Super Fine MANUAL
(Half tone)
Super Fine MANUAL
Setting
range
Default
0 - 99
50
50
50
50
NOW PRINTING
DOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY
50
46-16
Content
1
2
COPY START
EXP.LEVEL
3
4
5
AE (PHOTO ON)
AE (PHOTO OFF)
MANUAL (PHOTO
ON)
MANUAL (PHOTO
OFF)
Copy start
Exposure level
selection
Fine text AE (Half tone)
Fine text AE
Fine text MANUAL (Half
tone)
Fine text MANUAL
Setting
Default
range
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Adjustment
FAX exposure level adjustment (Ultra Fine mode
individual adjustment)
FAX
Image quality
Operation/procedure
1. Select "1: COPY START."
The currently set value is displayed beside the item.
0-99
50
2. Enter the set value of the exposure level with the 10-key, and
press the [#/P] key.
3. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started and the set value is stored.
Normal display
Error display
NOW PRINTING
DOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY
46-15
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Adjustment
FAX exposure level adjustment (Super Fine mode
individual adjustment)
FAX
Image quality
1
2
3
COPY START
EXP.LEVEL
AE (PHOTO ON)
4
5
AE (PHOTO OFF)
MANUAL
(PHOTO ON)
MANUAL
(PHOTO OFF)
Content
Copy start
Exposure level selection
Ultra Fine AE (Half
tone)
Ultra Fine AE
Ultra Fine MANUAL
(Half tone)
Ultra Fine MANUAL
Operation/procedure
1. Select "1: COPY START."
The currently set value is displayed beside the item.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 34
Setting
range
0 - 99
Default
50
Item
AE MODE
(1:EXPOSURE
2:TONER)
2 AE STOP(COPY)
(0:FIXED
1:REAL TIME)
3 AE STOP(FAX)
(0:FIXED
1:REAL TIME)
4 AE STOP(SCAN)
(0:FIXED
1:REAL TIME)
* Auto exposure mode
1
1
50
50
50
50
46-18
Purpose
Adjustment
Function
Used to adjust inclination for each exposure mode.
(Purpose)
Item
Picture quality
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
The adjustment item and the current set value are highlighted.
2. Press the [START] key.
The display is shifted to the copy menu.
Content
Auto exposure mode*
(1: Priority on Image quality,
2: Priority on toner consumption)
Auto exposure STOP mode
(COPY)
(0: Fixed, 1: Real-time)
Auto exposure STOP mode (FAX)
(0: Fixed, 1: Real-time)
Default
2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Setting
range
1-99
Content
AE
TEXT
TEXT/PHOTO
PHOTO
SUPER PHOTO
AE(TS)
TEXT(TS)
TEXT/PHOTO(TS)
AE
Character
Default
50
Level 3.0
Character/Photo
Level 3.0
Photo
Level 3.0
Super photo
Level 3.0
AE(TS)
Character (TS)
Level 3.0
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display returns to the initial
menu but the machine is not reset.
46-20
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Item
Adjustment
Used to set the exposure correction value of SPF/
RSPF for OC exposure.
Picture quality
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
1
2
Item
SPF EXPOSURE
RSPF EXPOSURE
Content
SPF
RSPF
Setting range
1-99
Default
53
46-19
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Item
Adjustment
Used to set the control method of the exposure mode.
46-30
Picture quality
Purpose
Setting
Function
Used to set the AE and the limit value in AE (Toner
(Purpose) save).
Operation/procedure
3. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key, and press the [START]
key.
Operation/procedure
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 35
1
2
Item
AE
AE(TS)
Setting range
0-31
Default
0
48
48-1
Purpose
Adjustment
Function
Used to adjust the copy mode magnification ratio (main
(Purpose) scanning direction, sub scanning direction).
Section
Image processing
Item
Picture quality
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the item to be set.
The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
2. Press the [START] key.
The display is shifted to the copy menu.
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density, and enter the
adjustment value with the 10-key.
46-31
Purpose
Setting
Function
Used to set the AE and the limit value in AE (Toner
(Purpose) save).
Operation/procedure
Content
F-R
SCAN
SPF/RSPF
(SIDE1)
SPF/RSPF
(SIDE2)
DUPLEX
1
2
3
4
5
Item
AE
TEXT
TEXT/PHOTO
PHOTO
SUPER PHOTO
Setting range
Default
0-2
4
5
Setting
range
1-99
Default
50
60
50
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the initial menu, but the machine is not reset.
46-39
48-2
Purpose
Setting
Function
Used to switch the FAX send image quality.
(Purpose)
Enter the set value with the 10-key.
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
0
1
Item
HAIRLINE
PRINTER
Content
Original with pencil lines
and thin lines
Printed original
Setting range
Default
0-1
Adjustment
Used to adjust the scanner mode magnification ratio
(main/sub scanning direction).
Image processing
Picture quality
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the item to be set.
The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
2. Press the [START] key.
The display is shifted to the copy menu.
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density, and enter the
adjustment value with the 10-key.
4. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 36
Item
1
F-R
SCAN
SPF (SIDE1)
SPF (SIDE2)
Setting
range
1-99
Content
Main scanning magnification
ratio adjustment
Sub scanning magnification
ratio adjustment
RSPF surface sub scan
magnification ratio
RSPF back surface sub scan
magnification ratio
1
128
128
128
128
128
128
48-9
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Adjustment
FAX magnification adjustment (print)
FAX
Operation/procedure
1. Select "1: COPY START."
The currently set value is displayed beside the item.
2. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started and the set value is stored.
48-8
Purpose
Adjustment
Function
FAX magnification adjustment (read)
(Purpose)
Section
FAX
Related soft SW SW112-1 to 8, SW113-1 to 8
Operation/procedure
Normal display
Error display
2. Enter the set value of magnification with the 10-key, and press the
[#/P] key.
3. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started and the set value is stored.
Normal display
Error display
NOW PRINTING
DOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY
COPY START
SCAN SELECT
(OC/SPF/RSPF)
OC(MAIN)
OC(SUB)
SPF(MAIN)
SPF(SUB)
RSPF(MAIN)
RSPF(SUB)
Content
Copy start
Scan selection (OC/
SPF/ RSPF)
SCAN Main scanning
magnification ratio
adjustment (OC)
SCAN Sub scanning
magnification ratio
adjustment (OC)
SCAN Main scanning
magnification ratio
adjustment (SPF)
SCAN Sub scanning
magnification ratio
adjustment (SPF)
SCAN Main scanning
magnification ratio
adjustment (RSPF)
SCAN Sub scanning
magnification ratio
adjustment (RSPF)
Setting
range
1-255*
1-255*
NOW PRINTING
DOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY
Default
128
Item
Content
Setting
Default
range
1-255
128
1-255
128
1-255
128
1-255
128
1-255
128
128
128
128
1-255*
128
128
128
1-255*
128
1-255*
128
1-255*
128
1-255*
128
50
50-1
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Item
Adjustment
Used to adjust the copy lead edge position.
Picture quality
Image position
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key and press the [P] key.,
The display goes to the copy menu.
When the [START] key is pressed, the display goes to the copying
state and print is started.
(When the [P] key is pressed: Copy menu)
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
Enter the exposure level with the 10-key.
4. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started.
50-5
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the initial menu, but the machine is not reset.
1. Note down the adjustment value of SIM 50-5 (Items 1, 2, 3, 4), and
change the value to 99.
Purpose
Adjustment
Function
Used to adjust the print image position (top margin) on
(Purpose) the print paper in the print mode.
Item
Picture quality
Print area
Operation/procedure
3. Place a chart with a clear lead edge (or a ruler) on the OC document table.
2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key and press the [P] key.,
The display goes to the copy menu.
When the [START] key is pressed, the display goes to the copying
state and print is started.
(Adjustment procedure)
4. Use SIM 50-1 (Item 1) to execute test print. Check the print out and
adjust so that the lead edge image is printed. (1 - 99: About
0.127mm/Step)
5. Reset the adjustment values of SIM 50-5 (Items 1, 2, 3, 4) to the
original values, and execute test print. Check the print out and
adjust so that the lead edge image is printed on the lead edge of
paper. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step).
6. Adjust SIM 50-1 (Items 2, 3, 4, 5) so that the lead edge void on the
print out is the specified value. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
7. Similar to procedure 6, adjust SIM 50-1 (Item 6, 7) so that the rear
edge void is the specified value. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
8. Similar to procedure 6, adjust SIM 50-1 (Item 8, 9) so that the left
edge void is the specified value. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
9. Make an enlargement copy (400%), and check that there is no
shade of the cabinet printed at the lead edge.
Item
TRAY1
OPTION
MANUAL
DUPLEX
Content
1st cassette
Option cassette
Manual feed
Back print
Setting range
0-99
1-99
Default
53
RRC-A
DEN-A
DEN-A-MANUAL
DEN-A -OPTION
DEN-A -DUPLEX
6
7
DEN-B
DEN-B-DUP
SIDE VOID
SIDE VOID-DUP
10 LOSS(OC)
Content
Original scan start position
adjustment
Lead edge position
adjustment value (OC)
Lead edge cancel
adjustment (Main cassette)
Lead edge cancel
adjustment (Manual feed
cassette)
Lead edge cancel
adjustment (Option cassette)
Lead edge cancel
adjustment (back of the
machine)
Rear edge void adjustment
Rear edge void adjustment
(Duplex)
Left edge void adjustment
(First print surface)
Left edge void adjustment
(Duplex)
Image loss amount
adjustment (Lead edge
image loss set value) (OC)
Setting
Default
range
1-99
43
1-99
18
1-99
18
1-99
18
1-99
18
1-99
1-99
30
50
1-99
18
1-99
18
1-5
50-6
Purpose
Adjustment
Function
Used to adjust the print image position (top margin) on
(Purpose) print paper in the copy mode. (SPF/RSPF)
Item
Picture quality
Image position
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key and press the [P] key.,
The display goes to the copy menu.
When the [START] key is pressed, the display goes to the copying
state and print is started.
(When the [P] key is pressed: Copy menu)
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
Enter the exposure level with the 10-key.
4. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started.
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the initial menu, but the machine is not reset.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 38
Item
Content
1 SIDE1
Setting
range
1-99
Item
Default
50
1-99
50
1-99
50
1-5
1-5
Content
Setting
range
Default
43-57
50
43-57
50
5 REAR
2
50
1-5
1-5
50
50
50-9
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Adjustment
FAX lead edge adjustment (print)
FAX
Operation/procedure
1. Select "1: COPY START."
The currently set value is highlighted beside the item.
2. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started.
Normal display
Error display
50-8
The adjustments on the machine side must have been normally
completed.
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Operation/procedure
Adjustment
FAX lead edge adjustment (read)
FAX
1 COPY START
2 LEAD
Setting
Default
range
43-57
50
43-57
50
43-57
50
43-57
50
43-57
50
43-57
50
Item
NOW PRINTING
DOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY
4 LEFT
Content
Copy start
Scan selection (1: OC, 2:
SPF, 3: RSPF back)
Scan lead edge position
adjustment value of the
selected method in 2.
Scan left edge position
adjustment value of the
selected method in 2.
Setting
range
1-3
NOW PRINTING
DOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY
Default
Content
Copy start
Print lead edge void
adjustment value (Front
surface)
LEFT
Print left edge void
adjustment value (Front
surface)
REAR
Print rear edge void
adjustment value (Front
surface)
LEAD
Print lead edge void
(DUPLEX)
adjustment value (Back
surface)
LEFT (DUPLEX) Print left edge void
adjustment value (Back
surface)
REAR
Print rear edge void
(DUPLEX)
adjustment value (Back
surface)
1
43-57
50
43-57
50
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 39
50-10
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Adjustment
Used to adjust the print image center position.
(Adjustment can be made for each paper feed
section.)
Section
Image processing (ICU)
Item
Picture quality
Image position
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key and press the [P] key.,
The display goes to the copy menu.
When the [START] key is pressed, the display goes to the copying
state and print is started.
51
Item
BYPASS
TRAY1
TRAY2
TRAY3
TRAY4
DUPLEX
Content
Manual feed
1st cassette
2nd cassette
3rd cassette
4th cassette
Back print
Setting range
1-99
Default
50
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Adjustment
Used to adjust the OPC drum separation pawl ON
time.
Image process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/
Cleaning)
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key.
1
2
Item
600dpi
1200dpi
Setting range
1-99
Default
50
50-12
Purpose
Adjustment
Function
Used to adjust the print image center position.
(Purpose) (Adjustment can be made for each document mode.)
Section
Image processing
Item
Picture quality
Image position
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key and press the [P] key.,
The display goes to the copy menu.
When the [START] key is pressed, the display goes to the copying
state and print is started.
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
Enter the exposure level with the 10-key.
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the initial menu, but the machine is not reset.
Content
OC
SPF front surface
SPF back surface
Setting range
1-99
Adjustment
Used to adjust the contact pressure of paper onto the
resist roller in each section (copier paper feed section,
duplex paper feed section, SPF/RSPF paper feed
section). (When the print image position varies greatly
for the paper or when a lot of paper jam troubles occur,
the adjustment is required.)
Section
Paper transport (Discharge/Switchback/Transport)
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
Item
OC
SPF(SIDE1)
SPF(SIDE2)
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
1
2
3
51-2
Default
50
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 40
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Item
BYPASS
TRAY1
TRAY2
TRAY3
TRAY4
DUPLEX
SPF(SIDE1)
SPF(SIDE2)
Content
Manual feed
1st cassette
2nd cassette
3rd cassette
4th cassette
Back print
SPF front surface
SPF back surface
Setting range
1-99
1-99
1-99
1-99
1-99
1-99
1-99
1-99
Default
50
70
50
50
50
70
50
50
53
53-6
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
51-8
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Setting
Used to set the OPC drum separation pawl operation
inhibit. (ON/OFF)
Image process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/
Cleaning)
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
Select the set value with the 10-key.
0
1
Item
ON
OFF
Content
Enable
Disable
Setting range
0-1
Adjustment
Used to adjust the detection level of the SPF/RSPF
width. The adjustment method is the 4-point system.
Set the guide to Max. (A3/WLetter) position, A4R/
Letter R position, A5R/Invoice R position, and Min.
position for adjustment.
Section
SPF/RSPF
Operation/Procedure
(Max. position setting)
1. Set the guide to the maximum position, and press the [START]
key.
Set WLetter and fit the guide, and press the [START] key.
2. Set A4R/Letter R and fit the guide, and press the [START] key.
3. Set A5R/Invoice R and fit the guide, and press the [START] key.
Default
0
4. Set the guide to the minimum position, and press the [START] key.
5. Set the paper recognition width (+), and press the [START] key.
6. Set the paper recognition width (-),and press the [START] key.
If "FAILED" is displayed in the above procedure 1, 2, 3, or 4, repeat the
adjustment.
(Middle position L/S setting)
If the middle position adjustment is not required, press the [START]
key without changing the guide position.
Middle position
adjustment L
51-9
Purpose
Setting
Function
Used to adjust the OPC drum separation voltage ON/
(Purpose) OFF timing.
Section
Process (OPC drum, developing, transfer, cleaning)
Item
Operation
Operation/Procedure
Middle position
adjustment S
YES
NO
YES
NO
AB series
MID-L ADJ.ON
MID-L ADJ.OFF
MID-S ADJ.ON
MID-S ADJ.OFF
Inch series
SHV ON
SHV OFF
Content
Separation voltage ON timing
* Transfer V2ON reference
(Synchronized with the
adjustment value of 50.)
Separation voltage OFF timing
* Transfer V2OFF reference
(Synchronized with the
adjustment value of 50.)
53-7
Setting
range
Default
25-90
50
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Adjustment
Used to enter the SPF/RSPF width detection
adjustment value.
SPF/RSPF
Operation/Procedure
50-90
75
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 41
1
2
3
4
Item
MAX POSITION
POSITION 1
POSITION 2
MIN POSITION
Content
Max. width
Adjustment point 1
Adjustment point 2
Min. width
Setting range
0 - 999
Default
0
63
63-1
Purpose
53-8
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Adjustment
Used to adjust the SPF/RSPF scan position of the
mirror unit automatically. For the SPF/RSPF scan
position automatic adjustment, the mirror unit is shifted
to 11mm before the SPF/RSPF glass cover edge, and
is operated automatically to scan images by the unit of
1 step, detecting the position up to the glass cover
automatically.
(Adjustment value)
Default: 50, Adjustment range: 1 - 99
Adjustment unit: 1 = about 0.12mm
Operation/Procedure
With the SPF/RSPF or the OC cover open, put a black background
chart on the OC glass (the SPF/RSPF glass surface is included for the
SPF/RSPF standard model), and press the [START] key.
If the adjustment is executed normally, the adjustment value is displayed and saved in the EEPROM. If an error occurs, "ERR" is displayed and the value is not saved in the EEPROM.
If the adjustment is not performed because of abnormality, "---" is displayed.
During execution of the adjustment, the operation cannot be interrupted.
63-7
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Adjustment
Used to adjust the SPF/RSPF white correction start
pixel position automatically.
This adjustment is performed after the lens unit is
replaced.
Scanner
Operation
Operation/procedure
Set the SPF/RSPF unit OPEN, and press the [START] key.
[ ] indicates the order number of the pixel of the white sheet for SPF/
RSPF exposure correction in the SPF/RSPF position.
If the adjustment is normally completed, "COMPLETE" is displayed
and data are written into the EEPROM.
In case of an abnormality, "ERROR" is displayed and no data is written
into the EEPROM.
The SPF/RSPF white correction start pixel = Displayed pixel position 34
If the simulation is executed with the SPF/RSPF unit closed, an error is
resulted.
61
61-1
Purpose
Operation test/check
Function
Used to check the LSU (polygon motor) operation.
(Purpose)
Section
LSU
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
Press the [START] key, and the LSU test is performed.
Used to set the LSU to ON state and check that the sync signal
(HSYNC/) is outputted or not.
After operation for 30 sec, the result is displayed. (Interruption cannot
be made for 5 sec after starting the operation.)
64
64-1
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to check the operation of the printer function
(auto print operation).
Printer
Operation
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 42
Operation/procedure
1. Select the print item with the 10-key.
2. Press the [START] key.
The display is shifted to the copy menu.
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
4. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started.
During execution of copying, the [CUSTOM SETTINGS] key and the
[INTERRUPTION] key are invalid.
Item
Content
2 BY 4
MODE
LATTICE
PRINT
Setting
range
1-2
65-5
Purpose
Default
1
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Operation (screen/operation)
Operation/procedure
* If the IMC board is not installed, the key inputs cannot be made.
66
66-1
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
65
65-1
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Adjustment
Used to adjust the touch panel (LCD display section)
detection position.
Operation (Display, Operation)
Setting
Used to change and check the FAX-related soft SW.
FAX
Operation/procedure
1. Enter the soft SW number to be selected with the 10-key.
2. Check and change the setting content of the selected soft SW.
3. Press the [START] key to save the set content.
Operation/Procedure
When the point of "+" on the LCD is pressed, it turns gray. Press all the
four points of "+."
66-2
65-2
Purpose
Purpose
Adjustment
Function
Used to clear the FAX-related soft SW. (Except for the
(Purpose) FAX adjustment values)
Section
FAX
Operation/procedure
1. Enter the country code with the 10-key, and press the [START]
key.
2. When "1: (YES)" is selected, the soft SW corresponding to the
country code is cleared. When "2: (NO)" is selected, the simulation
is canceled.
When the touch panel is pressed, the X-coordinate and the Y-coordinate (dot conversion values) are displayed.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 43
Country code
Japan
U.S.A.
Australia
U.K
France
Germany
Sweden
New Zealand
China
Singapore
TW
Other 1
Other 2
Other 3
: 00000000
: 10110101
: 00001001
: 10110100
: 00111101
: 00000100
: 10100101
: 01111110
: 00100110
: 10011100
: 11111110
: 11111101
: 11111100
: 11111011
66-4
Purpose
Operation test/check
Function
Signal send mode (Signal send level: Max.)
(Purpose)
Section
FAX
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
Select the signal number with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
The signal is sent to the line and the machine speaker. (Sending the
signal is continued until the [CUSTOM SETTINGS] key is pressed.)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
By entering the signal number and pressing the [START] key during
execution, the signal kind can be changed.
0000100 1
Item
66-3
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation/procedure
Operation test/check
FAX PWB memory check
FAX
Operation
Program area
Memory area
Option memory
PAGE
2. Detailed procedure
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
NO SIGNAL
33.6 V34
31.2 V34
28.8 V34
26.4 V34
24.0 V34
16.0 V34
19.2 V34
16.8 V34
14.4 V34
12.0 V34
9.6 V34
7.2 V34
4.8 V34
2.4 V34
14.4 V33
12.0 V33
14.4 V17
12.0 V17
9.6 V17
7.2 V17
9.6 V29
7.2 V29
4.8 V27t
2.4 V27t
0.3 FLG
CED2100
CNG1100
0.3 V21
ANSam
RINGER
32 No MSG
33 No RBT
Send signal
Signal not sent
Send level
Selection
menu
None
Yes
Yes
Pseudo-ringer sound
None
([ON HOOK] key ON)
Voice message (no sound)
None
Under the state where the ring back
tone can be sent to the line, keep the
sound composition IC volume to 0.
Ring back tone (no sound)
None
Under the state where the ring back
tone can be sent to the line, keep the
G/A volume to 0.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 44
Send level
Selection
menu
34 DP MAKE
Dial pulse (make)
1: 0dB
Maintain the make state with keeping 2: Soft SW
the condition to be able to send to the
dial pulse line.
35 DP BRK
Dial pulse (break)
1: 0dB
Maintain the break state with keeping 2: Soft SW
the condition to be able to send to the
dial pulse line.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
Item
Send signal
66-5
Signal number
27
28
29
30
31
CED2100
CNG1100
0.3 V21
ANSam
RINGER
Send signal
Tone signal
Pseudo-ringer sound
([ON HOOK] key ON)
32 No MSG
Voice message (no sound)
Under the state where the ring back
tone can be sent to the line, keep the
sound composition IC volume to 0.
33 No RBT
Ring back tone (no sound)
Under the state where the ring back
tone can be sent to the line, keep the
G/A volume to 0.
34 DP MAKE
Dial pulse (make)
Maintain the make state with keeping
the condition to be able to send to the
dial pulse line.
35 DP BRK
Dial pulse (break)
Maintain the break state with keeping
the condition to be able to send to the
dial pulse line.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
Send level
Selection
menu
Yes
None
None
None
1: 0dB
2: Soft SW
1: 0dB
2: Soft SW
Purpose
Operation test/check
Function
Signal send mode (Signal send level soft SW setting)
(Purpose)
Section
FAX
Item
Operation
Operation/procedure
Select the signal number with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
By setting the signal number, signals are sent to the line and the
machine speaker. (Sending signals is continued until interruption command is made (by pressing [CUSTOM SETTINGS] key.)
By entering the signal number and pressing the [START] key during
execution, the signal kind can be changed.
Signal number
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
NO SIGNAL
33.6 V34
31.2 V34
28.8 V34
26.4 V34
24.0 V34
16.0 V34
19.2 V34
16.8 V34
14.4 V34
12.0 V34
9.6 V34
7.2 V34
4.8 V34
2.4 V34
14.4 V33
12.0 V33
14.4 V17
12.0 V17
9.6 V17
7.2 V17
9.6 V29
7.2 V29
4.8 V27t
2.4 V27t
0.3 FLG
Send signal
Signal not sent
33.6 V34
31.2 V34
28.8 V34
26.4 V34
24.0 V34
16.0 V34
19.2 V34
16.8 V34
14.4 V34
12.0 V34
9.6 V34
7.2 V34
4.8 V34
2.4 V34
14.4 V33
12.0 V33
14.4 V17
12.0 V17
9.6 V17
7.2 V17
9.6 V29
7.2 V29
4.8 V27t
2.4 V27t
7EH Flag signal
Send level
Selection
menu
None
Yes
66-6
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation/procedure
Press the [START] key.
The confidential ID table (confidential BOX numbers, confidential BOX
names, and confidential password) is printed.
The confidential data of My company mode is printed separately.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
66-7
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation/procedure
Press the [START] key.
Used to input all image data (including confidential reception data,
remote send image, not-sent image) stored in image memory of the
FAX section.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 45
66-8
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Item
Voice message
Silent
"Hold the line a minute, please send fax."
(TEL/FAX voice response)
3 FAX/TEL MSG2
"Hold the line a minute."
(TEL/FAX voice response)
4 FAX/TEL MSG3
"Not around here, please send fax."
(TEL/FAX voice response)
5 CHANGED RX MSG "Ding Dong"
(Sound delivered when switching to remote
reception)
6 RINGER
Call sound
7 EXT.TEL RINGER
External telephone call
Message No. 5 can be heard by an external telephone speaker.
1
2
Operation test/check
Voice Message send (Signal send level:
Max.) (Japan only)
FAX
Operation
Item
NONE
FAX/TEL MSG1
Operation/procedure
Select the message number with the 10-key, and press the [START]
key.
By setting the message No., the sound message is sent to the line and
the speaker of the body. (The message is repeated until the interruption command is provided by pressing the [CUSTOM SETTINGS] key.)
By pressing the [START] key during execution, the signal kind can be
changed.
1
2
Item
NONE
FAX/TEL MSG1
FAX/TEL MSG2
FAX/TEL MSG3
CHANGED RX MSG
6
7
RINGER
EXT.TEL RINGER
Voice message
Silent
"Hold the line a minute, please send fax."
(TEL/FAX voice response)
"Hold the line a minute."
(TEL/FAX voice response)
"Not around here, please send fax."
(TEL/FAX voice response)
"Ding Dong"
(Sound delivered when switching to remote
reception)
Call sound
External telephone call
66-10
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Item
Adjustment/Setting/Check
Image data memory clear
FAX
Data
Image data
Operation/procedure
Select "1: YES" with the 10-key and press the [START] key. (When "2:
NO" is selected, the simulation is canceled.)
Used to clear all image data (including confidential reception data)
stored in image memory of the FAX section.
The management table is also cleared (initialized) at the same time.
* lIf there is any print data, the power must be turned off after clearing.
2
66-11
66-9
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to send the voice message. (Signal send level:
Set by soft SW.) (Japan only)
FAX
Operation
Operation/procedure
Select the message number with the 10-key, and press the [START]
key.
By setting the message No., the sound message is sent to the line and
the speaker of the body. (The message is repeated until the interruption command is provided by pressing the [CUSTOM SETTINGS] key.)
By pressing the [START] key during execution, the signal kind can be
changed.
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to send 300bps signals. (Signal send level:
Max.)
FAX
Operation
Operation/procedure
Select the signal number with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
By setting the signal number, the specified signal is delivered to the
line at the speed of 300bps. (The signal is continuously sent until the
interruption command is provided by pressing the [CUSTOM SETTINGS] key.)
The signal send level can be selected from 0dB or the soft SW set
value.
The signal send level is returned to the soft SW set value before execution of the mode after completion of the mode.
By entering the number and pressing the [START] key during execution, the signal kind can be changed.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 46
Item
1 NO SIGNAL
2 11111
3 11110
4 00000
5 010101
6 00001
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
66-14
Purpose
Operation check/test
Function
Used to perform the dial test. (10 PPS send test)
(Purpose)
Section
FAX
Item
Operation
Operation/Procedure
1. Select the item with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
2. Set the make time with the 10-key.
66-12
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Item
EXECUTE
MAKE TIME
Content
Execution
Dial pulse make time setting
Setting range
0-15
Operation/procedure
Select the signal number with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
By setting the signal number, the specified signal is delivered to the
line at the speed of 300bps. (The signal is continuously sent until the
interruption command is provided by pressing the [CUSTOM SETTINGS] key.)
The signal send level can be selected from 0dB or the soft SW set
value.
66-15
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation check/test
Used to perform the dial test. (20 PPS send test)
FAX
Operation
The signal send level is returned to the soft SW set value before execution of the mode after completion of the mode.
Operation/Procedure
By entering the number and pressing the [START] key during execution, the signal kind can be changed.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Item
NO SIGNAL
11111
11110
00000
010101
00001
1. Select the item with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
The dial is sent with the set value + 26ms.
The sending dial cannot be interrupted.
0
1
Item
EXECUTE
MAKE TIME
Content
Execution
Dial pulse make time setting
Setting range
0-15
1
1
66-16
66-13
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Item
Setting
Used to register the dial numbers.
FAX
Operation
Operation/procedure
Purpose
Operation check/test
Function
Used to perform the dial test. (DTFM signal send test)
(Purpose)
Section
FAX
Item
Operation
Operation/Procedure
1. Select the item with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
The sending dial cannot be interrupted.
Enter the number with the 10-key, [*] key, and [#] key.
Press the [CLEAR] key to return to the initial state.
Item
Content
0 EXECUTE
1 HIGH (SW)
2 HIGH-LOW (SW)
3. Select the soft SW reflection.
1
2
Item
NO STORE TO SW
STORE TO SW
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 47
Execution
High group
High group, Low group
Setting
range
0-15
0-15
Content
Not reflected.
Reflected. (Shift SW value changed.)
66-20
1
66-17
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation check/test
Used to check the DTFM signal send operation.
(Signal send level: Max.)
FAX
Operation
Operation/procedure
Purpose
Back up
Function
Used to write the Flash ROM data to the SRAM.
(Purpose)
Section
FAX
Item
Data
Operation/Procedure
Select "1: YES" with the 10-key, and press the [START] key. The Flash
ROM data are read out and written into the SRAM. (When "2: NO" is
selected, the simulation is canceled.)
* The AR-FX5 data cannot be written into the AR-FX7. If it is executed, data are initialized and deleted. In addition, the AR-FX7 data
cannot be used in the AR-FX5.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
Enter the DTFM signal (1 digit (1 to 9, 0, *, #)) and press the [START]
key.
When the [CUSTOM SETTINGS] key is pressed during execution, the
simulation is terminated.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
66-21
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation/procedure
66-18
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Check
FAX information print
FAX
Data
Operation/Procedure
Enter the DTFM signal (1 digit (1 to 9, 0, *, #)) and press the [START]
key.
When the [CUSTOM SETTINGS] key is pressed during execution, the
simulation is terminated.
Item
USER SW.LIST
SOFT SW.LIST
SYSTEM ERROR
PROTOCOL
Content
User setting list
Soft SW list
System error list
Used to print the system error log (error
number and time).
Protocol error list
Regardless of soft SW38-1 status, the
protocol monitor of the preceding
communication is printed. (Printing is
allowed at any time before starting the
next communication.) For this operation,
the protocol monitor of one
communication is always buffered.
Back up
Used to write the SRAM data to the Flash ROM.
FAX
Data
Operation/Procedure
Select "1: YES" with the 10-key, and press the [START] key. The data
are backed up. (When "2: NO" is selected, the simulation is canceled.)
* The AR-FX5 data cannot be written into the AR-FX7. If it is executed, data are initialized and deleted. In addition, the AR-FX7 data
cannot be used in the AR-FX5.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
66-22
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Setting
Handset sound volume adjustment (Japan only)
FAX
Operation
Operation/procedure
1. Select the set volume. (Max., Middle, Min.)
2. Press the [START] key.
Switch of 1, 2, and 3 can be made during execution of the simulation.
During execution of the simulation, sounds are generated.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 48
1 2 3 4 5
00001
66-24
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Data clear
Used to clear the FAST storage data. (SEC only)
FAX
Data
Initializing
Operation/procedure
Select "1: YES" with the 10-key and press the [START] key. The FAST
storage data are cleared. (When "2: NO" is selected, the simulation is
canceled.)
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
66-32
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation/procedure
Operation test/check
Receive data check
FAX
Operation
The fixed data received from the line are checked and the result is displayed.
When data are coincident, "OK" is displayed. When not, "NG" is displayed.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
66-30
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to set the TEL/LIU.
FAX
Operation
66-33
Operation/procedure
When the relay state of the polarity reverse relay, the handset hook
switch, or the external telephone hook switch is changed, the content
of change is displayed regardless of the soft SW setup (real time). The
display of change is kept until an interruption command is supplied by
pressing the [CUSTOM SETTINGS] key.
Item
HS2
HS1
RHS
EXHS
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Signal detection check
FAX
Operation
Operation/Procedure
Signal detection is checked and the result is displayed.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
Notification contents
Signal low
Signal high
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
66-31
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Communication time measurement display
FAX
Operation
The send/receive test is performed, and the time required for send/
receive of the image data in the test is measured and displayed.
Setting
Used to set the TEL/LIU.
FAX
Operation
Operation/Procedure
1. Enter the set value. (Valid only 0 to 8)
2. The entered bit is alternatively switched between "0" and 1" and
the target signal name is highlighted.
3. Press the [START] key to send the signal.
When the [CUSTUM SETTINGS] key is pressed, the output is terminated.
Measuring
range
Send
Receive
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 49
Communication
: Memory send
means
: Normal Character
Picture quality
: Lighter
Density
: ON
ECM
: OFF
Sender information
From flag reception before sending of
image data until sending of RCP frame
From flag reception before reception of
image data until reception of RCP frame
67
Operation test/check
Used to execute read/write check of the RAM on the
PCL board, and to display the result. (To be supported
for MCU v00.45 or later)
Section
Printer
Item
Operation
Operation/Procedure
66-37
Purpose
Function (Purpose)
Section
Adjustment/Setting/Check
Speaker sound volume adjustment
FAX
Read/write check of the RAM on the PCL board is performed and the
result is displayed.
Operation/procedure
The following test sound is delivered to the line and the speaker to
adjust the sound kind and volume.
The send level to the line is the set value of soft SW.
The set values of the selected sound kind and volume are written to
each soft SW.
1. Sound kinds pattern
Sound kinds (Test sound)
RINGER
Call sound
LINE MONITO Line monitor sound (Test
sound: communication
signal sound)
ON HOOK
On-hook (Test sound,
communication signal
sound)
SCAN FINISH Scan finish sound
TX/RX FINISH Communication finish
sound
DTMF
DTFM send sound
The presence of DIMM is detected. If there is no DIMM, "---" is displayed. If there is, read/write check is performed and the result is displayed.
The display of "---" is changed to "CHECKING," "OK," or "NG" according to the message number included in the continuation command.
When the simulation is completed normally, "COMPLETE" is displayed. (No display for abnormal completion.)
Since only the devices installed to the PCL board are checked when
the simulation is started, the display may not be changed from "---."
(No message is sent for an uninstalled device.)
Key operations on each display
(Initial display)
During execution, the [INTERRUPT] key, [C] key, and the [CA] key are
invalid. (Beep sound). The [CUSTOM SETTINGS] key produces a
valid sound only.
After execution, the [INTERRUPT] key and the [C] key are invalid.
(Beep sound). Pressing the [CA] key leads to resetting. The [CUSTOM
SETTINGS] key produces a valid sound only.
1
67-11
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
66-41
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Adjustment/Setting/Check
CI signal check
Setting
Used to set the select-in signal of the Centro port.
Printer
Operation
Operation/procedure
Operation/procedure
When the [START] key is pressed, the call signal from CI pin is
detected to deliver the call sound to the line and the speaker. The volume of call sound follows the soft SW.
Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
Setting range
Default
0-1
0
* In the other case than the serviceman call error, entering the simulation is inhibited during the system check operation is displayed.
Note: Executable only when the PCL is installed.
67-14
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Printer
Operation
Operation/procedure
1. Press the [START] key.
"PLEASE SEND DATA" is displayed.
2. Data are sent from the PC (MS-DOS) by use of "fcopy" command
(FCOPY: file name). (Refer the [7] FLASH ROM VERSION UP
PROCEDURE)
Used to overwrite and check the flash device while displaying its
process status.
After completion, the result is displayed.
3. Press the [CA] key to cancel the simulation and reset.
(Flash Device)
PROGRAM
BOOTROM
PS KANJI FONT
ESC/P KANJI FONT
OPTION FONT
(Processing state)
RECEIVE
ERASE
WRITE
VERIFY
67-17
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Data clear
Used to clear the printer section setting. (NVRAM
clear)
Operation/procedure
1. Press the [START] key.
The confirmation dialogue is displayed.
2. Select "1: YES" with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
If there is no abnormality after Clear operation, "COMPLETE" is displayed. If there is any abnormality, "ERROR" is displayed.
* Execution of the simulation which performs communication with the
PCL board is inhibited until Notice Page storage is completed. (Only
when the serviceman call error occurs.)
* In the other case than the serviceman call error, entering the simulation is inhibited during the system check operation is displayed.
Note: Executable only when the PCL is installed.
67-15
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Section
Item
Operation test/check
Used to check the validity of the ROM on the PCL
board and the result is displayed. (To be supported for
MCU v00.45 or later)
Printer
Operation
Operation/procedure
67-18
Purpose
Function
(Purpose)
Data clear
Used to clear the data area for FLASH ROM Network
Scanner Application.
Operation/procedure
1. Press the [START] key.
The confirmation dialogue is displayed.
2. Select "1: YES" with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
When the simulation is completed normally, "COMPLETE" is displayed. (No display for abnormal completion.)
If there is no abnormality after Clear operation, "COMPLETE" is displayed. If there is any abnormality, "ERROR" is displayed.
Since only the devices installed to the PCL board are checked when
the simulation is started, the display may not be changed from "---."
(No message is sent for an uninstalled device.)
* In the other case than the serviceman call error, entering the simulation is inhibited during the system check operation is displayed.
(Initial display)
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 51
67-20
Function
Used to check the network connection when the
(Purpose) scanner option is installed.
Operation/procedure
The network scanner is checked.
1. Press the [START] key.
"PLEASE SEND DATA" and "READY" are displayed. (When the
PCL board is installed, it takes some time to display "READY.")
2. Boot "ftp" from MS-DOS.
Data are sent from the PC by the put file name.
The process is displayed. Check the display.
(TEST DATA)
TEST DATA
(Process status)
RECEIVE
TESTING
After completion, the result is displayed.
When the simulation is completed normally, "COMPLETE" is displayed. (No display for abnormal completion.)
Pressing [CA] key cancels the simulation resets the operation.
* Execution of the simulation which performs communication with the
PCL board is inhibited until Notice Page storage is completed. (Only
when the serviceman call error occurs.)
* In the other case than the serviceman call error, entering the simulation is inhibited during the system check operation is displayed.
Note: Executable only when PCL and NIC are installed.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 SIMULATION 8 - 52
F1
F2
F5
F6
02
10
11
12
00
01
06
08
11
15
02
04
02
00
10
80
81
82
84
88
99
Trouble contents
Trouble
detection
Trouble code
Trouble
Trouble contents
Main Sub
detection
code code
F9
00 MCU-PRT communication trouble
MCU
10 Printer PWB trouble
80 Printer PWB communication trouble
(Protocol)
81 Printer PWB communication trouble
(Parity)
82 Printer PWB communication trouble
(Overrun)
84 Printer PWB communication trouble
(Framing)
88 Printer PWB communication trouble
(Timeout)
99 Machine-PCL board language error
H2
00 Main heater lamp thermistor open hard
detection
01 Sub heater lamp thermistor open hard
detection
H3
00 Main heater lamp abnormally high
temperature hard detection trouble
01 Sub heater lamp abnormally high
temperature hard detection trouble
10 Main heater lamp abnormally high
temperature soft detection trouble
11 Sub heater lamp abnormally high
temperature soft detection trouble
H4
00 Main heater lamp abnormally low
temperature detection
01 Sub heater lamp abnormally low
temperature detection
20 Main heater lamp abnormally low
temperature detection
21 Sub heater lamp abnormally low
temperature detection
H5
01 10 continuous POD1, POD2 or PPD2
JAM
L1
00 Scanner feed trouble
L3
00 Scanner return trouble
L4
01 Main motor trouble
11 Shifter motor trouble
L6
10 Polygon motor trouble
L8
10 Power abnormality detection trouble
U1
01 FAX battery error
02 PANEL LOW battery error
U2
04 EEPROM communication error
20 Machine speed code data error
40 CRUM chip communication error
U7
00 RIC communication trouble
U9
00 MCU-OPE communication trouble
OPE
80 Operation control PWB communication
trouble (Protocol)
81 Operation control PWB communication
trouble (Parity)
82 Operation control PWB communication
trouble (Overrun)
84 Operation control PWB communication
trouble (Framing)
88 Operation control PWB communication
trouble (Time-out)
99 Operation panel language error
EE
EL Developer adjustment trouble (Over-toned
abnormality)
EU Developer adjustment trouble (Undertoned abnormality)
PF
00 RIC copy inhibit signal received
2. Self diagnostics
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
A0
01
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
E1
00
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
10
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
11
12
13
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Remarks
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Remarks
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
E1
14
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Remarks
15
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Remarks
16
Content
Details
17
80
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
JBIG IC abnormality
IMC board flash ROM error
Flash ROM abnormality on IMC board
IMC board abnormality
Replace the IMC PWB.
"When the program download is
abnormally terminated, a error may occur.
In this case, download the program again."
Program ROM abnormality
Check
and
remedy
81
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
E1
82
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
84
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
88
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
E7
02
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
10
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
E7
11
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
12
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
F1
00
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
01
Content
Details
Cause
06
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 TROUBLE CODE LIST 9 - 3
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
F1
08
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
11
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
15
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
F2
02
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
F2
04
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
F5
02
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Remarks
F6
00
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Identification error
Model error
Type error
Destination error
Data abnormality
Misc error
Identification error
When the CRUM trademark differs.
When the CRUM company code differs.
Model error
When the boot program model code does
not match with the CRUM model
information.
Type error
When the CRUM type is other than
[Genuine/Conversion/Production rotation].
Destination error
The destination of the body differs from
that of the CRUM.
Data abnormality
The initial check information includes an
erroneous value.
When the max. toner supply time is 00:
When the print hard stop is 00:
CRUM chip failure
Erroneous developing unit
Replace the CRUM chip.
Replace the developing unit
Copy lamp lighting abnormality
The copy lamp does not light up.
Copy lamp error
Copy lamp harness abnormality
CCD PWB harness abnormality
Check the copy lamp (SIM 5-3)
When the lamp lights:
Check the harnesses and connectors
between the CCD unit and the MCU PWB.
When the lamp does not light:
Check the harness and connector
between the copy lamp and the MCU
PWB.
Replace the copy lamp unit.
Replace the MCU PWB.
Copy lamp disconnection
Cable is not attached.
MCU-FAX communication trouble
Communication establishment error/
framing/parity/protocol error
FAX control PWB connector disconnection
Defective harness between FAX control
PWB and MCU PWB
Motherboard connector pin breakage
FAX control PWB ROM error/Data error
Check connector/harness of FAX control
PWB and MCU PWB.
Check the grounding of the copier.
Check FAX control PWB ROM.
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
F6
10
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
80
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
81
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
82
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
84
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
F6
88
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
99
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
F9
00
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
10
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
80
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
F9
81
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
82
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
84
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
88
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
99
F9
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
H2
00
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
01
Remarks
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
H3
00
Remarks
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
H3
01
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
H3
10
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
11
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
H4
00
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
01
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
20
H4
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
21
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
H5
01
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
L1
00
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
L3
00
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
L4
01
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
L4
11
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
L6
10
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
L8
10
Content
Details
Cause
U1
01
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
02
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
U2
04
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Remarks
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
U2
20
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Remarks
40
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
U7
00
Remarks
Content
Details
Cause
U9
00
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
80
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
U9
81
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
82
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
U9
84
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
88
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
99
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
Trouble
code
Main Sub
code code
EE
EL
Details of trouble
Content
Details
Cause
EU
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
PF
00
Check
and
remedy
Content
Details
Cause
Check
and
remedy
: Replace
: Lubricate
Unit
Parts
Process unit Drum
Cleaning blade
Seal F/R
Drum frame unit
MC unit
75k
150k
225k
300k
375k
450k
Star ring
Developer
DV seal
DV side seal N
DV side seal N2
DV side mylar
DV moquette
Toner sensor
Upper heat roller
Lower heat roller
Upper separation pawl
Upper cleaning Pat
Lower separation pawl
Thermistor
Upper roller gear
Upper roller bush
Lower heat roller bearing
Paper guide
Pickup roller (Multi bypass tray)
Paper feeding sheet (Multi bypass tray)
Pickup roller (500 sheets tray)
Paper feeding sheet (500 sheets tray)
Pickup roller and feed roller (SPF/
RSPF)
Paper feeding sheet (SPF/RSPF)
Transport roller unit
Gear
Ozone filter
Paper feed rollers
Gears
Star ring
DV unit
Fusing unit
Paper feed
Transport
unit
Ozone filter
Others
2. Counter clear
Note
Item
Maintenance cycle setting
Jam/trouble counter clear
Paper feed counter clear
DF/Scan/Stapler counter clear
Maintenance counter clear
Developing counter clear
Copy counter clear
Drum counter clear
Printer, other counter clear
FAX counter clear
Scanner mode counter clear
SIM
SIM 21-1
SIM 24-1
SIM 24-2
SIM 24-3
SIM 24-4
SIM 24-5
SIM 24-6
SIM 24-7
SIM 24-9
SIM 24-10
SIM 24-15
Remarks
Unit
A. Process unit
Parts
(1) Drum
(2) Drum section
At maintenance
At maintenance
At drum replacement
At developer replacement
B. Developing unit
At drum replacement
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
Main charger
Cleaning blade
Drum frame unit
Moquette F/R
Separation pawl
(1) Developer
(2) DV seal/side seal N/side seal N2/side
mylar
Unit
C. Fusing unit
D. Optical section
E. Paper feed
section
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(1)
(2)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
L. Ozone filter
M. Drive section
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(1)
(2)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(1)
(1)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
N. Transport section (1)
O. Operation
(1)
section
(2)
(3)
(4)
P. Switch
(1)
Parts
Thermostat
Thermistor
Paper guide
Fusing Separation Pawl (lower)
Lower heat roller
Heater lamp
Fusing Separation Pawl (upper)
Upper heat roller
CCD unit
Lamp unit
a. Lamp
b. PWB
c. Wire
d. Mirror motor
Paper feed solenoid
Cassette sensor PWB
Manual P-in sensor/Manual empty sensor
Multi manual
a. Paper feed roller/
paper feed
pickup roller
b. Reverse sensor
c. Separation sheet
d. Clutch/solenoid
Upper 500
a. Paper feed roller/
sheets tray
pickup roller
paper feed
b. Separation sheet
Lower 500
a. Paper feed roller/
sheets tray
pickup roller
paper feed
b. Separation sheet
c. Lift up unit
d. Transport clutch
e. Paper feed clutch
f. Transport clutch
g. Solenoid
h. Sensor PWB
I. Dehumidification
heater
Transport roller unit
Transport roller
DUP transport roller
DUP motor
Exit roller
Cooling fan
Switch
Sensor
Roller
LSU
Power source
Option CN PWB
IMC PWB
MCU PWB
Motherboard PWB
Second interface PWB
DUP reverse motor
Main drive motor
Toner motor
Drive unit
PS transport clutch
Paper feed clutch
Lift up motor
Transport roller
Operation section
OPU PWB
Key PWB
LCD unit
Power switch/
4
3
b. Cleaning blade
Assembly* Press the center of the separation pawl and install it.
d. Moquette F/R
B. Developing section
(1) Developer
2
Note: If it disturbs the blade movement, replace it and attach new one.
e. Separation pawl
Disassembly* Hold the tip of the separation pawl and remove it.
Note: Attach it to fit with the attachment reference when replacing the
DV seal.
DV seal
0
Attaching
reference
0.5
Faulting
g
in
lu
G ce
fa
positions.
a. DV moquette
DV moquette
b. Toner sensor
1) When attaching the DV side Mylar, check the position shown in the
figure below and attach it properly.
Attaching reference
Toner sensor
2) When attaching the DV side seal, check the position shown in the
figure below and attach it properly.
(First of all, attach the DV side Mylar.)
MG roller
Attaching reference
Clean the sensor only after removing used DV when replacing DV.
Side seal
N2
Side seal
N
There is no need to remove the MG roller as shown in the above figure. Use waste cloth to remove toner from the sensor surface in the
arrow direction shown in the figure below.
side.
C. Fusing section
3
2
1
2
2
1
1
(1) Thermostat
1
1
2
3
(2) Thermistor
1
3
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
D. Optical section
(1) CCD unit
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
2
5
4
4
3
2
1
a. Lamp
1
1
3
2
1
5
b. PWB
4
3
4
2
2
1
1
2
c. Wire
1
2
3
A
2
B
1
A
B
1
A
B
C
3
2
Installation*Install so that the cam transmit arm (1) comes under the
roller arm (2).
d. Clutch/solenoid
(Clutch)
1
6
5
4
2
3
2
2
3
5
LO C K
2
1
b. Reverse sensor
1
2
(Solenoid)
c. Separation sheet
1)
2
2)
(Clutch)
3)
A
A
1
4
Note: With the toner cartridge installed, do not tilt or shake the developer cartridge.
1
3
1
3
2
2
1
4
2
3
3
2
4
1
2
1
1)
b. Separation sheet
4
1
3
1
c. Lift up unit
1
3
2
4
1
4
d. Transport clutch
b. Separation sheet
3
2
1
3
2
f. Transport clutch
1
2
Check that two springs are securely inserted into the transfer roller
unit bosses.
2
1
3
2
g. Solenoid
2
2
3
3
1
1
h. Sensor PWB
2
3
3
3
3
1
4
1
1
3
2
3
3
1
2
1
Remove the front right cabinet.
2
1
3
1
1
Remove the DUP motor.
4
1
3
Remove the delivery frame.
1
1
1
3
2
1
(1) Switch
2
1
(2) Sensor
Note: Check to confirm that the solenoid shaft is in the gate bracket,
and fix with the screw.
B
A
(3) Roller
1
1
1
2
1
2
1
1
2
1
I. Laser unit
(1) LSU
2
3
2
1
3
1
1
1
2
2
2
1
2
2
2
2
3
J. Power unit
K. PWB
(1) Option CN PWB
3
4
1
2
2
1
2
2
3
2
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
2
1
1
L. Ozone filter
2
1
1
Note: Before removing the left cover, remove the No.1 cassette in
advance.
1
2
2
1
2
1
3
M. Drive section
(1) DUP reverse motor
1
2
3
2
2
1
3
1
4
3
3
1
1
3
2
1
2
1
3
2
1
2
1
3
1
O. Operation section
(1) Operation section
N. Transport section
(1) Transport roller
2
1
1
1
2
1
2
1
1
2
2
1
2
3
1
2
2
2
3
1
P. Switch
(1) Power switch
[11] OTHERS
fax program
A Personal computer
B RS232C cross cable (D-sub 9pin to D-sub 9pin, or D-sub 25pin to
D-sub 9pin)
1)
2)
3)
Make sure only "Printer Control Board" tree is visible under "Simulation Command List".
4)
5)
(ROM type)
The flash ROM is directly installed to each PWB.
(Target PWB)
1 MCU PWB
2 Panel PWB
3 IMC PWB
4 Finisher PWB
Download
data
RS232C connector
(9pin or 25pin)
MCU-PWB
Operation
panel
IMC
PWB
Finisher
(AR-M236/M276/M237/M277)
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 OTHERS 11 - 1
6)
Make sure copier is turned off, and connect PC and Printer Control
board of the copier by parallel cable beforehand.
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
Expand "Printer Control Board", and double-click on "Printer Control Board Firmware Download".
7)
8)
7)
8)
9)
10) Close the maintenance program, and turn off the copier. Turn on
the copier again after pulling the plug.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 OTHERS 11 - 2
C. Others (Troubleshooting)
Followings are the error possibly occur during the download process and troubleshooting method.
No
1
Warning/error message
Incorrect destination. Continue with the
download process?
Checksum error.
10
An error. [0xXXXXXXXX]
Detail
Destination of download file and copier doesn't match.
Possible to select either continue or cancel the job.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]
To change destination, select "Yes". If not, select "No" and cancel download process.
Invalid download file for the machine is selected, or the file format is not correct.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]
Confirm the download file. Possibly the improper download file is selected.
Unable to find appropriate data in selected download file.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]
Confirm the download file. Possibly the improper download file is selected.
Download procedure is executed on uninstalled optional kit.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]
Confirm installed optional kit.
Confirm the download file. Possibly the improper download file is selected.
Panel flash ROM size is not enough to execute download procedure.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]
Confirm the download file. Possibly the improper download file is selected.
Exchange the flash ROM to the one which has more capacity.
Transmission error
Unable to receive data from the machine among the certain period of time.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]
Restart maintenance program after confirming communication port or communication cable.
Incorrect download procedure.
The machine did not proceed download procedure correctly.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]
Restart maintenance program after confirming communication port or communication cable.
Make sure the communication device of PC(either COM or parallel) is under right condition.
Transmission error
The check sum value of the transmission data is mismatch.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]
Restart maintenance program after confirming communication device of PC (either COM or
parallel) is under right condition.
Download data file operation error.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]
Restart maintenance program after confirming the selected download file is not abnormal and
not using other application.
The error occurred except the above errors.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]
Restart maintenance program after confirming communication device of PC(either COM or
parallel) is under right condition.
Energy save
Operation settings
ON / OFF
ON / OFF
ON / OFF
1 240 (Increment of 1min.) 60 (min.)
Remarks
When this is set to ON, the
department number must be
registered in the "Account number
control".
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 OTHERS 11 - 3
Operation settings
Device control
ON / OFF
ON / OFF
ON / OFF
Disabling of duplex
Disabling of stapler
Output trays
ON / OFF
ON / OFF
Pattern 1 / Pattern 2 / Pattern 3 / Pattern 4
ON / OFF
30 / 40 / 50 / 60 / 70%
0 / 30 / 40 / 50 / 60 / 70%
(0%: Function inhibited)
ON / OFF
1 60 (Increment of 1sec.) 60 (sec.)
ON / OFF
Remarks
00000 (5 digits)
Serial number
ON / OFF
1 / 2 / 3 / 4 / 5
Plain paper / Plain and recycle paper
1 999 999
ON / OFF
Remarks
ON / OFF
ON / OFF
1 / 2 / 3 / 4 / 5
ON / OFF
Rotated print
Forced output of print
Excluded bypass-tray from ATS
ON / OFF
ON / OFF
ON / OFF
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 OTHERS 11 - 4
Remarks
Default settings
Interface settings
ON / OFF
I/O timeout
Network settings
(When the print
server card
installed.)
ON / OFF
ON / OFF
ON / OFF
Enable ECP
ON / OFF
IP address setting
DHCP: ON / OFF
Enable TCP/IP
Enable NetWare
Enable EtherTalk
Enable NetBEUI
Reset the NIC
ON / OFF
ON / OFF
ON / OFF
ON / OFF
Initialize and/or
store settings
(When the PCL
printer expansion
board is installed
or the model with
the board.)
Remarks
When the PCL printer expansion
board is installed or the model with
the board.
When the PCL printer expansion
board is installed or the model with
the board.
Restore configuration
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 OTHERS 11 - 5
Remarks
A. Basic functions
1)
Event driven type text message transmission by using MIB information of Printer control board.
2)
The above functions are available as standard provision only when the
NIC card are installed.
For 2), the software key protect is made.
Event
Paper Jam
Toner Low
Toner Empty
Paper Empty
Service Required
PM Required
Message
Condition
! ! ! MISFEED HAS OCCURRED ! ! ! When paper/document jam has occurred. If a jam is detected when the power is
turned ON or reset, checking is made again.
! ! ! TONER SUPPLY IS LOW ! ! !
When toner LOW is detected for the first time. If toner LOW is detected when the
power is turned ON or reset, checking is made again.
! ! ! ADD TONER ! ! !
When toner empty is detected for the first time. If toner empty is detected when
the power is turned ON or reset, checking is made again.
! ! ! LOAD PAPER/XXX ! ! !
When paper empty is detected for the first time. If paper empty is detected when
the power is turned ON or reset, checking is made again. No information on the
number of steps of trays. Manual feed is not supported. When a tray empty is
detected, information of all the trays that are empty at that time is delivered.
! ! ! CALL FOR SERVICE ! ! !
When the machine enters the self-diagnosis mode. If detected when the power is
turned ON or reset, checking is made again.
! ! ! MAINTENANCE REQUIRED ! ! ! When the maintenance counter or the developer counter reaches the specified
count. If detected when the power is turned ON or reset, checking is made again.
Counter information
When schedule driven is set, the total counter, the copy counter, and
the printer counter are displayed in a mail address for general. These
information items are supplied from the controller MIB. The "total
counter" means the "effective paper counter" controlled by the MCU.
Timer information
For schedule drive message, the Printer controller controls transmission time by means, and transmits a mail.
Timer setup is made from the Web setup page.
AR-M236/M276/M237/M277 OTHERS 11 - 6
* LLC: Drop
OP-UP cassette
PPD1 ; Paper Pass Detector
PAP1 ; Paper Empty
LUD1 ; Lift Up Detector
CSS1 ; Casette Detector
DRS1 ; Door Detector
PCL1 ; Pick Up Clutch
LUM1 ; Lift Up Motor
TRCL ; Vertical transport roller
clutch 2
OP interface PWB
Fuser-Lamp (x2)
Fuser Unit
CN140
CN***(new)
CN***
CN*** (New)
CN***
Pout Gate
Solenoid
CN***
CN***
Pout 2 Ssensor
CN***
Defog
Heater
CN***
Key/LED PWB
WakeUp SW
OPERATION PANEL
MAIN-Motor
AB
Toner-Motor
MCU-PWB
CN***
OP interface PWB
OP-LO cassette
PPD2 ; Paper Pass Detector
PAP2 ; Paper Empty
LUD2 ; Lift Up Detector
CSS2 ; Casette Detector
DRS2 ; Door Detector
PCL2 ; Pick Up Clutch
LUM2 ; Lift Up Motor
Drum Initial
Sensor
Paper Remove
Sol
Pout Sensor
Duplex-Motor
Duplex-Conveyance Motor
Shifter-Motor
SPF-DupSOL
Shifter
HP
Sensor
SPF-pressure
release SOL
SPF-Motor
CN***
SPF-CNT-PWB
CN***
L2
Coin
Vender
COPY-OP-PWB
InterLock
Switch
CN***(chg)
Option
Connector PWB
HVU
CN***
(chg)
CN***(chg)
D-Sub 15pin
Power Supply
(New)
Main / Sub
Power Unit
BD-PWB
BD-Sensor
Ozon Fan
APC-PWB
LSU-PWB
LSU-UN
Polygon-Motor
(include CRSM)
DEV
TRAYPAPER
SENSOR
CCD-PWB
IMC PWB
Tiger Size-LCD
Touch Panel
Auditer I/F
INCH
CN***(new)
(AB / INCH )
CN***(New)
Copy-Lamp
CN***
Mirror HP
Sensor
AR-235/275 series Pin nothing compatible
D-Sub 25pin
CN***
Down-Load-CON
D-Sub 9pin
CN***
L1
CN***
CN***
Scanner
Cover
Sensor
Mirror-Motor
Stapler
Reactor
(CE Only)
PS-SW
PS Cooling Fan
Defog Heater
(Japan Only)
AC
GDI/USB PWB
OR
PCL PWB
FAX PWB
(Standard)
(Optional)
(Optional)
Cartridge empty
Paper Size Detector
Staple operation motor
sensor
Rear edge plate HP sensor
Staple HP sensor
Staple supply cover Side guide plate HP sensor
open/close sensor
Tray paper empty sensor
Tray JAM process
Self priming sensor
sensor
No. 1 tray paper exit sensor Side guide plate motor Rear edge plate drive
solenoid
JAM process PG
No. 2 tray paper exit sensor Rear edge plate drive
open/close sensor Lift-up drive control sensor
Transport select gate
motor
right solenoid
Tray position sensor Upper FIN main motor
Upper alignment plate
Paper position sensor
Tray lift-up motor
drive solenoid
Tray position sensor Lower Tray off-set motor
Transport select gate
right solenoid 2
Off-set position sensor
Shutter drive solenoid
Paper exit roller clutch
(New)
SPF-PSOL
CN***
FINISHER PWB
Mother PWB
SPF-SEN-PWB
SPF Cover Sens
SPF PS Sens
SPF Paper Empty
SPF Paper Size Sens (x2)
SPF Paper Width Sens (Analog)
SPF BOOK Sens
CN***
CN***(chg)
CN***
CN***
CN***
CN***(chg)
CN***(chg)
1. Block diagram
Interlock SW
Hand Paper
Solenoid
Hand Paper
Tray 1
Hand Paper
Tray 2
Hand Paper
Size Sensor 1
Duplex 2
Sensor PWB
Hand Paper
Empty Sensor
Harness Guide
PM PWB
Hand Paper
Width Sensor PWB
Hand Paper
Size Sensor 2
BPC
LVS UN
APC
Hand Paper
IN Sensor
Separation Pawl
Solenoid
Heater Lamp 2
Thermostat 1
Thermister 2
Thermostat 2
Heater Lamp 1
Thermister 1
FUSING UNIT
Dupex 2 Motor
Dupex Motor
Shifter Motor
Cooling Fan
Cooling Fan
Shifter HP Sensor
Cover SW
(1/11)
RIC/Down Load
1st CASSETTE
Cassette
Sensor Sw
TCS
CRUM
PWB
DV UN
to Auditor
Main
Motor
Toner
Motor
Lift Up
Motor
IMC-PWB
PS Cluch
MCU-PWB
OPTION
Lens
Dehumidification
heater
Mirror
Dehumidification
heater Dehumidification
Heater PWB
LCD UN
Touch Panel
Casette
Sensor
PWB
Pick Up
Solenoid
to RSPF UN to Finisher UN
Paper
Size
Sensor
OPU PWB
CCD PWB
OP CONNECTOR PWB
Mirror
Motor
Copy
Lamp
Operation Panel
Key
PWB
Cassette
Dehumidification
heater
OPTION
to Coinvender
to PCL PWB
or
GDI PWB
OPTION
SPEAKER
HAND SET
Fax-PWB
OC Cover Mirror HP
Sensor Sensor PWB
GRID
Transport Cluch
TC
PS Fan
Dehumidification
Heater SW
AC SW
to 3rd Casette
BC
Cassette Dehumidification
Heater
OPTION
Cassette
Paper Feed
SW
MCFB
OZON Fan
Paper Exit
Sensor
MC
Harness Holder
CN9(18FMN-BTK)
GND 1
5Vsub 2
/WakeUpKey 3
StandbyLED 4
GND 5
/OPURXD 6
/OPUTXD 7
OPUSRDY 8
OPUCRDY 9
/OPUCLK 10
RESET# 11
3.3V 12
3.3V 13
GND 14
5V 15
GND 16
24V 17
GND 18
MCU PWB
CN1(23FMN-BMT-TF)
GND
23
/START_KEY 22
SENSE0
21
SENSE1
20
SENSE2
19
SENSE3
18
SENSE4
17
SCAN0
16
SCAN1
15
SCAN2
14
SCAN3
13
SCAN4
12
/SEG0
11
/SEG1
10
/SEG2
9
/SEG3
8
COM0
7
COM1
6
COM2
5
/BZR_PWM
4
START_LED 3
5Vsub
2
GND
1
KEY PWB
<KEY PWB HARNESS> (FFC)
CN6(23FMN-BTK-A)
1 GND
2 /START_KEY
3 SENSE0
4 SENSE1
5 SENSE2
6 SENSE3
7 SENSE4
8 SCAN0
9 SCAN1
10 SCAN2
11 SCAN3
12 SCAN4
13 /SEG0
14 /SEG1
15 /SEG2
16 /SEG3
17 COM0
CN7
18 COM1
(SM02(8.0)B-BHS-1-TB)
19 COM2
20 /BZR_PWM
/CCFT
1
21 START_LED
24V_OP
2
22 5Vsub
23 GND
CN3(20FLS-SM1-TB)
GND 1
N.C 2
N.C 3
N.C 4
N.C 5
GND 6
LCD_D3 7
LCD_D2 8
LCD_D1 9
LCD_D0 10
GND 11
LCD_VEE 12
3.3V_OP 13
LCD_DIS 14
GND 15
LCD_CP2 16
GND 17
LCD_CP1 18
LCD_M 19
LCD_S 20
CN4(04FLS-SM1-TB)
Y1 1
X1 2
Y2/ 3
X2/ 4
OPU PWB
CN1(18FMN-BTK)
18 GND
17 5Vsub
16 /WakeUpKey
15 StandbyLED
14 GND
13 /OPURXD
12 /OPUTXD
11 OPUSRDY
10 OPUCRDY
9 /OPUCLK
8 RESET#
7 3.3V
6 3.3V
5 GND
4 5V
3 GND
2 24V
1 GND
<LCD M FFC>
(FFC)
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
GND
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
GND
LCD_D3
LCD_D2
LCD_D1
LCD_D0
GND
LCD_VEE
3.3V
/SEG1
/SEG2
/SEG3
COM0
COM1
COM2
/BZR_PWM
LCD UNIT
PANEL UNIT
TOUCH PANEL
MCU PWB
CN23(B34B-PHDSS-B)
N.C 1
N.C 2
N.C 3
N.C 4
N.C 5
N.C 6
N.C 7
N.C 8
N.C 9
N.C 10
N.C 11
N.C 12
N.C 13
N.C 14
N.C 15
N.C 16
/INCHJP 17
GND 18
DSIN2A 19
GND 21
DSCLK# 23
5V 25
LED0# 27
DSIN2B 20
GND 22
DSCLK# 24
5V 26
LED0# 28
OCCOVER 29
GND 30
PullUp 31
PullUp 32
MHP 33
GND 34
CN23(B34B-PHDSS-B)
/ABJP 1
GND 2
LED1# 3
LED2# 5
LED3# 7
5V 9
GND 11
DSCLK# 13
DSIN0 15
N.C 17
N.C 18
LED1# 4
LED2# 6
LED3# 8
5V 10
GND 12
DSCLK# 14
DSIN3 16
N.C 19
N.C 20
N.C 21
N.C 22
N.C 23
N.C 24
N.C 25
N.C 26
N.C 27
N.C 28
OCCOVER 29
GND 30
PullUp 31
PullUp 32
MHP 33
GND 34
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
PL
GY
OR
OR
PL
GY
PL
GY
OR
OR
PL
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
LED1#
LED2#
LED3#
5V
GND
DSCLK#
DSIN3
N.C
LED1#
LED2#
LED3#
5V
GND
DSCLK#
DSIN0
N.C
S3B-PH-K-S
3 PullUp
2 MHP
1 GND
OR
PL
GY
DSIN2B
GND
DSCLK#
5V
LED0#
DSIN2A
GND
DSCLK#
5V
LED0#
GP1S73P
1 OCCOVER
2 GND
3 PullUp
1
2
3
4
5
1
2
3
4
5
S3B-PH-K-S
3 PullUp
2 MHP
1 GND
GP1S73P
1 OCCOVER
2 GND
3 PullUp
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
PL
GY
OR
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
OR
PL
GY
PL
GY
OR
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
OC COVER SENSOR
(INCH ONLY)
OC COVER SENSOR
(AB ONLY)
MIRROR MOTOR
COPY LAMP
UNIT
CCD PWB
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4
5
04FE-BT-VK-N
P-GND 4
P-GND 3
/CL 2
24V 1
CCDD4
CCDD3
CCDD5
CCDD2
CCDD6
CCDD1
CCDD7
CCDD0
ADSCLK
ADWRT
ADSD
/f1
3.3V
/SH
GND
/f2
GND
GND
GND
/REFCK
GND
/DATCK
GND
/fR
/DUMC
/PB
/OB
5V
GND
12V
GND
12V
CN1(FF4-32-S1503)
<CCD HARNESS>
(FFC)
CN26(04FE-BT-VK-N)
1 P-GND
2 P-GND
3 /CL
4 24V
CN6(FF4-32-S1503)
1 CCDD4
2 CCDD3
3 CCDD5
4 CCDD2
5 CCDD6
6 CCDD1
7 CCDD7
8 CCDD0
9 ADSCLK
10 ADWRT
11 ADSD
12 /f1
13 3.3V
14 /SH
15 GND
16 /f2
17 GND
18 GND
19 GND
20 /REFCK
21 GND
22 /DATCK
23 GND
24 /fR
25 /DUMC
26 /PB
27 /OB
28 5V
29 GND
30 12V
31 GND
32 12V
CN16(40FMN-BTK)
GND
1
MIRMO0
2
MIRMO1
3
MIRMO2
4
MIRMODA# 5
/MIRMODA# 6
/MIRMODB# 7
MIRMODB# 8
SVSTS
9
SVCMD
10
RTS
11
DSR
12
DTR
13
CTS
14
GND
15
SPFPSOL# 16
SPFGSOL# 17
SPFRSOL# 18
SPFCLH#
19
SPFPAPER 20
GND
21
GND
22
SPFWS
23
3.3V
24
YSPF
25
SELA#
26
SELB#
27
SELC#
28
SPFMODA# 29
SPFMODB# 30
/SPFMODA# 31
/SPFMODB# 32
GND
33
/FINCRDY
34
FINSTS
35
/RESET#
36
/FINSRDY
37
FINCMD
38
/FINDET
39
GND
40
MCU PWB
<OP INTERFACE PWB HARNESS>
(FFC)
CN906(52147-0510)
1 MMA
2 MMB
3 /MMA
4 /MMB
5 +24V
CN902(40FMN-BTK)
40 GND
39 MIRMO0
38 MIRMO1
37 MIRMO2
36 MIRMODA#
35 /MIRMODA#
34 /MIRMODB#
33 MIRMODB#
32 SVSTS
31 SVCMD
30 RTS
29 DSR
28 DTR
27 CTS
26 GND
25 SPFPSOL#
24 SPFGSOL#
23 SPFRSOL#
22 SPFCLH#
21 SPFPAPER
20 GND
19 GND
18 SPFWS
17 3.3V
16 YSPF
15 SELA#
14 SELB#
13 SELC#
12 SPFMODA#
11 SPFMODB#
10 /SPFMODA#
9 /SPFMODB#
8 FINPIN
7 /FINCRDY
6 FINSTS
5 /RESET#
4 /FINSRDY
3 FINCMD
2 /FINDET
1 GND
CN902(SUB-D15)
P-GND 1
+24V 2
/FINCRDY 3
FINSTS 4
/RESET# 5
FINPIN 6
+24V 7
P-GND 8
S-GND 9
+3.3V 10
/FINSRDY 11
FINCMD 12
+5V 13
/FINDET 14
S-GND 15
CN904(SUB-D25)
S-GND 1
24V 2
/SPFMODB# 3
/SPFMODA# 4
SPFMODA# 5
SELC# 6
SELB# 7
SPFPDA 8
SPFRSOL# 9
SPFPSOL# 10
SPFPAPER 11
24V 12
S-GND 13
P-GND 14
YSPF 15
S-GND 16
SPFMODB# 17
SPFWS 18
3.3V 19
SELA# 20
SPFCLH# 21
SPFGSOL# 22
SPFPDB 23
5V 24
P-GND 25
CN903(SUB-D9)
N.C 1
SVCMDX 2
SVSTSX 3
DTRX 4
S-GND 5
DSRX 6
RTSX 7
CTSX 8
N.C 9
OP CONNECTOR PWB(1/2)
FINISHER
RSPF
CN4(B5B-PH-K R)
SW24V 1
DPX2A 2
DPX2B 3
/DPX2A 4
/DPX2B 5
CN1(S5B-PH-K S)
SW24V 1
DPXA 2
DPXB 3
/DPXA 4
/DPXB 5
CN2(S6B-PH-K S)
SW24V 1
SW24V 2
SFTDA# 3
SFTDB# 4
/SFTDA# 5
/SFTDB# 6
CN22(S3B-PH-K
+24V
/PGSOL1
/PGSOL2
CN24(S12B-PH-K-S)
SFTHP 1
GND 2
5V 3
PullUp 4
POUT1 5
GND 6
TFANOUT 7
/TFANMD 8
P-GND 9
TFANOUT 10
/TFANMD 11
P-GND 12
CN20 (S8B-PH-K-S)
PullUp 1
POUT2 2
GND 3
POUTCOV 4
GND 5
5V 6
PFULL2 7
GND 8
MCU PWB
PL
GY
OR
OR
PL
GY
RD
PL
GY
RD
PL
GY
OR
PL
GY
PL
GY
OR
PL
GY
(4) MCU PWB - 1ST PAPER EXIT UNIT - 2ND PAPER EXIT UNIT (5/11)
1
2
3
SMR-03V-N
RD 1 TFANOUT
PL 2 /TFANMD
GY 3 P-GND
RD
PL
GY
TFANOUT
/TFANMD
P-GND
S3B-PH-K-S
3 PullUp
2 POUT1
1 GND
OR
PL
GY
SMR-03V-N
GP1A71L3
2 SFTHP
1 GND
3 5V
GP1S44S1
2 5V
3 PFULL2
1 GND
OR
PL
GY
PL
GY
OR
COVER SW
D2X
1 POUTCOV
2 GND
PL
GY
COOLING FAN
COOLING FAN
DUPLEX 2 MOTOR
DUPLEX MOTOR
SHIFTER MOTOR
1
2
3
SMP-03V-NC
1
2
3
SMP-03V-NC
SHIFTER HP SENSOR
GP1S73P
3 PullUp
1 POUT2
2 GND
OR
PL
GY
BK
BK
SRA-51T-3
SRA-51T-3
THERMOSTAT 2
SRA-51T-3
BK
SRA-51T-3
THERMOSTAT 1
BK
SRA-51T-3
BK
THERMISTER11
FUSING UNIT
3
2
1
OR
GY
PL
WH
175019-1
WH
SRA-51T-3
THERMISTER11 2
PullUP
GND
PDPX
GP1S73P
BK
WH
3
2
1
VLP-03V
<FUSING HARNESS>WH
1
2
3
4
PHNR-4-H
VLR-03V
WH
BK
WH
HL-OUTPUT1 3
LIVE
2
HL-OUTPUT2 1
WH
BK
WH
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
CN19(S7B-PH-K-S)
PullUP
GND
PDPX
RTH1
GND
RTH2
GND
CN3(B04P-VL)
3 HL-OUTPUT1
1 LIVE
4 HL-OUTPUT2
2 N.C
OR
GY
PL
LB
GY
BR
GY
<FUSING SECTION
INTERFACE HARNESS>
BU04P-TR-P-H
LB
RTH1
4
GY
GND
3
BR
RTH2
2
GY
GND
1
PHNR-4-H
BU03P-TR-P-H
OR
1 PullUP
3
GY
2 GND
2
PL
3 PDPX
1
PHNR-3-H
PHNR-3-H
OR
GY
PL
HARNESS GUIDE
MCU PWB
CN14(B8B-PH-K
24V
/PCS1H
GND
/PIN
5V
/PAP1H
N.C
/LUD1H
S)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CN15(B32B-PHDSS-B)
24V 3
/HPSOL 5
HPTRAY1 7
GND 9
HPTRAY2 11
GND 13
HPSIZE1 15
GND 17
PullUp 19
HPSIZE2 21
GND 23
PullUp 25
3.3V 27
HPWS 29
GND 31
24V 4
/PSRSOL 6
GND 12
/DUP2SEN 14
PullUp 16
/HPIN 28
GND 30
PullUp 32
HPEMPTY 18
GND 20
PullUp 22
CSS1H 24
GND 26
/PCL1H 2
24V 1
/LUM1H 8
P-GND 10
MCU PWB
BR
RD
BR
GY
BR
OR
PK
RD
PL
PK
GY
BR
GY
LB
GY
OR
PL
GY
OR
BL
BR
GY
RD
BR
GY
PL
OR
PL
GY
OR
PL
GY
OR
BR
GY
PL
RD
LB
GY
2
3
N.C
/PSRSOL
SMR-03V-N
1
2
3
SMP-02V-BC
PL
1
RD
2
/PCL1H
24V
SMR-02V-B
1
2
BU05P-TR-P-H
PL
PL
1
HPEMPTY 5
GY 2
GY
GND
4
OR
OR 3
PullUp
3
BR
BR
4
CSS1H
2
GY 5
GY
GND
1
PHNR-5-H
PHNR-5-H
GY
PL
OR
BU03P-TR-P-H
GY
1 GND
3
PL
2 /DUP2SEN 2
OR
3 PullUp
1
PHNR-03-H
PHNR-03-H
BR
SMP-03V-NC
RD 1
24V
HARNESS GUIDE
PL
4
3
GY
2
OR
1
PHNR-4-H
RD 1
BR 2
SMR-02V-N
24V
/PCS1H
1st CASSETTE
BU04P-TR-P-H
1
/HPIN
2
N.C
3
GND
4
PullUp
PHNR-4-H
GY
OR
PL
1
2
SMP-02V-NC
BU15P-TR-P-H
RD
24V
1
PL
/HPSOL
2
PK
HPTRAY1 3
GY
GND
4
BR
HPTRAY2 5
GY
GND
6
LB
HPSIZE1 7
GY
GND
8
OR
PullUp
9
PL
HPSIZE2 10
GY
GND
11
OR
PullUp
12
BL
3.3V
13
BR
HPWS
14
GY
GND
15
PHNR-15-H
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
PHNR-15-H
RD
PL
PK
GY
BR
GY
LB
GY
OR
PL
GY
OR
BL
BR
GY
B3B-PH-K-S
1 /LUM1H
2 N.C
3 P-GND
HAND PAPER
WIDTH SENSOR
HAND PAPER
SIZE SENSOR2
HAND PAPER
TRAY2
HAND PAPER
TRAY1
HAND PAPER
SOLENOID
LIFT UP MOTOR
CASSETTE SENSOR SW
DUPLEX 2
SENSOR PWB
PS CLUCH
GP1S73P2
/HPEMPTY
GND
PullUp
GP1S73P2
/HPIN
GND
PullUp
D2X
1 CSS1H
2 GND
1
2
3
1
2
3
B6B-PH-K-S
1 GND
2 /PIN
3 5V
4 /PAP1H
5 N.C
BR 6 /LUD1H
GY
BR
OR
PK
GY
LB
BR
GY
PL
GY
OR
BR
GY
OR
S3B-PH-K-S
1 GND
2 /DUP2SEN
3 PullUp
S 3B-PH-K-S
3 3.3V
2 HPWS
1 GND
BL
BR
GY
GY
PL
OR
GP1S73P
1 HPSIZE2
2 GND
3 PullUp
PL
GY
OR
GP1S73P
1 HPSIZE1
2 GND
3 PullUp
D2X
1 HPTRAY2
2 GND
BR
GY
LB
GY
OR
D2X
1 HPTRAY1
2 GND
PK
GY
SMP-02V-NC
SMR-02V-N
RD
1
24V
1
PL
2
/HPSOL
2
CN12(B14B-PH-K-S)
NC D-1
TCDA# D-2
/CVSEL D-3
/TCLON D-4
/BPWM D-5
/MC D-6
/TC D-7
/HVSEL1 D-8
/HVSEL2 D-9
/HVSEL3 D-10
/GRIDL D-11
BIAS D-12
P-GND D-13
SW24V D-14
CN10(B30B-PHDSS-B)
FW B-1
/PR B-2
HLOUT1 B-3
HLOUT2 B-4
POFFR# B-5
GND B-6
GND B-7
GND B-8
3.3V B-9
3.3V B-10
3.3V B-11
12V B-12
/PSFAN B-13
5V B-14
5V B-15
GND B-16
GND B-17
24VINT B-18
24V B-19
24VINT B-20
PGND B-21
PGND B-22
PGND B-23
3.3Vsub B-24
3.3Vsub B-25
GND B-26
GND B-27
5Vsub B-28
GND B-29
GND B-30
MCU PWB
BR
PK
LB
PL
BR
LB
PK
PL
BR
PK
PL
GY
RD
PL
BR
LB
PL
BR
GY
GY
GY
BL
BL
BL
LB
PL
OR
OR
GY
GY
RD
RD
RD
GY
GY
GY
BL
BL
GY
GY
OR
GY
GY
CN901(B10B-PH-K-S)
P-GND
F-1
P-GND
F-2
P-GND
F-3
24V
F-4
24V
F-5
24V
F-6
5V
F-7
3.3V
F-8
S-GND
F-9
S-GND F-10
OP CONNECTOR PWB(2/2)
GY
GY
GY
RD
RD
RD
OR
BL
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
RD
RD
RD
OR
BL
GY
GY
BR
PK
LB
PL
BR
LB
PK
PL
BR
PK
PL
GY
RD
PL
BR
LB
PL
BR
GY
GY
GY
BL
BL
BL
LB
PL
OR
OR
GY
GY
RD
RD
RD
GY
GY
GY
BL
BL
GY
GY
OR
GY
GY
P/S PWB(2/3)
FW
/PR
HLOUT1
HLOUT2
POFFR#
GND
GND
GND
3.3V
3.3V
3.3V
12V
/PSFAN
5V
5V
GND
GND
24VINT
24V
24VINT
PGND
PGND
PGND
3.3Vsub
3.3Vsub
GND
GND
5Vsub
GND
GND
CN201(B10B-PH-K-S)
E-1 P-GND
E-2 P-GND
E-3 P-GND
E-4 24V
E-5 24V
E-6 24V
E-7 5V
E-8 3.3V
E-9 S-GND
E-10 S-GND
1
2
3
4
5
6
F-GND
CN1(B03P-VL)
LIVE 1
N.C 2
NEUTRAL 3
CN102(B3B-PH-K-S)
/PSFAN 1
N.C 2
GND 3
AC-L OUT
N.C
AC-N OUT
AC-L IN
N.C
AC-N IN
CN2(B06P-VL)
BC
250
CN10(B14B-PH-K-S)
187
C-1 NC
MC
C-2 TCDA#
C-3 /CVSEL
C-4 /TCLON
CN11(B3P-VH "BLACK")
C-5 /BPWM
MCFB 3
C-6 /MC
N.C 2
C-7 /TC
GRID 1
C-8 /HVSEL1
C-9 /HVSEL2
C-10 /HVSEL3
C-11 /GRIDL
C-12 BIAS
C-13 P-GND
C-14 SW24V
187
TC
A-1
A-2
A-3
A-4
A-5
A-6
A-7
A-8
A-9
A-10
A-11
A-12
A-13
A-14
A-15
A-16
A-17
A-18
A-19
A-20
A-21
A-22
A-23
A-24
A-25
A-26
A-27
A-28
A-29
A-30
CN101(B30B-PHDSS-B)
WH
WH
BK
BK
AC SW
<BC HARNESS> RD
<TC HARNESS> WH
<GB/MCFB HARNESS>
<MC HARNESS>
<AC SW HARNESS>
RD
WH
WH
PK
BK
187
187
PS FAN
BC
TC
TC high
voltage
Holder
Socket Holder
PM PWB
BPC
APC
DV UNIT
TCS
SMR-03V-N
RD
1
BR
2
GY
3
GY
LB
OR
PL
BR
PK
GY
RD
177622-5
/PMCLK 1
/PMRDY 2
/PMD 3
P-GND 4
24V 5
OR
LB
PL
BR
PK
GY
LB
OR
LB
GY
B3B-PH-K-S
GND 3
/SYNC 2
5V 1
B10B-PH-K-S
5V 4
/SYNC 5
/VIDEO 6
/SAMP 7
APCSTT 8
GND 9
LPSEL 10
5V 3
/SYNC 2
GND 1
TSR-04V-K
GND
5V
DEVCLK#
DECID#
1
2
3
4
52025-0811
DV BIAS
8
N.C
7
GND
6
DEV
5
N.C
4
N.C
3
TONER
2
24V
1
GY
OR
PK
LB
PL
RD
GY
BR
RD
<LSU HARNESS>
PI8-FX-4P-DS
1
2
3
4
51010-0811
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
CRUM PWB
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
OR
LB
PL
BR
PK
GY
LB
PL
BR
PK
GY
RD
LSU UNIT
OR 1 SW5V
LB 2 /SYNC
PL 3 /VIDEO
BR 4 /SAMP
PK 5 APCSTT
GY 6 GND
LB 7 LPSEL
PL 8 /PMCLK
BR 9 /PMRDY
PK 10 /PMD
GY 11 P-GND
RD 12 24V
GY
3
PL
2
OR
1
PHNR-03-H
CONNECTOR HOLDER
BU03P-TR-P-H
GY
GY
1 GND
PL
PL
2 TRAYPAPER
OR
OR
3 PullUp
PHNR-03-H
CN12(B02P-NV)
RD
DV BIAS
1
GND
2
GP1S73P
GND
2
TRAYPAPER 1
PullUP
3
OZON FAN
SMP-03V-NC
1 OZFANOUT
2
/OZFAN
3
GND
OR
LB
PL
BR
PK
GY
LB
PL
BR
PK
GY
RD
RD
BR
GY
GY
PL
OR
GY
BR
PL
RD
GY
OR
PK
LB
CN13(B28B-PHDSS-B)
8 OZFANOUT
10 /OZFAN
12 GND
2 GND
4 TRAYPAPER
6 PullUp
22 GND
24 DEV
26 TONER
28 24V
14 GND
16 5V
18 DEVCLK#
20 DECID#
3 N.C
1 SW5V
5 /SYNC
7 /VIDEO
9 /SAMP
11 APCSTT#
13 GND
15 LPSEL#
17 /PMCLK
19 /PMRDY
21 /PMD
23 P-GND
25 24V
27 N.C
1
2
3
RD
RD
CN28(1-171825-2)
/CV_SIZE3 1
/CV_SIZE2 2
/CV_SIZE1 3
/CV_SIZE0 4
/CV_DPX
5
/CV_STAPLE 6
/CV_CA
7
/CV_START 8
/CV_COUNT 9
/CV_COPY 10
P-GND
11
24V
12
CN27(B13B-PH-K-S)
/PNC#
1
/COPY#
2
/CA#
3
/AUD-READY 4
/AUD-DTC
5
5V
6
GND
7
24V
8
N.C
9
/AUD-TC
10
24V
11
/PNC-a
12
P-GND
13
CN3(B2P-VH)
TMD 1
/TMD 2
CN8(10FE-BT-VK-N)
P-GND
1
P-GND
2
SW24V
3
SW24V
4
P-GND
5
/MMD
6
P-GND
7
/MMRDY
8
/MMSEL
9
P-GND
10
1
2
RD
RD
1
2
SEPARATION PAWL
SOLENOID
Interlock SW
TONER MOTOR
SW
<INTERLOCK SW HARNESS>
SMR-02V-NC
1
2
3
SMP-03V-NC
10FE-BT-VK-N
10 P-GND
9 P-GND
8 SW24V
7 SW24V
6 P-GND
5 /MMD
4 P-GND
3 /MMRDY
2 /MMSEL
1 P-GND
24V
/PREMSOL
24VINT
NC
SW24V
(FFC)
COIN VENDER
(OPTION)
Auditor UN
(Option)
RD
LB
SMP-02V-N
SMR-03V-N
RD
1
2
RD
3
CN1(B4B-PH-K-R)
RD
24V 1
LB
/PREMSOL 2
N.C 3
N.C 4
CN18(B3P-VH)
24VINT
NC
SW24V
MCU PWB
PS PWB (3/3)
3
2
1
CN25(B4B-PH-K-S)
/DHROFF 1
NC 2
NC 3
24V 4
CN17(B40B-PADSS-1)
24V 1
24V 2
P-GND 3
P-GND 4
GND 5
GND 6
GND 7
GND 8
5V 9
5V 10
3.3V 11
3.3V 12
P-GND 13
LUM2# 14
Y1A 15
PCS2# 16
Y1B 17
PCL2# 18
Y2 19
LUM1B# 20
CSSELA# 21
TRCLB# 22
CSSELC# 23
PCS1B# 24
CSSELB# 25
PCL1B# 26
BI# 27
AI# 28
/BI# 29
/AI# 30
/OPCASSEL 31
LUM1A# 32
24V 33
TRCLA# 34
24V 35
PCS1A# 36
P-GND 37
PCL1A# 38
P-GND 39
GND 40
MCU PWB
WH
BK
RD
RD
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
OR
OR
BL
BL
GY
PK
BR
PL
LB
PK
BR
PL
LB
PK
BR
PL
LB
PK
BR
PL
LB
PK
BR
PL
RD
LB
RD
PK
GY
BR
GY
GY
(172074-7)
B L
C N
(172074-7)
(172074-1)
DH-L B
DH-N C
(172074-1)
(XLP-02V)
A-1
DH-L
A-1
A-2
DH-N
A-2
(XLR-02V)
<DEHUMIDIFICATION
HEATER SW HARNESS>
DEHUMIDIFICATION
HEATER SW
RD
RD
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
GY
OR
OR
BL
BL
GY
PK
BR
PL
LB
PK
BR
PL
LB
PK
BR
PL
LB
PK
BR
PL
LB
PK
BR
PL
RD
LB
RD
PK
GY
BR
GY
GY
/DHROF
24V
(XLP-02V)
C-1
DH-L
A-1
C-2
DH-N
A-2
(XLR-02V)
(XLP-02V)
C-1
DH-L
A-1
C-2
DH-N
A-2
(XLR-02V)
(XLP-02V)
C-1
DH-L
A-1
C-2
DH-N
A-2
(XLR-02V)
2
1
1
2
3
1
2
3
(XLP-02V)
C-1
DH-L
A-1
C-2
DH-N
A-2
(XLR-02V)
(XLP-02V)
B-1
DH-L
A-1
B-2
DH-N
A-2
(XLR-02V)
(XLP-02V)
B-1
DH-L
A-1
B-2
DH-N
A-2
(XLR-02V)
(XLP-02V)
B-1
DH-L
A-1
B-2
DH-N
A-2
(XLR-02V)
L
N.C
N
CN1(B40B-PADSS-1)
1 24V
2 24V
3 P-GND
4 P-GND
5 GND
6 GND
7 GND
8 GND
9 5V
10 5V
11 3.3V
12 3.3V
13 P-GND
14 LUM2#
15 Y1A
16 PCS2#
17 Y1B
18 PCL2#
19 Y2
20 LUM1B#
21 CSSELA#
22 TRCLB#
23 CSSELC#
24 PCS1B#
25 CSSELB#
26 PCL1B#
27 BI#
28 AI#
29 /BI#
30 /AI#
31 /OPCASSEL
32 LUM1A#
33 24V
34 TRCLA#
35 24V
36 PCS1A#
37 P-GND
38 PCL1A#
39 P-GND
40 GND
LIVE
NEUTRAL
(B02P-XL)
B-1
B-2
4th CASSETTE
DEHUMIDIFICATION HEATER
3rd CASSETTE
DEHUMIDIFICATION HEATER
2nd CASSETTE
DEHUMIDIFICATION HEATER
1st CASSETTE
DEHUMIDIFICATION HEATER
to IMC PWB
CN7(TX25-60P-6ST-H1)
1 5V
2 5V
3 3.3V
4 3.3V
5 /RESET#
6 /PWOFF#
7 /PRLINE
8 /HSYNC
9 GND
10 GND
11 GND
12 N.C
13 /ESPAGE
14 ESCMD
15 /ESCRDY
16 GND
17 GDATA0
18 GDATA2
19 GDATA4
20 GDATA6
21 GDATA8
22 GDATA10
23 GDATA12
24 GDATA14
25 N.C
26 /ESACK1P
27 N.C
28 /ESPRD
29 /ESACK0P
30 GND
31 5V
32 5V
33 3.3V
34 3.3V
35 N.C
36 N.C
37 /SCLINE
38 /READY
39 GND
40 GND
41 GND
42 N.C
43 /ESDET
44 ESSTS
45 /ESSRDY
46 GND
47 GDATA1
48 GDATA3
49 GDATA5
50 GDATA7
51 GDATA9
52 GDATA11
53 GDATA13
54 GDATA15
55 N.C
56 /ESREQ1P
57 /ESCS1P
58 /ESREQ0P
59 /ESCS0P
60 GND
Mother-PWB
CN3 (TX24-60R-12ST-H1)
CN5(TX25-60P-12ST-H1)
3.3Vsub
3.3Vsub
24V
GND
GND
/SCLINE
/READY
5V
GDATA1
GDATA3
GDATA5
GDATA7
GDATA9
GDATA11
GDATA13
GDATA15
/PRINTWU
/PCLDET
PCLSTS
/PCLSRDY
/PCLREQ1P
/PCLCS1P
/PCLREQ0P
/PCLCS0P
/FAXDET
FAXSTS
/FAXSRDY
/FAXREQ0P
/FAXCS0P
3.3V
5Vsub
EXTRS
GND
GND
/RESET
/PWOFF#
/PRLINE
/HSYNC
/PSSTS
GDATA0
GDATA2
GDATA4
GDATA6
GDATA8
GDATA10
GDATA12
GDATA14
/FWUAX
/PCLPAGE
PCLCMD
/PCLCRDY
/PCLPRD
/PCLACK1P
/PCLACK0P
/FAXPAGE
FAXCMD
/FAXCRDY
/FAXPRD
/FAXACK0P
GND
MCU PWB
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
CN (TX25-60P-12ST-H1)
GR
CN1 (TX25-60P-12ST-H1)
CN (TX24-60R-12ST-H1)
FG
SRA-21T-3
to PCL PWB
or
GDI PWB
FAX PWB
CN8(B2B-PH-K-S)
WH
RHS1
BK
GND
2
CN7(B4B-PH-K-S)
TX+
1
RX+
2
RX3
TX4
<HANDSET CABLE>
24V
24V
5V
5V
3.3V
3.3V
/RESET
/PWOFF
/PRLINE
/HSYNC
GND
GND
/FAXPAGE
FAXCMD
/FAXCRDY
GND
GDATA0
GDATA2
GDATA4
GDATA6
GDATA8
GDATA10
GDATA12
GDATA14
GND
/FAXPRD
/FAXACK1P
GND
/FAXACK0P
GND
24V
24V
5V
5Vsub
3.3V
3.3V
EXTRS
FAXWU
/SCLINE
/READY
GND
GND
/FAXDET
FAXSTS
/FAXSRDY
GND
GDATA1
GDATA3
GDATA5
GDATA7
GDATA9
GDATA11
GDATA13
GDATA15
GND
/FAXREQ1P
/FAXCS1P
/FAXREQ0P
/FAXCS0P
GND
PL
PK
BL
BR
CN9(B3B-PH-K-S)
PK
SP+
1
LB
SP2
N.C
3
<SPEAKER HARNESS>
SPEAKER
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
3.3Vsub
3.3Vsub
24V
GND
GND
/SCLINE
/READY
5V
GDATA1
GDATA3
GDATA5
GDATA7
GDATA9
GDATA11
GDATA13
GDATA15
/PRINTWU
/PCLDET
PCLSTS
/PCLSRDY
/PCLREQ1P
/PCLCS1P
/PCLREQ0P
/PCLCS0P
/FAXDET
FAXSTS
/FAXSRDY
/FAXREQ0P
/FAXCS0P
3.3V
5Vsub
EXTRS
GND
GND
/RESET
/PWOFF#
/PRLINE
/HSYNC
/PSSTS
GDATA0
GDATA2
GDATA4
GDATA6
GDATA8
GDATA10
GDATA12
GDATA14
/FWUAX
/PCLPAGE
PCLCMD
/PCLCRDY
/PCLPRD
/PCLACK1P
/PCLACK0P
/FAXPAGE
FAXCMD
/FAXCRDY
/FAXPRD
/FAXACK0P
GND
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
HAND SET
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
24V
24V
5V
5V
3.3V
3.3V
/RESET
/PWOFF
/PRLINE
/HSYNC
GND
GND
/FAXPAGE
FAXCMD
/FAXCRDY
GND
GDATA0
GDATA2
GDATA4
GDATA6
GDATA8
GDATA10
GDATA12
GDATA14
GND
/FAXPRD
/FAXACK1P
GND
/FAXACK0P
GND
24V
24V
5V
5Vsub
3.3V
3.3V
EXTRS
FAXWU
/SCLINE
/READY
GND
GND
/FAXDET
FAXSTS
/FAXSRDY
GND
GDATA1
GDATA3
GDATA5
GDATA7
GDATA9
GDATA11
GDATA13
GDATA15
GND
/FAXREQ1P
/FAXCS1P
/FAXREQ0P
/FAXCS0P
GND
OPTION
5Vsub
5Vsub
3.3Vsub
3.3Vsub
/RESET
/PWOFF
/PRLINE
/HSYNC
GND
GND
GND
GND
/PCLPAGE
PCLCMD
/PCLCRDY
GND
GDATA0
GDATA2
GDATA4
GDATA6
GDATA8
GDATA10
GDATA12
GDATA14
GND
/PCLPRD
/PCLACK1P
GND
/PCLACK0P
GND
5Vsub
5Vsub
3.3Vsub
3.3V
/PRINTWU
PSSTS
/SCLINE
/READY
GND
GND
GND
GND
/PCLDET
PCLSTS
/PCLSRDY
GND
GDATA1
GDATA3
GDATA5
GDATA7
GDATA9
GDATA11
GDATA13
GDATA15
GND
/PCLREQ1P
/PCLCS1P
/PCLREQ0P
/PCLCS0P
GND
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
LEAD-FREE SOLDER
Example:
Lead-Free
5mm
(Danish)
ADVARSEL !
Lithiumbatteri Eksplosionsfare ved fejlagtig hndtering.
Udskiftning m kun ske med batteri
af samme fabrikat og type.
Levr det brugte batteri tilbage til leverandoren.
(English)
Caution !
Danger of explosion if battery is incorrectly replaced.
Replace only with the same or equivalent type
recommended by the manufacturer.
Dispose of used batteries according to manufacturers instructions.
Solder composition
code (Refer to the
table at the right.)
(Finnish)
VAROITUS
Paristo voi rjht, jos se on virheellisesti asennettu.
Vaihda paristo ainoastaan laitevalmistajan suosittelemaan
tyyppiin. Hvit kytetty paristo valmistajan ohjeiden
mukaisesti.
a
z
(French)
ATTENTION
Il y a danger dexplosion s il y a remplacement incorrect
de la batterie. Remplacer uniquement avec une batterie du
mme type ou dun type quivalent recommand par
le constructeur.
Mettre au rebut les batteries usages conformment aux
instructions du fabricant.
Sn-In-Ag-Bi
(Swedish)
Sn-Cu-Ni
Sn-Ag-Sb
Bi-Sn-Ag-P
Bi-Sn-Ag
Sn-Ag-Cu
Sn-Ag-Bi
Sn-Ag-Bi-Cu
Sn-Zn-Bi
VARNING
Explosionsfara vid felaktigt batteribyte.
Anvnd samma batterityp eller en ekvivalent
typ som rekommenderas av apparattillverkaren.
Kassera anvnt batteri enligt fabrikantens
instruktion.
(German)
Achtung
Explosionsgefahr bei Verwendung inkorrekter Batterien.
Als Ersatzbatterien drfen nur Batterien vom gleichen Typ oder
vom Hersteller empfohlene Batterien verwendet werden.
Entsorgung der gebrauchten Batterien nur nach den vom
Hersteller angegebenen Anweisungen.
PARTS GUIDE
CODE:00ZARM277/P1E
MODEL
AR-M277
AR-M237
AR-M276
AR-M236
CONTENTS
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Exteriors 1
Exteriors 2
Delivery tray section
RSPF Exteriors 1(AR-M237/M277)
RSPF Exteriors 2(AR-M237/M277)
RSPF Paper feeding section(AR-M237/M277)
RSPF Transport section 1(AR-M237/M277)
RSPF Transport section 2(AR-M237/M277)
Operation panel unit
Frame section
Lump unit
Optical frame 1
Optical frame 2
Middle frame
550 cassette unit
Paper feed section
Paper transfer section
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
[
\
]
^
_
DV unit
Process unit
Fusing unit 1
Fusing unit 2
Drive unit
1st delivery paper unit 1
1st delivery paper unit 2
2nd delivery paper unit
PWB section
Rear frame section
2nd exteiors
2nd 550 cassette unit
2nd paper feed section
2nd paper transfer section
2nd drive section
Pick up motor unit
Packing material & accessories
Index
Because parts marked with "!" is indispensable for the machine safety maintenance and poeration, it must
Be replaced with the parts specific to the product specification.
SHARP CORPORATION
DEFINITION
The definition of each Rank is as follows and also noted in the list
Rank A : Maintenance parts, and consumable parts which are not included in but closely related to maintenance parts
Rank B : Performance/function parts (sensors, clutches, and other electrical parts), consumable parts
Rank E : Unit parts including PWB
Rank D : Preparation parts (External fitting, packing, parts packed together)
Rank C : Parts other than the above (excluding sub components of PWB)
Because parts marked with "!" is indispensable for the machine safety maintenance and operation, it must be replaced with
the parts specific to the product specification.
F Other than this Parts Guide, please refer to documents Service Manual(including Circuit Diagram)of this model.
F Please use the 13 digit code described in the right hand corner of front cover of the document, when you place an order.
F For U.S. only-Use order codes provided in advertising literature. Do not order from parts department.
1 Exteriors 1
NO.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
11
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
PARTS CODE
GCAB-0081QSZZ
GCAB-0080QSZZ
CFIX-0013QS05
PSHEZ0220QSZ1
LX-BZ0024QSZZ
GCAB-0084QSZZ
CGIDM0116QS02
LFIX-0011QSZB
PGLSP0003QSZZ
LFIX-0012QSZB
PSHEZ0221QSZZ
PGLSP0004QSZZ
PSHEZ0207QSZZ
PSHEZ0222QSZZ
PCUSS0011QSZZ
PSHEZ0208QSZZ
PCUSS0027QSZZ
PSHEZ0088QSZ1
PMLT-0093QSZZ
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AN
N
AN
N
AN
N
AK
AA
AV
N
AK
AP
N
BA
AK
N
AC
AX
AC
AC
AB
AC
AA
AD
N
AB
N
PART
RANK
D
D
D
C
C
D
C
D
B
D
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AQ
N
AA
AA
AR
N
AH
N
AN
N
AA
AZ
N
AK
N
AK
AB
AD
AP
AF
AC
AX
N
AS
AQ
AN
N
AX
N
AY
N
AG
N
AP
N
AW
N
AC
N
AX
N
AX
N
AX
N
AX
N
AC
AR
AA
AA
AK
AB
PART
RANK
D
C
C
D
D
D
C
D
D
D
C
C
D
C
C
D
D
B
D
D
D
D
D
D
C
D
D
D
D
C
C
C
C
D
D
DESCRIPTION
(AR-M276/M236)
(AR-M277/M237)
(AR-M277/M237)
(AR-M277/M237)
(AR-M277/M237)
(AR-M277/M237)
(AR-M277/M237)
(AR-M277/M237)
(AR-M277/M237)
2 Exteriors 2
NO.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
35
37
38
39
PARTS CODE
GCAB-0042QSZB
XEBSE30P12000
XHBSE30P08000
GCOV-0029QSZ1
GCOV-0056QSZZ
GCAB-0043QSZB
XEBSE40P10000
GCAB-0085QSZZ
GCOV-0034QSZB
GCOV-0031QSZZ
MSPRD0189QSZZ
MLEVP0069QSZZ
GDOR-0003QSZ1
NROLP1060FCZZ
MSPRT0229GCAZ
GCAB-0039QSZB
GCOV-0043QSZ1
PFILZ0011QSZ1
GCOV-0055QSZZ
GCOV-0054QSZZ
GCOV-0052QSZZ
GCOV-0053QSZ1
CCAB-0082QS01
GCAB-0083QSZZ
LBNDZ0002QSZZ
CCOV-0051QS08
CCOV-0051QS07
CCOV-0051QS02
CCOV-0051QS01
TLABZ4047FCZZ
TLABG0401QSZZ
XHBSE40P10000
LX-BZ0024QSZZ
GCOV-0042QSZZ
TCAUA0770FCZZ
DESCRIPTION
(AR-M276/M236)
(AR-M277)
(AR-M237)
(AR-M276)
(AR-M236)
(U.S.A,Europe,Australia,New Zealand)
(Hong Kong)
(Except LAG2,4)
2 Exteriors 2
NO.
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AD
AE
AS
AQ
AP
AM
AL
AP
AE
N
PARTS CODE
TLABZ0058QSZZ
TLABZ4312FCZZ
PGSK-0011QSZZ
PGSK-0012QSZZ
PGSK-0013QSZZ
PGSK-0014QSZZ
PGSK-0015QSZZ
PGSK-0016QSZZ
PMLT-0088QSZZ
PART
RANK
D
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
DESCRIPTION
Class 1 label
ECP label
OP PWB cover cushion A
OP PWB cover cushion B
OP PWB cover cushion C
OP PWB cover cushion D
OP PWB cover cushion E
OP PWB cover cushion F
Right exterior upper cushion R
1 Exteriors 1
[Except U.S.A,Canada,Taiwan,LAG2,Brazil]
(Canada)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
3
7
5
6
5
25
5
11
26
23
17
18
21
19
20
22
24
PRP01731
22
SPF only
2 Exteriors 2
47
3
37
9 7
42
37
8
42
44
40
43
3
46
4
2
3
37
39
17
45
19
3
21
12
11
7
20
18
14
15
14
15
48
13
22
7
7
35
38
35
16
23
7
41
26
10
35 7
3
24
27
25
PRP01732
35
2
PARTS CODE
XEPSD30P14X00
PCOVP0085QSZZ
PBOX-0016QSZZ
XEBSD30P10000
NFANP0015QSZZ
PDUC-0004QSZZ
XEBSE30P12000
PBOX-0006QSZZ
VHPGP1S73P+-1
MLEVP0068QSZZ
DHAI-0370QSZZ
LX-BZ0030QSZZ
LSOU-0040QSZZ
PSHEZ0286QSZZ
PSHEZ0283QSZZ
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AA
AP
AN
N
AA
BA
N
AL
AA
AF
AF
AC
AF
N
AC
BB
N
AE
AB
PART
RANK
C
D
C
C
B
C
C
D
B
C
C
C
D
C
C
DESCRIPTION
Screw(314)
Exhaust cover
Exhaust fan box
Screw(310)
Ozon fan motor
Exhaust fan duct
Screw(312)
Delivery sensor BOX
Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
Delivery tray actuator
Delivery paper detect sensor harness
Screw(M334P)
Delivery tray
Exhaust fan sheet
Fan motor sheet
14
20
11
12
20
12
4
10
11
8
17
6
4
7
PRP01733
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AR
N
AA
AA
AC
N
AT
N
AD
N
BL
N
AA
AK
N
AX
N
AX
N
AA
AD
BE
N
AW
AD
N
AE
AA
AE
N
AV
N
AN
N
AC
N
AF
AS
N
AD
N
AE
N
AC
AD
AA
AD
N
AW
N
AP
N
AH
N
AH
N
AK
N
BQ
N
BF
N
PARTS CODE
GCAB-0075QSZZ
XEBSE40P12000
XHBSE30P08000
LSTPP0016QSZZ
PCLC-0017QSZZ
NPLYZ0033QSZZ
CGIDM0106RS51
XHBSD30P10000
GCAB-0074QSZZ
MHNG-0021QSZZ
MHNG-0022QSZZ
XWVSD40-05000
NBRGC0018QSZZ
LSOU-0037QSZZ
PCUSS0022QSZZ
PSHEZ0413QSZZ
PSHEZ0077QSZ1
XEBSE30P08000
LPLTP0321QSZZ
GCAB-0078QSZZ
LSOU-0039QSZZ
MLEVP0098QSZZ
VHPGP1S73P+-1
CPWBF1501FCE2
NGERP0168QSZZ
NGERR0169QSZZ
MSPRC0250QSZZ
PTME-0271FCZZ
XEPSD30P08X00
MSPRP0315QSZZ
LSOU-0038QSZZ
LSOU-0041QSZZ
LPLTP0319QSZZ
LPLTP0320QSZZ
DHAI-0386QSZZ
CSOU-0037RS51
CSOU-0038RS51
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
501
502
PART
RANK
D
C
C
C
B
B
E
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
B
E
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
E
DESCRIPTION
Rear exterior
Screw(412)
Screw(38)
Stopper
SPF paper feed clutch
Coupling pulley(39P)
SPF Transport unit
Screw(310)
Front exterior
SPF hinge L
SPF hinge R
Washer
Bearing
Base tray
OC mat
OC mat sheet R
OC mat sheet F
Screw(38)
Sensor plate
Original tray lower exterior
Original tray S
Original detect actuator
Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
SPF VR PWB unit
Gear(36T)
Gear
Tray lock spring
Tray lock pawl
Screw(38)
Regulation plate spring
Original tray
Middle tray
Regulation plate F
Regulation plate R
Original tray harness
Base tray unit(Include Block 5-501)
Original tray unit
1
3
8
5 4
13
7
2
33
32
34
501
10
22
23
22
35
9
35
12
11
23
31
12
12
2
26
29
21
30
25
12
2
27
28
26
29
16
19
24
18
14
17
20
18
18
18
502
15
18
PRP01734
PARTS CODE
CPWBF0139QSE1
XHBSE30P08000
DHAI-0382QSZZ
LPLTM0111QSZZ
RPLU-0011QSZ1
PSPO-0023QSZZ
PSPO-0004QSZZ
RCORF0026FCZZ
MSPRD0342QSZZ
MLEVP0036QSZZ
MLEVF0093QSZZ
XBBSD30P05000
DHAI-0388QSZZ
MSPRD0211QSZZ
VHPGP1S73P+-1
MLEVP0092QSZZ
XRESP20-04000
NROLP0011QSZZ
PSPO-0020QSZZ
PSHEZ0285QSZZ
NSFTZ0013QSZZ
PSPO-0003QSZZ
LHLDZ0101QSZZ
MSPRD0305QSZZ
LPINS0327FCZZ
NSFTZ0072QSZZ
XRESP50-06000
NBRGM0501FCZZ
NSFTZ0009QSZZ
NROLP0010QSZZ
MSPRP0306QSZZ
LPLTM0316QSZZ
XEBSE30P08000
MSPRC0307QSZ1
MSPRP0123QSZZ
MSPRT0308QSZZ
PSHEZ0436QSZZ
PSHEZ0069QSZZ
LPLTP0117QSZZ
NBRGP0041GCZZ
PRNGP0090FCZZ
LSOU-0037QSZZ
CSOU-0037RS51
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
BA
N
AA
BA
N
AC
AQ
AB
AB
AL
AD
N
AD
AE
N
AA
AE
N
AC
AF
AC
N
AA
AD
AB
AB
AF
AC
AE
N
AC
N
AC
AP
N
AA
AB
AE
AD
AC
N
AH
N
AA
AC
N
AD
AC
N
AD
N
AE
AM
AD
AA
BE
N
BQ
N
PART
RANK
E
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
DESCRIPTION
SPF interface PWB unit
Screw(38)
SPF interface harness
Reinforce plate earth
Gate solenoid
Sound proof Sponge
Delivery gate sponge
Core(TRC-16813)
Delivery gate spring
Delivery gate lever
Pressure release lever
Screw(35)
Paper exit sensor harness
Delivery sensor ACT spring
Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
Delivery sensor ACT lever
E type ring
Delivery roller
Sponge
Sound proof sheet
Delivery shaft
Sound proof Sponge
Pressure release holder
Delivery spring
SP pin(210)
Pressure release shaft
E type ring
Metal D
Transport shaft
Transport roller
Spring
Base tray reinforce plate
Screw(38)
Earth spring
Transport spring
Transport earth spring
Sheet
Base tray sheet
Delivery gate
Bearing
Ring(E5)
Base tray
Base tray unit(Include Block 4-501)
2
5
4
1
12
6
7
43
12
9
42
11
10
41
13
14
15
29
16
40
18
20
44
19
39
17
38
501
27
31
34
26
24
29
22
20
30
28
19
21
37
17
33
30
25
18
32
36
23
24
28
27
PRP01735
30
35
33
33
33
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AP
N
AC
N
AR
AD
N
AC
N
AD
N
AC
AA
AF
N
AA
AC
N
AA
AD
N
AF
N
AD
AD
N
AT
N
AE
N
AC
N
AC
N
AQ
N
AQ
N
AC
N
AE
N
AC
N
AD
AE
AD
N
AD
N
AF
N
AF
N
AQ
N
AT
AD
N
AN
AN
AD
N
AF
N
AF
AH
N
AC
N
AC
N
AC
N
AC
N
AC
N
AZ
N
PARTS CODE
GCAB-0076QSZZ
NGERH0166QSZZ
PCLC-0316FCZ1
MLNKP0001QSZZ
MSPRD0309QSZZ
NGERH0167QSZZ
NBRGM0096FCZ1
XRESP50-06000
NSFTB0075QSZZ
XPSSP20-07000
LPLTM0318QSZZ
XEBSE30P08000
MSPRD0314QSZZ
NSFTZ0074QSZZ
NBRGC0018QSZZ
NPLYZ0033QSZZ
PCLC-0017QSZZ
MARMM0047QSZZ
LSTPP0016QSZZ
DHAI-0390QSZZ
PGIDM0105QSZZ
GCAB-0077QSZZ
MSPRP0311QSZZ
PTME-0029QSZZ
MSPRD0310QSZZ
NROLP0010QSZZ
NSFTZ0009QSZZ
MARMP0046QSZZ
PCOVP0094QSZZ
CSFTB0073QS01
MARMP0044QSZZ
LFRM-0069QSZZ
NCPL-0049FCBZ
NPLYZ0035QSZZ
NROLR1311FCZZ
NROLR1312FCZZ
NPLYZ0034QSZZ
NBLTT0033QSZZ
VHPGP1S73P+-1
DHAI-0387QSZZ
MLEVP0097QSZZ
LSTPP0015QSZZ
MLEVP0096QSZZ
MARMP0045QSZZ
MSPRD0313QSZZ
CCAB-0077RS51
(Unit)
901 C F R M - 0 0 6 9 R S 5 1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
46
47
48
49
50
501
BK
PART
RANK
D
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
B
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
E
C
C
C
B
B
B
B
B
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
DESCRIPTION
Open and shut exterior
Paper feed shaft gear(20T)
Torque limiter
Pickup link
Pickup arm spring
Paper feeding drive gear(32T)
Bearing
E type ring
Paper feed roller shaft
Spring pin(2-7)
Paper feeding earth plate
Screw(38)
JAM release spring R
PF roller shaft
Bearing
Coupling pulley(39P)
SPF paper feed clutch
U-turn PG arm R
Stopper
U-turn earth harness
U-turn guide
U-turn PG exterior
PS spring
U-turn PG lock pawl
U-turn PG lock spring
Transport roller
Transport shaft
U-turn PG arm F
Maintenance cover
Pickup roller shaft ASSY'
Pickup arm
Paper feeding frame
Coupling
Paper feeding roller pulley(16P)
Paper feed separation roller
Pickup roller
Pick up roller pulley(16P)
Drive belt
Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
PFUN harness
Original detect actuator
Stopper
Stopper release lever
Stopper arm
JAM release spring F
U-turn PG uint
2
3
11
9
7
21
10
19
18
49
7
9
48
47
20
13
17
14
13
15
49
13
48
23
46
47
13
43
22
13
12
29
24
13
44
26
13
45
50
31
36
34
13
30
13
13
29
27
43
44
26
35
28
32
13
41
40
42
9
37
13
38
901
501
39
PRP01736
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AP
N
AF
N
AP
N
AC
N
AC
N
AD
N
AA
AR
N
AR
N
AR
N
AE
N
AH
N
AB
AR
N
AL
AC
N
AB
AA
AA
AE
AA
AC
N
AA
AC
N
AD
N
AF
AA
AB
AA
AD
AE
N
AF
N
AC
AC
N
AH
N
AR
N
AM
N
AH
AS
N
AB
N
AD
N
BL
N
PARTS CODE
PGIDM0107QSZZ
PSHEZ0452QSZZ
PSHEZ0423QSZZ
LPLTP0328QSZZ
PSHEZ0451QSZZ
LPLTM0327QSZZ
XHBSE30P08000
NROLR0096QSZZ
NROLR0094QSZZ
NROLR0095QSZZ
PSHEZ0415QSZZ
LPLTM0325QSZZ
MSPRC0063QSZZ
DHAI-0384QSZZ
RDTCT0006QSZZ
PTME-0030QSZZ
NBRGM0501FCZZ
XRESP50-06000
XPSSP20-09000
NPLYZ0019QSZZ
PSHEP3029FCZZ
LHLDZ0102QSZZ
XEBSE30P08000
NKOM-0007QSZZ
MLEVP0095QSZZ
VHPGP1S73P+-1
XEBSE40P14000
MSPRC0153QSZZ
XWVSD40-05000
LPLTP0131QSZZ
JKNBZ0009QSZZ
NBLTT0036QSZZ
NBRGC0017QSZZ
MSPRD0316QSZZ
LPLTP0324QSZZ
NROLR0097QSZZ
LPLTM0326QSZZ
PBRSS0008QSZ1
PGIDM0106QSZZ
PSHEZ0454QSZZ
PSHEZ0455QSZZ
CGIDM0106RS51
PART
RANK
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
B
B
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
D
B
C
C
C
B
C
B
C
C
C
E
DESCRIPTION
Paper feeding guide
Front separate sheet
Separate sheet
SPF separate plate
Sound proof sheet
Silence plate
Screw(38)
Transport roller
PS roller
Read roller
White sheet
Transport plate
Delivery paper guide spring
RSPF harness
Inlet detect sensor
Open and shut lock pawl
Metal D
E type ring
Spring pin(2-9)
PS pulley
Flange sheet DUP2
Tension holder F
Screw(38)
Tension roller
Book sensor actuator
Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
Screw(414)
Book sensor spring
Washer
Book sensor attachment plate
JAM release knob(24P)
Belt(B79MXL4.0)
Bearing
Tension spring F
Reverse gate plate
Delivery roller
Paper feeding PG reinforce plate
Discharge brush
Transport R guide
PF PG cushion R
PF PG sound proof cushion
SPF Transport unit(Include Block 8-501,Without No.9,10,18)
5
46
47
44
42
43
45
21
28
11
21
47
20
28
22
41
17
23
18
36
35
37
40
38 24
39
28
24
33
26
18
30
17
25
34
32
13
19
22
23
12
27
23
22
14
23
29
28
16
15
PRP01737
PARTS CODE
RMOTS0043QSZZ
DHAI-0384QSZZ
PTPE-0018QSZZ
XEBSE30P08000
RPLU-0015QSZ1
PSPO-0022QSZZ
XRESP40-06000
PSHEZ0414QSZZ
NBLTT0034QSZZ
NGERH0170QSZZ
NBRGM0501FCZZ
NGERH0116QSZ1
XEPSD30P08X00
NGERH0117QSZZ
XPSSP20-09000
NPLYZ0019QSZZ
NBLTT0035QSZZ
PSHEP3029FCZZ
XRESP50-06000
MSPRP0312QSZZ
XHBSE30P08000
NBRGC0017QSZZ
NPLYZ0018QSZZ
PCLC-0018QSZZ
NKOM-0007QSZZ
MSPRT0317QSZZ
LHLDZ0103QSZZ
LPLTM0322QSZZ
LPLTM0323QSZZ
XBBSD30P05000
MSPRC0346QSZZ
CGIDM0106RS51
CPLTM0323RS51
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
BG
N
AR
N
AC
AA
AR
AB
AA
AB
N
AF
N
AD
N
AB
AD
AA
AK
AA
AE
AE
N
AA
AA
AD
N
AA
AC
AE
AT
N
AC
N
AC
N
AC
N
AF
N
AG
N
AA
AC
N
BL
N
AY
N
PART
RANK
B
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
B
C
C
C
C
C
B
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
E
DESCRIPTION
SPF motor
RSPF harness
Motor earth tape
Screw(38)
Pressure release solenoid
Sound proof Sponge
E type ring
Flange sheet
Belt(48S2M244)
Gear(48T/43P)
Metal D
Gear(48T/25P)
Screw(38X)
Gear(48T)
Spring pin(2-9)
PS pulley
Belt(B86MXL4.0)
Flange sheet DUP2
E type ring
U-turn earth spring
Screw(38)
Bearing
PS coupling pulley
PS clutch
Tension roller
Tension spring R
Tension holder R
Transport earth plate
Motor attachment plate
Screw(35)
PS Brake spring
SPF Transport unit(Include Block 7-501)
Drive unit(Without No.4)
31
502
4
5
3
8
9
10
11
32
4
30
32
20
12
19
14
18
17
13
15
4
21
16
20
22
12
23
20
25
34
19
35
20
12
24
26
28
14
29
27
PRP01738
8
501
GCOV-0057QSZZ
XEBSE40P10000
CPWBN0146QSE2
VVLLM065HB1-1
DHAI-0361QSZZ
PCOVP0095QSZZ
HPNLH0030QSZZ
PTPE-0052QSZZ
LHLDZ0105QSZZ
XEBSE30P08000
PSHEZ0424QSZZ
PSHEZ0425QSZZ
DHAI-0362QSZZ
CPWBF0145QSE1
XEBSE30P08000
CBTN-0069QS02
CBTN-0068QS01
CBTN-0070QS01
CBTN-0071QS01
20
CBTN-0071QS02
21
22
23
24
CFILW0284FC02
CFILW0282FC02
CFILW0283FC02
GCAB-0086QSZZ
CPNLH0029QS05
CPNLH0029QS06
LPINS0014QSCZ
LPINS0014QSBZ
LPLTM0346QSZZ
LPLTM0331QSZZ
RCORF0002QSZZ
CHLDZ0105RS51
(Unit)
CPNLH0029RS55
25
26
27
29
30
32
501
901
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AT
N
AA
BU
N
CB
AE
N
AG
N
BC
N
AA
N
AG
N
AA
AL
N
AE
N
AD
N
AX
N
AA
AF
N
AF
N
AN
N
AM
N
N
AM
PARTS CODE
AF
AK
AH
AV
AY
AY
AF
AF
AC
AC
AE
AU
BY
PART
RANK
D
C
E
E
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
C
C
C
C
C
C
N
N
N
N
N
N
DESCRIPTION
Operation panel cover
Screw(410)
OPU PWB
LCD module
LCD M harness
LCD cover
Touch panel(A126)
Touch panel fixing tape
LCD holder
Screw(38)
Anti static electricity sheet
PWB protect sheet
Key PWB harness
KEY PWB
Screw(38)
CA key
Start key AS
Ten key
Mode key AS
Mode key AS [No FAX]
D
D
D
D
D
D
C
C
C
C
C
E
C key smoke AS
Copy key smoke AS
CA key smoke AS
Operation panel exterior
Main panel
Main panel
Fixing pin D
Fixing pin E
LCD earth plate
PWB earth plate
Core(HF57SH35*1)
LCD unit
Operation panel
N
N
(U.S.A,Other Countries)
(U.S.A,Other Countries)
(Algeria,Iran,Egypt,Syria,Tunisa,Nigeria,West Africa,
Morocco,Jordan,Lebanon,Special Country,Brazil,LAG2,4)
(U.S.A,Other Countries)
32
16
31
16
16
16
16
14
16
2
13
29
16
3
16
21
23
22
15
16
30
16
33
17
10
18
6
16
20
9
19
16
8
8
7
24
25
26
27
501
12
27
26
PRP01739
9
F Frame section
NO.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
11
14
15
16
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
55
56
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AK
AA
AU
N
AX
AA
AK
N
AB
AD
N
AD
N
BH
N
AB
AA
AX
N
AA
AF
AS
N
AC
AC
BB
AE
AG
AC
AA
AA
AC
AB
AH
N
AD
N
AR
N
AF
N
AE
N
AQ
AP
AH
AS
AA
AB
N
AC
N
AD
N
AQ
N
PARTS CODE
LPLTM0163QSZZ
XHBSE30P08000
LPLTM0232QSZ1
CFRM-0043QS02
XEBSD40P10000
CPLTM0168QS02
PSHEZ0065QSZZ
NGERH0173QSZZ
NPLYZ0036QSZZ
LDAI-0023QSZB
LHLDW1061FCZZ
XHBSE40P10000
LPLTM0333QSZZ
XRESP40-06000
NBLTT0026QSZZ
LPLTM0165QSZ1
PCOVP0066QSZZ
LPLTM0166QSZZ
CFRM-0044QS02
LPLTM0251QSZZ
NSFTZ0048QSZZ
NKOM-0005QSZZ
XBPSD30P08KS0
XHBSE30P06000
PSHEZ0333QSZZ
PSHEZ0325QSZZ
CPLTM0342QS01
NGERH0174QSZZ
RMOTS0045QSZZ
NBLTT0038QSZZ
LPLTM0332QSZZ
PGSK-0021QSZZ
PGSK-0022QSZZ
PGSK-0023QSZZ
MSPRD0276QSZZ
XEBSE40P12000
PMLT-0092QSZZ
PMLT-0089QSZZ
PMLT-0091QSZZ
PGSK-0026QSZZ
PART
RANK
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
B
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
DESCRIPTION
Left reinforce plate lower
Screw(38)
Frame support plate R
Corner frame RL
Screw(310)
DUP drive idle plate
Pully flange sheet
DUP gear
DUP pulley gear
Base plate
Harness holder(HL-18-0)
Screw(410)
Frame support plate F
E type ring
DUP drive belt
Front support plate
Interlock cover
Front support adjusting plate
Right frame unit
PS earth plate
Cassette collar shaft
Cassette guide collar
Screw(38KS)
Screw(36)
PS front sheet
Frame lower mylar
DU motor fixing plate ASSY'
DUP drive gear
DUP 2 motor
DUP drive belt TL
Fusing unit earth plate
Frame rainforce cushion A
Frame rainforce cushion B
Frame rainforce cushion C
Front earth spring
Screw(412)
Frame RR cushion
Right frame cushion F
Right frame cushion A
OP holder cushion
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
F Frame section
15
56
47
48
3
49
15
1
2
5
15
52
42 44
5
15
53
54
7
16
20
14
54
15
26
46
25
50
41
15
40
51
23
24
28
15
55
2
21
7
7 9
19
8
2
PRP01740
10
18
11
43
15
15
18
45
22
27
5
G Lump unit
NO.
!
PARTS CODE
PREFL0004QSZZ
RLMPU0012QSZZ
LHLDZ0047QSZ2
MSLI-0138FCZZ
PCUSU0203FCZZ
MSPRP0145QSZZ
PMIR-0009QSZZ
DUNTK0034QSZZ
DHAI-0200QSZZ
LFIX-0009QSZZ
PCUSF0334FCZZ
XEPSD30P06000
LPLTM4715FCZ1
TCAUH0933FCZZ
XEPSD40P06000
(Unit)
901 C R E F L 0 0 0 4 Q S 3 3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
14
15
16
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AP
BG
AW
AC
AE
AF
AS
BC
AS
AF
AP
AA
AF
AB
AA
PART
RANK
D
B
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
BL
DESCRIPTION
Riflector
Lump
Base
Slider
Protection cushion
Spring
1st mirror
Inverter unit
CL harness
Harness fixing
Cushion
Screw(36)
Wire fixing plate
High temperature caution label
Screw(46)
Copy lamp unit
G Lump unit
16
1
16
4
2
3
16
5
4
14
6
7
12
12
9
15
8
12
10
12
11
5
6
4
14
12
12
PRP01741
12
11
H Optical frame 1
NO.
1
2
3
4
5
6
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AQ
BH
N
AF
AD
AA
AQ
BL
AA
AC
AB
AG
AG
AA
BG
AB
AK
AL
AA
AB
AA
AC
AG
AM
AB
AB
AS
N
AA
AH
AH
AA
AA
AC
AA
AH
N
AA
AH
N
AU
AH
AF
AK
PARTS CODE
PWIR-0006QSZZ
CDAIU0012QS11
NPLYZ0016QSZZ
NPLYZ0006QSZZ
XRESP40-05000
PWIR-0005QSZ1
CREFL0004QS33
XBPSD40P06K00
LHLDZ0056QSZZ
LX-BZ0004QSZZ
LRALM0007QSZ1
LRALM0006QSZZ
XBPSD30P05K00
RMOTP0027QSZZ
MSPRC0040QSZZ
CPLTM0084QS02
PGUMS0002QSZZ
XBPSD40P16KS0
PCUSG0190FCZ1
XRESP50-06000
NBRGP0012QSZZ
NPLYZ0004QSZZ
NPLYZ0003QSZZ
LX-BZ0049FCZZ
XPSSJ30-12000
NSFTZ0028QSZ1
LX-BZ0324FCZZ
NBLTT0002QSZZ
NGERH0027QSZZ
LX-WZ0119FCZZ
XRESP70-08000
NBRGP0011QSZZ
LX-BZ0024QSZZ
PGIDM0108QSZZ
XHBSE30P08000
PGIDM0109QSZZ
PSHEM0342QSZZ
PGIDH0095QSZZ
PTPE-0036QSZZ
PTPE-0032QSZZ
PART
RANK
C
D
C
C
C
C
E
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
DESCRIPTION
MB wire F
Optical frame
Pulley
L pulley
E type ring
MB wire R
Copy lamp unit
Screw(46K)
Wire holder
Screw
MB-B rail R
MB-B rail F
Screw(35K)
Mirror motor
MB drive spring
Mirror motor fixing plate
Protection rubber
Screw(416KS)
Table glass cushion
E type ring
Winder bearing F
Winder drive shaft pulley
Winder pulley
Screw
Spring pin(3-12)
Winder drive shaft
Screw
Winder drive belt
Mirror motor idle gear
Washer
E type ring
Winder bearing F
Screw
Hinge guide L
Screw(38)
Hinge guide R
MCU earth sheet
CCD harness guide
CCD harness fixing tape
CCD cable shield tape
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
H Optical frame 1
3
4
36
34
5
9
10
7
5
3 4
34
38
35
39 36
11
8
9
2
10
36
37
41 16
19
40
18
11
13
18
12
19
21
22
31
30 29
28
23
24
26
11
25
32
33
28
27
24
25
12
14
20
32
11
15
17
PRP01742
I Optical frame 2
NO.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
24
25
26
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
38
39
40
41
43
44
45
PARTS CODE
PCOVP0075QSZZ
XNESD30-24000
VHPGP2D07//-1
VHPGP2D03//-1
DHAI-0346QSZZ
DHAI-0347QSZZ
LHLDW1009ACZZ
XBBSF30P08000
CPWBF0083QSE5
CDAIU0012QS11
PCUSG0190FCZ1
XHBSD30P06000
RSNSZ0001QSZZ
VHPGP2D032/-1
XBPSD30P08X00
LPLTP0230QSZZ
VHPGP1S73P+-1
MSPRD0232QSZZ
MLEVP0077QSZZ
LCRA-0002QSZZ
TLABH0461QSZZ
LHLDZ0104QSZZ
PSHEZ0218QSZZ
PSHEZ0217QSZZ
PSHEZ0448QSZZ
PCASZ0010QSZZ
LHLDZ7021XCZZ
RCORF0002QSZZ
CLNS-0003RS54
LX-BZ0004QSZZ
DHAI-0345QSZZ
PSHEZ0108QSZZ
PSHEZ0219QSZZ
LX-BZ0031GCZZ
PSHEZ0254QSZZ
PSHEZ0273QSZZ
PGSK-0008QSZZ
XWHSD40-08100
PMLT-0094QSZZ
PSHEZ0420QSZZ
PTPE-0051QSZZ
PSHEZ0426QSZZ
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AE
AA
BA
BA
AP
N
AN
N
AA
AA
AU
BH
N
AB
AA
BA
BA
AA
AF
AF
AB
AC
AC
AG
AD
N
AC
AC
AA
N
AL
AD
AE
BQ
N
AB
AG
N
AC
AC
AB
AC
AB
AF
AA
AC
N
AC
AC
AB
PART
RANK
D
C
B
B
C
C
C
C
E
D
C
C
B
B
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
E
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
Harness cover
Nut(M3)
Photo senser(GP2D07)
Photo senser(GP2D03)
Optical sensor harness
Optical sensor harness
Clamp
Screw(38)
Sensor PWB
Optical frame
Table glass cushion
Screw(36)
Photo senser(GP2D071)
Photo senser(GP2D032)
Screw(38)
Open/close sensor fixing plate
Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
Return spring
Open/Close actuator
Mini clump
Clean caution label
CL lead holder
Edge protect mylar A
CCD harness protect mylar B
Optical base plate bottom myler B
Durk box
Holder(FRH-12)
Core(HF57SH35*1)
Lens unit
Screw
CCD harness
Optical base plate bottom myler A
Edge protect mylar B
Screw
Optical bottom mylar
CCD harness protect mylar A
Gasket
Washer
Cushion ORG
OP harness protect mylar
OP harness protect tape
OP harness protect mylar B
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
BW
N
AA
AD
AA
AL
N
AL
N
AH
AS
N
AD
AD
AD
AH
N
AB
AD
AA
AU
AA
AE
AE
AQ
AD
AD
AD
AB
AD
AP
N
AF
AB
AD
AA
AA
BA
N
AA
PART
RANK
E
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
LSU unit
Screw(3x14X)
Separator pawl arm
Screw(310)
MC harness
GBMCFB harness
High voltage terminal holder A
DV/LSU interface harness
High voltage terminal saw teeth
High voltage terminal grid L
High voltage terminal case L
ILSW I/F harness 2
Screw
Connector fixing plate
E type ring
PS clutch
Screw(35)
TR terminal holder
TR terminal plate
PS roller
Bearing
ILSW cover
Right door stopper
Stopper spring
ILSW lever
Inter lock switch
ILSW holder
ILSW spring
PS knob
Screw(38KS)
Screw(36ES)
Middle frame
E type ring
DESCRIPTION
[AB
[Inch
[AB
[Inch
[AB Series]
[Inch Series]
(U.S.A,Canada)
J Middle frame
NO.
1
2
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
18
19
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
39
40
41
42
43
44
PARTS CODE
DUNTK0384RSZZ
XEPSD30P14X00
MARMP0025QSZZ
XEBSD30P10000
CHAI-0356RS51
CHAI-0357RS51
LHLDZ0057QSZZ
DHAI-0373QSZZ
MSPRD0190QSZ1
MSPRD0191QSZ1
MSPRD0192QSZ1
DHAI-0353QSZZ
LX-BZ0020QSZZ
LPLTM0149QSZZ
XRESP50-06000
PCLC-0006QSZZ
XBBSD30P05000
LHLDZ0085QSZZ
LPLTM0248QSZZ
NROLR0089QSZZ
NBRGC0018QSZZ
PCOVP0062QSZZ
LSTPP0010QSZZ
MSPRC0220QSZZ
MLEVP0071QSZZ
CSW-M0007RS56
LHLDZ0065QSZ1
MSPRT0221QSZZ
JKNBZ0006QSZZ
XBPSD30P08KS0
XBPSC30P06ES0
LFRM-0037QSZ2
XRESP60-08000
DESCRIPTION
13
Series]
Series]
Series]
Series]
J Middle frame
NO.
45
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
PARTS CODE
LPLTM0194QSZZ
RMOTD0023QSZZ
MSPRC0195QSZZ
NCPL-0011QSZZ
RPLU-0024QSZZ
MSPRC1318FCZ1
LPINS0300FCZZ
LPINS0301FCZZ
XEBSD40P10000
XEBSD30P06000
DHAI-0354QSZZ
DHAI-0355QSZZ
XEBSD30P10000
TCAUH0007QSZZ
MSPRC0271QSZZ
XEPSD23P12000
PSHEZ0394QSZZ
QSW-B0017QSZZ
CPLTM0160RS53
RCORF0013QSZZ
LBNDJ0013FCZ1
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AC
AZ
AB
AC
AM
AA
AD
AD
AA
AA
AG
N
AG
N
AA
AD
AC
AA
AB
AF
BN
N
AG
AE
I Optical frame 2
PART
RANK
C
B
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
E
C
C
DESCRIPTION
DV fixing plate
Toner motor
Hopper spring
Hopper cupring
Pawl solenoid
Spring B
DV guide pin
DV guide pin
Screw(310)
Screw(36)
TC harness
BC harness
Screw(310)
Laser caution laber
Earth Spring
Screw(312)
Drum solenoid silence material
Tray detect switch
Drive unit
LSU harness core
Cable band
10
1
4
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
INCH
11 Series
16
14
15
12
10
7
2
(U.S.A,Other countries)
(Europe,Australia,New Zealand)
12
11
13
45
43
20
INCH
Series
2
31
34
41
10
9
32
21
19
24
10
39
39
17
18
33
10
25
40
26
40
30
9
33
22
42
38
22
29
10
25
22
46
22
28
J Middle frame
PRP01743
44
2
10
49
10
48
47
58
2
69
52 53
68
5
11
42
10
53 15
13
53
63
51
50
53
16
19
12
18
65
28
37
67
66
31 44
35
44
31
55
29
54
28
36
32
27
57
57
64
39
41
40
45
56
43
30
14
34
29
54
33
14
PRP01744
PARTS CODE
LPLTP0159QSZZ
LHLDW1226FCZZ
LPLTM0179QSZ1
PSHEZ0274QSZZ
GCASP0006QSZZ
PGIDM0070QSZ1
PTPE-0021QSZZ
LPLTM0181QSZ1
PGIDM0071QSZZ
LX-BZ0884FCZZ
NGERH0193FCZZ
MSPRC2631FCZZ
MLEVP0755FCZ1
LX-BZ0833FCZZ
PSHEZ0244QSZ2
XRESP70-08000
NGERH0108QSZZ
MSPRC0210QSZZ
NSFTZ0047QSZZ
LPLTM0180QSZ1
NBRGP0041GCZZ
XEBSE40P10000
JHNDP0004QSZZ
XBPSD40P08KS0
PCOVP0096QSZZ
LPLTM0277QSZZ
(Unit)
901 C C A S P 0 0 0 6 R S 5 1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
27
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AD
AB
AR
AC
BA
N
AM
AD
AB
AL
AB
AB
AC
AE
AC
AC
AA
AD
AC
AP
AE
AD
AA
AV
N
AA
AN
N
AC
BL
PART
RANK
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
DESCRIPTION
Cassette rear side plate
Turn fastener
Rotetion plate
Rotation plate sheet
550 cassette
Guide F
GID tape
Side plate guide F
Guide R
Screw
UC manual feed gear
Fusing pressure spring
Side plate F lever
Screw
Cassette mylar
E type ring
Lift gear(22T)
Lift gear spring
Lift shaft
Lift plate
Bearing
Screw(410)
Body cassette panel
Screw(48KS)
Cassette panel line
Side plate guide R
550 cassette unit
8
6
7
9
10
4
11
11
13
12
7
27
14
22
22
15
17
18
22
22
PRP01745
19
20
23
22
21
25
22
15
24
16
PARTS CODE
XEBSD30P10000
CPWBF0081QSE2
MLEVP0064QSZZ
MLEVP0063QSZZ
MLEVP0056QSZZ
MSPRD0201QSZZ
PCOVP0064QSZZ
RPLU-0026QSZ1
MARMP0026QSZZ
NROLR0054QSZZ
MARMP0019QSZZ
NGERH0990FCZZ
NROLR0055QSZ1
MARMP0021QSZZ
LPIN-0026MCZZ
NGERH0107QSZZ
MSPRD0206QSZZ
NBRGC0100FCZ1
NGERH0097QSZZ
DHAI-0350QSZZ
QSW-B0017QSZZ
NGERH0156QSZZ
MSPRC0209QSZ1
XRESP40-06000
XRESP50-06000
PCLC-0012QSZZ
NSFTZ0043QSZ1
VHPGP1S73P+-1
DHAI-0399QSZZ
PSHEZ0391QSZZ
PSHEZ0392QSZZ
PSHEZ0393QSZZ
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AA
AP
N
AD
AD
AC
AC
AD
AR
AD
AP
AD
AB
AR
AD
AA
AD
AC
AC
AF
AG
N
AF
AD
AC
AA
AA
AS
AH
AF
AF
N
AC
AB
AA
PART
RANK
C
E
C
C
C
C
D
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
B
C
B
C
C
C
C
DESCRIPTION
Screw(410)
Cassette sensor PWB
Paper detect actuator
Upper limit detect actuator
P-IN actuator
P-IN actuator spring
Solenoid cover
Paper feed solenoid
Solenoid arm
Pick up roller
Pick up arm F
Gear(16T)
Paper feed roller
Pick up arm R
Spring pin(2-10)
Paper feed gear(20T)
Pick up roller pressure spring
Bearing 6
2nd joint gear
Cassette sensor harness
Tray detect switch
Paper feed clutch gear(42T)
Solenoid spring
E type ring
E type ring
Paper feed clutch(42T)
Paper feed roller shaft
Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
Manual paper feeding empty harness
Paper feed solenoid silence material A
Paper feed solenoid silence material B
Paper feed solenoid silence material C
7 10
15
18
19
13
38
21
3
9
11
36
24
14
17
20
16
29
5
6
25
22
27 23
28
19
37
31
30
PRP01746
16
PARTS CODE
XEBSE40P12000
PCOVP0053QSZ2
MSPRD0194QSZ1
MSPRC0291QSZZ
NSFTZ0065QSZZ
NKOM-0006QSZZ
PSHEZ0133QSZZ
XEBSE40P10000
PGIDM0067QSZ1
MSPRD0233QSZ1
MLEVP0023QSZZ
MLEVP0044QSZZ
LPLTP0348QSZZ
MSPRC0301QSZZ
PFTA-0019QSZZ
XEBSD30P10000
PSHEZ0378QSZZ
LRALP0008QSZ1
VHPGP1S73P+-1
DHAI-0398QSZZ
MSPRD0202QSZZ
MLEVP0057QSZZ
PSHEZ0378QSZZ
LPLTP0297QSZZ
PCOVP0088QSZ1
MSPRC0270QSZZ
NKOM-0005QSZZ
NSFTZ0048QSZZ
XBPSD30P08KS0
XEBSD40P10000
PSHEZ0301QSZZ
PSHEZ0302QSZZ
LPLTM0276QSZZ
PSHEZ0322QSZZ
PSPO-0026QSZZ
LHLDZ0094QSZZ
MSPRC0292QSZZ
MSPRD0287QSZZ
NROLP0087QSZZ
NSFTZ0064QSZZ
PSHEZ0314QSZ1
LBRC-0012QSZZ
NKOM-0009QSZZ
NSFTZ0064QSZZ
MSPRD0340QSZZ
CGIDM0067RS51
CCOVP0053RS53
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AA
AP
AD
AC
AD
AC
AD
AA
AR
AC
AE
AE
AC
AD
N
AE
N
AA
AG
AQ
AF
AE
N
AB
AC
AG
AC
AD
N
AB
AC
AG
AA
AA
AC
AC
AE
AD
AA
AC
AC
AC
AD
AD
AF
AD
AC
AD
AC
N
AY
AW
PART
RANK
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
E
Screw(412)
Middle frame cover
PS earth spring LP
PS pressure spring
PS sub roller shaft
PS collar
Paper feeding sheet
Screw(410)
Base plate paper feed guide
MF actuator spring
MF sensor actuator
MF sensor actuator 2
Separation plate
Pressure plate spring
Pressure plate cover
Screw(310)
Separation sheet
Base plate rail
Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
Manual paper feeding PIN harness
Manual P-IN actuator spring
Manual paper feed P-IN actuator
Separation sheet
Separation plate
Plate cover
Separation plate spring
Cassette guide collar
Cassette collar shaft
Screw(38KS)
Screw(410)
Rail R side mylar F
Rail R side mylar R
Manual feed damper plate
Front separator sheet
MF ACT cushion
PS presure holder
PS sub presure spring
Paper feed assistance roller SP
Paper feed assistance roller
Paper feed assistance roller shaft
Toner protect mylar
Manual feed sub roller blacket
Manual feed sub roller
Manual feed sub shaft
Manual feed sub roller spring
Base plate paper feed guide unit
Middle frame cover unit
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AD
N
AY
AA
AC
AD
AA
AC
AC
AC
AN
AA
AP
AA
AF
AV
AD
N
AD
N
AD
AF
AA
AF
AF
AA
AA
AA
AA
AE
PART
RANK
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
Lock lever
Right door
E type ring
M bushing C
DUP roller driving gear
Pin(210)
Lock pawl
Lock pawl spring
Lock pawl arm
Lock pawl shaft
E type ring
DUP transport roller
Spring pin
PS upper roller
Right door inner
High voltage spring B
High voltage spring A
DUP roller eatrh plate
TR terminal interface holder
Screw(38)
TR pressure spring R
TR pressure spring F
Screw(310)
Screw(316)
Screw(314)
Screw(310)
Inner reinforce plate F
DESCRIPTION
PARTS CODE
MLEVP0058QSEZ
GDOR-0002QSZC
XRESP40-06000
LBSHZ0303FCZZ
NGERH0074QSZZ
LPINS0133FCZZ
PTME-0020QSZ1
MSPRD0222QSZZ
MARMP0043QSZZ
NSFTZ0055QSZ1
XRESP30-06000
NROLP0036QSZZ
XPSSJ20-07000
NROLP1122FCZZ
LFRM-0040QSZZ
MSPRC0349QSZZ
MSPRC0348QSZZ
LPLTM0102QSZZ
LHLDZ0084QSZZ
XEBSE30P08000
MSPRC0296QSZZ
MSPRC0295QSZZ
XHBSD30P10000
XHBSD30P16000
XHBSD30P14000
XEBSD30P10000
LPLTM0090QSZZ
DESCRIPTION
17
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AE
AE
AH
AB
AC
AB
AG
N
PARTS CODE
LPLTM0091QSZZ
MSPRD0205QSZZ
LRALP0004QSZ2
PSHEZ0307QSZ1
PSHEZ0330QSZZ
LX-BZ0032QSZZ
NGERH0163QSZ2
(Unit)
901 C D O R - 0 0 0 2 R S 5 8
29
30
31
34
36
38
39
BH
PART
RANK
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
DESCRIPTION
Inner reinforce plate R
TC grand spring
Right door rail
Right door mylar
Right door DUP mylar
Screw
TR Gear
36
502
1
1
501
3
5
11
4
4 39
10
38
6
38
44 13
14
9
35
46
15
45
17
12
37
47
20
16
19
34
33
21
22
18
28
23
27
41
42
40
26
25
24
40
29
16
503
31
31
PRP01747
2
12
3
4
27
15
4
13
3
15
26 25
38
16
14
23
14
30
28
27
5
26
11
38
25
27
24
36
31
24
34
34
11
9
8
10
22
36
19
24
17
20
29
31
34
34
32
27
24
32
21
39
18
33
PRP01748
18
PARTS CODE
PGIDM0075QSZZ
PGIDM0076QSZZ
XEBSE30P08000
LSOU-0024QSZB
PTME-0271FCZZ
MSPRC0250QSZZ
NGERR0140QSZZ
XEPSD30P06X00
NGERP1385FCZZ
LHLDZ0066QSZZ
LSOU-0026QSZB
QSW-B0017QSZZ
DHAI-0359QSZZ
MSPRP2830FCZZ
LPLTP0234QSZZ
MLEVP0035QSE1
CPWBF0106QSE4
LSOU-0025QSZB
VHPGP1S73P+-1
LSOU-0027QSZB
XEBSE30P06000
(Unit)
901 C S O U - 0 0 2 4 R S 5 5
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
22
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AF
AF
AA
AT
N
AD
AC
AD
AA
AF
AD
AU
N
AF
AP
N
AA
AE
AC
AP
N
AS
N
AF
AT
N
AA
BK
PART
RANK
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
B
C
C
C
C
E
D
B
D
C
E
DESCRIPTION
MB side guide F
MB side guide R
Screw(38)
Manual paper feed tray 1 upper
Tray lock pawl
Tray lock spring
Width detect rack
Screw(36X)
Width detect pinion
Harness holder
Manual paper feed tray 2 upper
Tray detect switch
Manual paper feeding unit harness
Width detect spring
Width detect plate
Original detect actuator
Manual paper feeding VR PWB unit
Manual paper feed tray 1 lower
Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
Manual paper feed tray 2 lower
Screw(36)
Manual paper feeding tray unit
PARTS CODE
PCOVP0055QSZC
XEBSE30P10000
PSHEZ0099QSZZ
NROLR0922FCZ2
NGERH0495FCZZ
XPSSJ20-07000
NGERH0061QSZZ
MARMP0009QSZZ
MSPRT0091QSZZ
NROLR1267FCZ1
XRESP40-06000
LBSHZ0303FCZZ
LBOSZ1508FCZZ
MSPRC1315FCZ1
PPIPP0109FCZZ
LBOSZ1510FCZZ
MARMP0041QSZZ
MARMP0006QSZZ
MSPRD0347QSZZ
MCAMP0003QSZZ
MSPRC1316FCZ1
PPIPP0014QSZZ
NSFTZ0017QSZZ
NGERH0972FCZZ
CPLTM0345QS01
MSPRD0092QSZZ
XEBSD30P08000
PTME-0178FCZZ
MSPRC2175FCZZ
RPLU-0028QSZZ
MSPRC1318FCZ1
PTME-0179FCZZ
XBBSD30P10000
MARMP0027QSZ1
LFRM-0048QSZC
MARMP0008QSZZ
LPLTP0056QSZ3
XEPSD30P06X00
XEBSD30P10000
PSHEZ0241QSZZ
LBNDJ0013FCZ1
MSPRD0302QSZZ
MSPRD0329QSZZ
NCPL-0012QSZZ
CPWBF0083QSE5
DHAI-0360QSZZ
MLEVP0104QSZZ
LBSHZ0006QSZZ
LSTPP0011QSZZ
(Unit)
901 C F R M - 0 0 4 8 R S 5 3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AL
N
AA
AC
AR
AC
AA
AD
AF
AC
AH
AA
AC
AG
AD
AB
AF
AE
AD
AD
N
AD
AE
AC
AG
AB
AG
N
AE
AA
AC
AA
AM
AA
AC
AA
AE
AT
N
AH
AD
AA
AA
AB
AE
AC
AC
N
AD
AU
AE
N
AD
N
AC
AC
BH
PART
RANK
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
C
C
C
C
E
DESCRIPTION
Multi frame cover
Screw(310)
Protect sheet
Manual feed roller
Gear(20T)
Spring pin
Gear(24T)
Roller arm
Roller arm spring
Paper feeding rolor
E type ring
M bushing C
Cam boss A2
Manual clutch spring A
Manual clutch sleeve pipe A
Cam boss A1
Cam transmission arm
Arm
Stopper arm spring
Drive cam
MF clutch spring B
Cam clutch sleeve
Manual feed cam shaft
Gear(27T)
Paper feed plate
MF earth spring
Screw(38)
Manual paper feeding pawl A
Pawl A spring
Multi field solenoid
Spring B
Manual paper feeding pawl B
Screw(310)
Manual paper feed tray arm
Multi frame
Stopper arm
Stopper plate
Screw(36X)
Screw(310)
Manual paper feed protection sheet
Cable band
Manual paper cupling spring
Reversal spring
Manual paper cupling
Sensor PWB
DUP 2 sensor harness
Reversal lever
M bushing 2
E-ring
Multi manual paper feeding unit(Except No.36,40,41,43)
19
4
1
11
10
12
12
5
9
3
14
16
15
13
17
19
16
22
19
3
20
3
18
22
22
22
PRP01749
14 6
11
1
2
19 26
47
18
22
23
17
12
32
30
42
29
27
20
48
6
43
21
12
28 29
29
16
29
13
15
13
45
9
46
12
12
44
52
50
17
51
25
33
31
5
41
10
49
34
7
40
35
37
36
38
41
36
40
39
20
PRP01750
Q DV unit
NO.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
501
502
PARTS CODE
PGIDM0085QSZZ
PGIDM0086QSZZ
PSEL-0035QSZZ
XBBSD40P08000
PCOVP0072QSZZ
PMLT-0002YSZ1
PMLT-0006YSZZ
PMLT-0005YSZZ
NROLP0072QSZ1
NGERH0002YSZZ
NBRGC0020QSZZ
XEBSD30P08000
PSEL-0037QSZ1
NGERH0001YSZZ
NBRGC0021QSZZ
NGERH0136QSZZ
XBPSD30P06KS0
PBOX-0001YS13
PSHEP0035YSZZ
LPLTM6022FCZZ
PSEL-0025QSZZ
NROLM0108QSZZ
PSEL-0132QSZZ
XBPBZ30P03000
LPLTM0001YSZZ
LPLTM0002YSZ2
PSEN-0001QSZZ
RDTCM0015QSZZ
XUBUZ30P08000
XRESP30-06000
LHLDR0072QSZZ
MSPRK0001YSZZ
PSPAP0023QSZZ
LHLDZ0001YSZZ
LX-BZ0026QSZZ
XEBSD30P10000
PCOVP0073QSZZ
PSEL-0114QSZZ
PSEL-0115QSZZ
TCAUH0016QSZZ
PSEL-0117QSZZ
PSEL-0124QSZZ
PSPAP0036QSZZ
PSEL-0116QSZZ
LANGF0013QSZZ
XEBSD26P05000
PSHEP0324QSZZ
DHAI-0314QSZZ
CBOX-0001JS5G
CCOVP0072RS54
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AP
AQ
AE
AA
AK
AC
AB
AB
AP
AD
AH
AA
AG
AD
AD
AD
AA
AM
AB
AC
AA
BA
N
AG
AB
AN
AP
AC
AY
AA
AA
AC
AB
AC
AD
AD
AA
AG
AC
AD
AC
AB
AB
AC
AB
AD
AA
AC
AH
N
BL
N
AP
PART
RANK
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
E
TN guide U
TN guide D
TG seal
Screw(48)
DV cover U
DV-TH cushion
DV side cushion R
DV side cushion F
DMX roller
DMX gear(28T)
DMX Bearing
Screw(38)
TG seal
DV idle gear(20T)
DID Bearing
MG gear(18T)
Screw(36KS)
DV BOX
DV side seat N
M4 plate
DVC seal
MG roller
DV plate
Screw(33)
Doctor
Doctor reinforce plate
DV cap F
ATC sensor
Screw(38)
E type ring
MG holder
Bias spring
DV spacer F
Bearing holder
Screw
Screw(310)
DV cover F
Seal F
Seal F2
Label
TG seal R
TG seal F
TGU-SPA-FL
DVC seal F
DID plate
Screw(2.65)
DVB Sheet FBR
Sensor harness
DV box unit
DV cover unit
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AA
AC
AE
AF
AE
AZ
AZ
AC
AF
AF
AC
AG
AA
AC
AC
AG
AE
AE
AE
AC
AC
AL
AC
AC
AK
PART
RANK
C
D
C
C
C
D
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
Screw(38)
Toner pipe cap
Transport pipe screw
Process reinforce plate
Separator pawl lever
Process frame unit
Process frame unit
Screw cupring
Seal R
Seal F
Toner pipp shuter
Toner pipe
Toner pipe spring
P cap spacer
Transport screw gear(30T)
Drum cover
Transport pipe gear(14T)
Drum fixing plate A
Drum fixing plate B
Idle gear(26T)
Transport pipe gear(15T)
Transport screw
DV bearing
Transport screw cushion
Separator pawl
DESCRIPTION
R Process unit
NO.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
PARTS CODE
XEBSD30P08000
PCAPH0009QSZZ
NSRW-0002QSZZ
LPLTM0241QSZZ
MLEVP0065QSZZ
CFRM-0049RS61
CFRM-0049RS69
NCPL-0003QSZZ
PSEL-0071QSZZ
PSEL-0070QSZZ
PSHT-0004QSZ1
PPIPP0015QSZZ
MSPRC0045QSZZ
PSPAZ0696FCZZ
NGERH0036QSZZ
PCOVP0057QSZZ
NGERH0039QSZZ
LFIX-0014QSZZ
LFIX-0015QSZZ
NGERH0037QSZZ
NGERH0038QSZZ
NSFTZ0020QSZZ
NBRGP0299FCZZ
PMLT-0018QSZ1
PTME-0021QSZZ
DESCRIPTION
21
(Except Philippines,STCL,SRS,SRSSC,Indonesia,India,SRH)
(Philippines,STCL,SRS,SRSSC,Indonesia,India,SRH)
R Process unit
NO.
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AB
AB
AB
AA
AB
AZ
AT
AA
AC
AA
AC
AA
AC
AP
AK
PARTS CODE
LX-WZ0329FCZZ
LX-RZ0001QSZZ
MSPRT0214QSZZ
XHBS230P08000
MSPRC0213QSZZ
CHLDZ0035RS53
UCLEZ0011QSZZ
XEBSE30P10000
PSHEZ0329QSZZ
PTPE-0026QSZZ
LHLDZ0090QSZZ
LX-BZ0406FCZZ
PRNGF0106FCZ2
CPIPP0015RS51
CTME-0021RS51
(Unit)
CFRM-0049RS58
901
CFRM-0049RS54
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
501
502
BK
BK
PART
RANK
C
C
C
C
C
E
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
E
E
E
Q DV unit
DESCRIPTION
Washer
Starling
Lever spring
Screw(38)
Separator pawl spring
MC holder unit
Cleaning blade
Screw(310)
Screw miler
Screw tape
Star ring holder
Screw(34)
Star ring N2
Toner pipe unit
Separator pawl unit
(Philippines,STCL,SRS,SRSSC,Indonesia,India,SRH)
(Philippines,STCL,SRS,SRSSC,Indonesia,India,SRH)
(Philippines,STCL,SRS,SRSSC,Indonesia,India,SRH)
13
12
(Except Philippines,STCL,SRS,SRSSC,Indonesia,India,SRH)
(Philippines,STCL,SRS,SRSSC,Indonesia,India,SRH)
41
502
20
3
21
43
4
23
20
6
21
46
45
10 30
7 11
20
44
27
A 14
18
8
39
49
12
48
47
17
15
19
11 16
6
12
49
22
40
38
30
37
PRP01751
12
11
30
34
36
R Process unit
25
32
35
A
26
33 12 31
28
24
50
501
12
24
29
12
29
29
32
1
31
29
6
28
7
5
36
36
38
12
3
36
15
501
13
36
33
17
30
37
38
26
38 37
27
14
16
37
30
26
27
38
10
502
25
37
23
22
35
25
502
33
11
18
21
901
19
20
22
24
35
34
PRP01752
S Fusing unit 1
NO.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
!
!
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
!
!
26
27
28
29
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
901
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AF
N
AE
N
AE
N
AA
AA
AA
N
AD
N
AN
N
AL
N
AF
N
AB
AS
N
AC
N
AF
AA
AE
N
AC
N
AF
N
AY
N
AY
N
AC
N
AA
AF
N
AY
N
AC
N
AC
N
AZ
N
AZ
N
BE
N
AR
N
AN
N
AR
N
AC
AC
N
AF
N
AT
N
AH
AC
AN
PARTS CODE
MARMP0048QSZZ
MLEVP0100QSZZ
MLEVP0101QSZZ
XBPSN30P08KS0
XBPSD30P14KS0
LX-NZ0002QSZZ
DHAI-0368QSZZ
RTHM-0004QSZZ
DHAI-0366QSZZ
DHAI-0367QSZZ
LHLDW0086QSZZ
RH-HX0001QSZZ
LPLTM0338QSZZ
VHPGP1S73P+-1
XEBSD30P06000
LPLTM0334QSZZ
LX-BZ0040QSZZ
LSTPP0017QSZZ
RLMPU0027QSZZ
RLMPU0029QSZZ
LPLTM0339QSZZ
LX-WZ7021SCZZ
LPLTM0335QSZZ
LFRM-0071QSZZ
MSPRC0323QSZZ
LPLTM0337QSZZ
RLMPU0026QSZZ
RLMPU0028QSZZ
NROLM0098QSZZ
NGERH0171QSZZ
NBRGP0025QSZZ
CPLTM0336QS01
MSPRT0257QSZ1
MSPRD0322QSZZ
MLEVP0099QSZZ
PGIDM0113QSZZ
PTME-0282FCZZ
LX-WZ0001QSZZ
PTME-0024QSZZ
(Unit)
DUNTW0375RS12
BZ
PART
RANK
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
B
C
B
C
C
C
C
B
B
C
C
C
D
C
C
B
B
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
DESCRIPTION
Pressurization fulcrum arm
Pressurization lever F TL
Pressurization lever R TL
Screw(38KS)
Screw(314KS)
Nut
Thermostat harness 1
Thermostat TL
Fusing harness
DUP sensor harness
Harness ring
Thermistor TL
Fusing earth plate UR
Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
Screw(36)
Lamp terminal plate
Screw
Suport
Sub heater lamp
Sub heater lamp
Thermostat fixing plate
Washer
Lamp fixing plate
Fusing upper frame
Fusing earth spring
Fusing earth plate UF
Main heater lamp TL
Main heater lamp TL
Heat roller TL
Fusing gear TL(38T)
Upper HR bearing TL
Fusing cleaner plate
Upper pawl spring
Fusing ACT spring
Fusing rear side lever
Fusing rear upper guide
Upper separate pawl
Washer
Upper separate pawl
(120V)
(230V)
(120V)
(230V)
(120V)
S Fusing unit 1
1
10
14
6
4
4
13
12
11
6 17
15
16
7
4
21
18
7
8
19
28
21
4
29
20
20
30
27
26
23
21
22
34
32
33
4
21 4
35
32
17
17
32
25
36
24
15
29
31
38
36
23
17
37
38
37
PRP01753
T Fusing unit 2
NO.
PARTS CODE
NBRGY0022QSZZ
NROLS0100QSZZ
MSPRC0324QSZZ
PSHEZ0266QSZ1
MSPRC0325QSZZ
LPLTM0344QSZZ
PGIDH0114QSZZ
LPLTM0340QSZZ
XBPSD30P14KS0
MSPRD0328QSZZ
PTME-0014QSZZ
XBPSN30P08KS0
MSPRD0327QSZZ
LFRM-0072QSZZ
MSPRD0326QSZZ
PGIDM0115QSZZ
TLABH0289QSZZ
(Unit)
901 D U N T W 0 3 7 5 R S 1 2
1
2
3
4
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
14
15
16
17
18
19
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AL
BB
N
AC
N
AK
AB
N
AC
N
AH
N
AC
N
AA
AC
N
AK
AA
AC
N
AU
N
AC
N
AS
N
AA
BZ
PART
RANK
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
DESCRIPTION
(120V)
T Fusing unit 2
1
21
3
5
4
2
6
1
7
8
12
3
6
20
12
11
13
17
14
16
10
12
15
10
11
12
18
15
19
PRP01754
24
U Drive unit
NO.
PARTS CODE
XBPSD40P08K00
RMOTP0025QSNA
CPLTM0160QS01
MSPRC0200QSZZ
NGERH0153QSZZ
NGERH0090QSZZ
NGERH0084QSZZ
XRESP70-08000
NGERH0085QSZZ
NGERH0086QSZZ
NGERH0087QSZZ
NGERH0010QSZZ
NGERH0092QSZZ
NGERH0093QSZZ
XBPSD30P06KS0
NGERH0095QSZZ
NGERH0011QSZZ
NGERH0152QSZZ
NGERH0096QSZZ
CPLTM0161QS01
MSPRC0262QSZZ
NCPL-0009QSZZ
NGERH0091QSZZ
NGERH0083QSZZ
DHAI-0376QSZZ
RCORF0012QSZZ
(Unit)
901 C P L T M 0 1 6 0 R S 5 3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AA
BF
AU
AB
AH
AE
AK
AA
AE
AD
AE
AD
AD
AD
AA
AE
AD
AH
AE
AN
AC
AC
AE
AH
AD
N
AC
BN
PART
RANK
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
DESCRIPTION
Screw(48K)
Main motor
Main drive plate
Ratchet spring
Ratchet gear(49T)
Ratchet gear(19T)
Gear(94/21T)
E type ring
Gear(46/18T)
Gear(39/21T)
Gear(28/21T)
Gear(28T)
Gear(30/16T)
Gear(28/16T)
Screw(36KS)
Gear
MG gear
N gear(59/21T)
Gear(37/25T)
Sub drive plate
MG spring
MG cupring
Cupring(34T)
Drum cupring gear
Main motor harness
MM harness core
(Taiwan)
U Drive unit
25
26
1
6
8
9
2
10
13
15
11
15
12
21
14
17
12
18
22
20
23
24
16
12
15
19
25
PRP01755
PARTS CODE
NSFTZ0042QSZZ
PGUMM0005QSZZ
NROLP0049QSZZ
NROLP0079QSZZ
LBRC-0003QSZZ
PBRSR0019QSZZ
NROLM0037QSZ4
NBRGY2122SCZZ
LPLTM0195QSZZ
NBRGM0501FCZZ
XRESP50-06000
LHLDZ0058QSZZ
LPLTP0185QSZ1
MSPRD0224QSZZ
MLEVP0055QSZ1
MSPRT0197QSZZ
XEBSD30P08000
CPWBF0083QSE5
DHAI-0364QSZZ
PSPO-0021QSZZ
CSFTZ0023QS01
XRESP40-06000
NROLR0051QSZ1
LBSHZ0303FCZZ
PGIDM0065QSZ1
NROLP1122FCZZ
MSPRT0229GCAZ
XHBSE40P10000
PDUC-0003QSZ1
NFANP0004QSZZ
PFILZ0004QSZZ
PMLT-0027QSZZ
XEBSD20P06000
LX-BZ0780FCZZ
(Unit)
CFRM-0038RS57
901
CFRM-0038RS58
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AF
AD
AC
AC
AD
AK
AR
AB
AC
AB
AA
AR
AL
AB
AC
AB
AA
AU
AP
N
AD
AH
AA
AL
AC
AY
AF
AC
AA
AG
BB
AM
AC
AA
AC
BT
BT
PART
RANK
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
B
C
C
C
N
N
E
E
DESCRIPTION
Delivery sub roller shaft
Paddler
Delivery sub roller
Delivery sub roller (Large)
P-OUT bracket
Discharger brush LP
Delivery roller C
Transport roller bearing
Delivery earth plate A
Bearing
E type ring
Delivery roller holder
Delivery change gate
Delivery actuator spring
Delivery actuator
Delivery sub spring
Screw(38)
Sensor PWB
1st delivery harness
Shifter cution
Shifter shaft
E type ring
DUP delivery roller
M bushing C
Delivery upper paper guide
PS upper roller
FU spring R
Screw(410)
Cooling fan duct
Cooling fan
Ozone filter
Cleaning fan cushion
Screw(26)
Screw
3
4
10
11
13
2
3
4
7
14
16
12
9
11
8 16
20
10
15
23
19
17
18
32
29
34
26
30
33
24
21
31
17
25
22
28
PRP01756
34
17
35
17
26
28
34
32
33
27
34
27
31
30
PARTS CODE
XHBSD30P08000
RMOTP0029QSNA
CPLTM0184QS02
XEBSD30P08000
MSPRD0225QSZZ
LSTPP0003QSZ1
NGERH0068QSZ1
NGERH0067QSZZ
VHPGP1A71L3-1
DHAI-0364QSZZ
XRESP30-06000
XRESP40-06000
MSPRD0216QSZZ
MSPRT0217QSZ1
LBRC-0002QSZZ
LBSHZ0303FCZZ
NBRGY2122SCZZ
NBRGC0019QSZZ
LPINS0258FCZZ
NBLTT0024QSZZ
NGERH0080QSZZ
NGERH0082QSZZ
MSPRD0198QSZZ
NGERH0113QSZZ
NGERH0114QSZZ
MSPRD0196QSZZ
NGERH0155QSZZ
RPLU-0027QSZZ
CBRC-0004QS03
RMOTP0024QSZZ
XHBSD30P08000
XBBSD26P03000
XWHSD30-05070
LHLDW1334FCZZ
PSHEZ0316QSZZ
PRDAZ0002QSZZ
PSHEZ0341QSZZ
CPLTM0184RS52
CBRC-0004RS51
(Unit)
CFRM-0038RS57
901
CFRM-0038RS58
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
501
502
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AA
AV
AG
AA
AC
AC
AD
AD
AG
AP
N
AA
AA
AD
AC
AD
AC
AB
AD
AA
AG
AE
AD
AC
AC
AC
AC
AD
AU
AF
AW
AA
AA
AA
AA
AD
AD
AA
AZ
N
BA
BT
BT
N
N
PART
RANK
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
E
E
E
DESCRIPTION
Screw(38)
Shifter motor
Shifter drive plate
Screw(38)
Stopper return spring
Shifter stopper
Shifter gear(50T)
Shifter gear(24T)
Photo sensor(GP1A71L3)
1st delivery harness
E type ring
E type ring
Shifter earth spring
Gate return spring
Gate bracket
M bushing C
Transport roller bearing
Bearing
Spring pin(3-10)
Drive belt 240
Delivery drive gear(25/31T)
DUP delivery gear(20/31T)
Delivery earth spring B
Idle gear B(29T)
Idle gear C(29T)
Delivery earth spring A
Gear(31/39T)
Change gate solenoid
DUP motor fixing bracket
DUP motor
Screw(38)
Screw(2.63)
Washer
Wire holder
Delivery motor sheet
Delivery motor radiation plate
Shifter stop mylar
Shifter unit
DUP motor fixing bracket unit
1st delivery unit(Include Block 26)
1st delivery unit(Include Block 26)
(AR-M276/M236 U.kingdom,Taiwan)
(Except AR-M276/M236 U.kingdom,Taiwan)
24
2
25
4
4
13
3
7
5
34
10
12
19
18
26
22
33
21
23
4
32
35
30
36
31
17
20
28
502
16
15
37 6
11
14
27
29
PRP01757
4
27
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AA
AH
AG
AH
AG
AG
AC
AF
AN
AH
N
AD
AK
AF
AC
AF
AB
AC
AE
AC
AB
AU
AL
AC
AA
AC
AA
AA
AA
AK
AE
N
BB
N
AV
PARTS CODE
XHBSD40P10000
CPLTM0216QS01
PBRSR0021QSZ1
PBRSR0020QSZ1
LFRM-0047QSZZ
LFRM-0058QSZZ
MSPRT0229GCAZ
NROLP1122FCZZ
NROLR0056QSZ1
DHAI-0365QSZZ
MSPRD0218QSZZ
VHPGP1S44S/-1
VHPGP1S73P+-1
NROLP0079QSZZ
QSW-B0017QSZZ
NBRGM0501FCZZ
NGERH0111QSZZ
NGERH0110QSZZ
NGERH0112QSZZ
NBRGY2122SCZZ
PGIDM0072QSZ2
NROLR0051QSZ1
LBSHZ0303FCZZ
XRESP40-06000
MLEVP0067QSZ1
XRESP50-06000
XHBSD30P08000
XHBSE40P10000
RCORF0014QSZZ
PMLT-0090QSZZ
CGIDM0072RS64
CFRM-0047RS51
PART
RANK
C
C
B
B
D
D
C
C
C
C
C
B
B
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
E
DESCRIPTION
Screw(410)
DID rail assistance plate
Discharger brush S
Discharger brush L
Delivery frame
Delivery frame R
FU spring R
PS upper roller
Delivery roller
2nd delivery harness
Delivery earth spring
Photo sensor(GP1S44S)
Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
Delivery roller
Tray detect switch
Bearing
Drive gear A(25T)
Idle gear A(29T)
Drive gear B(25T)
Transport roller bearing
Delivery lower paper guide
DUP delivery roller
M bushing C
E type ring
Delivery actuator
E type ring
Screw(38)
Screw(410)
Core
2nd delivery upper cushion R
Delivery lower PG unit
Delivery frame unit
(Taiwan)
502
1
28
501
2
29
6
1
10
11
18
17
8
3
16
5
8
8
19
12
20
15
27
14
13
14
21
25
22
28
26 16
27
28
24
23
PRP01758
Y PWB section
NO.
1
2
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
28
29
30
31
32
33
35
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
PARTS CODE
CPWBX0136QS31
XBBSD30P08000
CPWBF0138QSE1
XBBSF30P08000
DHAI-0372QSZZ
LHLDZ0062QSZ2
LX-BZ0031QSZZ
LHLDW0086QSZZ
CPWBX0134QS31
LHLDZ0071QSZZ
CPWBN0137QSE1
XHBSE30P08000
LX-BZ0024QSZZ
LHLDZ0070QSZ2
XHBSE30P08000
XEBSE40P10000
XBPSD30P08KS0
PSHEZ0269QSZZ
RCORF0002QSZZ
DHAI-0345QSZZ
DHAI-0353QSZZ
DHAI-0392QSZZ
PCAPH0023FCZZ
PCAPH1003ACZZ
PCAPH1005ACZZ
CPWBN0135QS31
DHAI-0364QSZZ
DHAI-0200QSZZ
DHAI-0346QSZZ
DHAI-0347QSZZ
DHAI-0373QSZZ
DHAI-0371QSZZ
DHAI-0395QSZZ
DHAI-0348QSZZ
DHAI-0381QSZZ
DHAI-0374QSZZ
PGSK-0018QSZZ
RCORF0011QSZZ
PTPE-0034QSZZ
PTPE-0035QSZZ
PGSK-0017QSZZ
PTPE-0027QSZZ
PTPE-0028QSZZ
PTPE-0029QSZZ
PSHEM0338QSZZ
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
CG
N
AA
BD
N
AA
AE
N
AT
AC
AB
CF
N
AG
AZ
N
AA
AA
AX
N
AA
AA
AA
AC
AE
AG
N
AH
N
AU
N
AC
AC
AC
CF
N
AP
N
AS
AP
N
AN
N
AS
N
AR
N
AG
N
AH
N
AH
N
AX
N
AH
AG
AP
AH
AH
AP
AG
AG
AH
PART
RANK
E
C
E
C
C
C
C
C
E
C
E
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
D
D
E
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
IMC PWB
Screw(38)
Option interface PWB
Screw(38)
OP interface PWB harness
MCU PWB holder
Screw
Harness ring
MCU PWB
Mother bord holder
Mother bord
Screw(38)
Screw
OP PWB holder
Screw(38)
Screw(48)
Screw(38)
CCD harness sheet
Core
CCD harness
ILSW I/F harness 2
2nd harness
15P protect cap
25P protect cap
9P protect cap
GDI PWB
1st delivery harness
CL harness
Optical sensor harness
Optical sensor harness
DV/LSU interface harness
Drive/Manual paper feed interface harness
Cassette sensor PWB harness
Operation PWB FFC
Fusing interface harness
Power supply harness
MCU-OP PWB holder cushion
Manual harness core
MB holder shield cushion
MB holder tape B
1394CN cushion
OP PWB holder shield tape A
OP PWB holder shield tape B
OP PWB holder shield tape C
IMC shield alpet
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AA
AM
N
AA
AC
AD
AR
N
AC
N
AA
AA
AG
N
AA
AZ
N
AC
AS
AZ
AW
AW
AW
N
BA
N
AU
N
AN
BY
N
BY
N
BY
N
BN
N
AB
AP
N
AD
AA
AA
PART
RANK
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
C
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
E
E
E
E
C
C
C
C
C
Screw(46K)
HL interface harness
Screw(36)
Drive earth plate
Paper feed earth plate LP
Drive/Manual paper feed interface harness
Cassette earth harness
Screw(38)
Screw(430)
Harness guide
Screw(430)
1st lift up unit
2nd earth plate
AC cord
(U.S.A,Canada,Brazil,LAG2)
AC cord
(U.kingdom,UAE,Yemen,Oman,Qutar,Kuwait,Bahrain)
AC cord
(Other Countries)
AC cord
(Philippines,Taiwan)
AC cord
(Australia,New Zealand)
AC cord
(Saudi Arabia)
AC cord
(SRS,SRSSC,South africa,Special Country,India,Hong kong)
Power supply switch(AJ8W200B)
Low voltage power supply unit
(100V)
Low voltage power supply unit
(120V)
Low voltage power supply unit
(230V)
High voltage Power supply unit
Wire holder(LWS-3S)
AC switch harness
AC cord fixer
Screw(430)
Screw(412)
DESCRIPTION
(AR-M237/M236)
[AB Series]
[Inch Series]
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
19
20
!
!
!
!
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
PARTS CODE
XBPSN40P06K00
DHAI-0375QSZZ
XHBSE30P06000
LPLTM0162QSZZ
LPLTM0252QSZZ
DHAI-0371QSZZ
DHAI-0378QSZZ
XHBSE30P08000
XEBSD40P30000
PGIDM0112QSZZ
XEBSD40P30000
CDAIU0024RS53
LPLTM0249QSZZ
QACCDR614QCPZ
QACCBR421QCPZ
QACCER624QCPZ
QACCJR614QCPZ
QACCLR421QCPZ
DHAI-0167QSZZ
DHAI-0151QSZZ
QSW-C9292QCZZ
RDENC0011QSZZ
RDENC0011QS11
RDENC0011QS12
RDENC0012QSZZ
LHLDW1057FCZZ
DHAI-0377QSZZ
LFIX-0016FCZZ
XEBSD40P30000
XEBSE40P12000
DESCRIPTION
29
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AA
AA
AS
N
AS
N
AA
AA
PARTS CODE
XWHSD40-08100
XWSSD40-10000
LPLTM0349QSZZ
NFANP0011QSZZ
XBPSD30P30KS0
XBPSD30P08KS0
PART
RANK
C
C
C
B
C
C
DESCRIPTION
Washer
Washer
Power supply plate
P/S fan motor
Screw(330KS)
Screw(38KS)
Y PWB section
30 31
5
2
3
42 6
2
22 2
37
43 35
54
14
32
14
20
47 39
2
2
17
2
10
2 14
44 13
17
49 45
12
40 29
50
14
5
16
17
5
2
28
17
21
38 14
2
2
52
53
48
41
51
14
15
14
55
56
18
33
19
PRP01759
19
1
5
2
4
15
8
9
39
38
10
34
42
11
42
42
31
20
42
42
29
42
42
12
28
13
42
30
34
32
33
36 35
37
30
19
30
PRP01760
[ 2nd exteriors
NO.
1
2
3
5
7
8
10
12
13
14
15
16
22
23
24
25
PARTS CODE
GCAB-0030QSZA
XEBSE40P12000
LPLTM0240QSZZ
GCOVA0025QSZB
LFRM-0039QSZB
LPLTM0236QSZZ
PCOVP0063QSZB
NSFTZ0048QSZZ
NKOM-0005QSZZ
XBPSD30P08KS0
GLEGG0064FCZZ
LPLTM0237QSZZ
PSHEZ0325QSZZ
LX-BZ0037QSZZ
MSPRD0276QSZZ
MSPRD0277QSZZ
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AN
N
AA
AC
AS
N
BK
N
AG
AD
N
AG
AC
AA
AC
AH
AB
AB
N
AS
AN
PART
RANK
D
C
C
D
D
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
DESCRIPTION
Left cabinet
Screw(412)
2nd joint plate
Rear cover
Frame
2nd reinforce plate R
Front cover
Cassette collar shaft
Cassette guide collar
Screw(38KS)
Rubber foot
2nd reinforce plate F
Frame lower mylar
Screw
Front earth spring
2nd joint earth spring
(Taiwan)
(Taiwan)
[ 2nd exteriors
2
2
2
1
2
23
24
23
16
2
2
23
2
25
2
3
14
13 12
22
15
8
2
10
2
3
PRP01761
31
15
PARTS CODE
LPLTP0159QSZZ
LHLDW1226FCZZ
LPLTM0179QSZ1
PSHEZ0274QSZZ
GCASP0005QSZ2
PGIDM0070QSZ1
PTPE-0021QSZZ
LPLTM0181QSZ1
PGIDM0071QSZZ
LX-BZ0884FCZZ
NGERH0193FCZZ
MSPRC2631FCZZ
MLEVP0755FCZ1
LX-BZ0833FCZZ
CSHEZ0244QS02
XRESP70-08000
NGERH0108QSZZ
MSPRC0210QSZZ
NSFTZ0047QSZZ
LPLTM0180QSZ1
NBRGP0041GCZZ
XEBSE40P10000
JHNDP0005QSZZ
XBPSD40P08KS0
TLABZ0366QSZZ
LPLTM0277QSZZ
PCOVP0096QSZZ
(Unit)
901 C C A S P 0 0 0 5 R S 5 5
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
27
28
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AD
AB
AR
AC
BA
N
AM
AD
AB
AL
AB
AB
AC
AE
AC
AE
AA
AD
AC
AP
AE
AD
AA
AY
N
AA
AD
AC
AN
N
BM
PART
RANK
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
DESCRIPTION
Cassette rear side plate
Turn fastener
Rotetion plate
Rotation plate sheet
550 cassette
Guide F
GID tape
Side plate guide F
Guide R
Screw
UC manual feed gear
Fusing pressure spring
Side plate F lever
Screw
Cassette mylar
E type ring
Lift gear(22T)
Lift gear spring
Lift shaft
Lift plate
Bearing
Screw(410)
Cassette panel
Screw(48KS)
Label
Side plate guide R
Cassette panel line
(Taiwan)
8
6
7
9
10
4
11
11
13
12
7
27
14
22
22
25
15
17
18
22
22
19
20
23
22
PRP01762
21
501
28
22
32
24
16
PARTS CODE
CPWBF0082QSE1
PCOVP0070QSZZ
CPWBF0095QSE3
MLEVP0063QSZZ
MLEVP0064QSZZ
MLEVP0062QSZZ
PCOVP0064QSZZ
RPLU-0026QSZ1
MARMP0026QSZZ
MSPRC0209QSZ1
NSFTZ0050QSZ1
QSW-B0017QSZZ
DHAI-0397QSZZ
NBRGC0100FCZ1
MSPRD0206QSZZ
MARMP0021QSZZ
NGERH0107QSZZ
LPIN-0026MCZZ
NROLR0055QSZ1
MARMP0019QSZZ
NGERH0990FCZZ
NROLR0054QSZZ
DHAI-0394QSZZ
MSPRD0204QSZZ
DHAI-0395QSZZ
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
BB
AD
AP
N
AD
AD
AC
AD
AR
AD
AC
AH
AF
AD
N
AC
AC
AD
AD
AA
AR
AD
AB
AP
AD
N
AC
AG
N
PART
RANK
E
D
E
C
C
C
D
B
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
DESCRIPTION
2nd cassette interface PWB
Sensor cover
2nd cassette sensor PWB
Upper limit detect actuator
Paper detect actuator
P-IN detect actuator
Solenoid cover
Paper feed solenoid
Solenoid arm
Solenoid spring
2nd paper feed roller shaft
Tray detect switch
Cassette detect interface harness
Bearing 6
Pick up roller pressure spring
Pick up arm R
Paper feed gear
Spring pin(2-10)
Paper feed roller
Pick up arm F
Gear(16T)
Pick up roller
Door open/close detect harness
P-IN detect actuator spring
Cassette sensor PWB harness
8
14
2
17
10
1
4
13
5 11
31
30
6
19
27
14
24
18
20
26
21
22
23
29
PRP01763
33
PARTS CODE
MSPRC0141QSZZ
MLOKZ0001QSZZ
XEPSD30P08X00
PGIDM0068QSZZ
MARMP0015QSZZ
NSFTZ0054QSZZ
NROLP1060FCZZ
MSPRP0345QSZZ
XEBSD30P08000
GCOVA0026QSZB
XEBSD30P10000
PCOVP0089QSZZ
LPLTP0297QSZZ
PSHEZ0378QSZZ
NROLR0052QSZZ
MSPRC0270QSZZ
NBRGZ0503FCZZ
LSTPP0011QSZZ
LRALP0009QSZZ
XBPSD30P08KS0
NKOM-0005QSZZ
NSFTZ0048QSZZ
PGIDM0074QSZZ
XEBSE40P12000
PSHEZ0301QSZZ
PSHEZ0302QSZZ
MSPRD0287QSZZ
NROLP0087QSZZ
NSFTZ0064QSZZ
CCOVP0089RS51
CGIDM0068RS51
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AB
AC
AA
AP
AD
AE
AF
AD
N
AA
AP
N
AA
AD
AC
AG
AN
AB
AC
AC
AQ
AA
AC
AG
AK
AA
AC
AC
AC
AD
AD
AQ
AS
PART
RANK
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
E
DESCRIPTION
lock spring
Paper guide lock
Screw(38X)
Transport paper guide
Door arm
Transport paper guide shaft
U-turn roller
Transport paper guide spring
Screw(38)
Right cover
Screw(310)
Plate cover
Separation plate
Separation sheet
Transport roller
Separation plate spring
Bearing
E-ring
Cassette rail R
Screw(38KS)
Cassette guide collar
Cassette collar shaft
2nd U-turn guide
Screw(412)
Rail R side mylar F
Rail R side mylar R
Paper feed assistance roller SP
Paper feed assistance roller
Paper feed assistance roller shaft
Plate cover unit
Transport paper guide unit
2
1
4
a
a
b
8
6
8
26
23
502
b
25
28
29
14
19
10
24
15
22
21
18
24
20
27
13
27
17
501
16
12
11
34
PRP01764
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AE
BB
AA
AU
N
AC
AD
AS
AA
AA
AC
AD
AF
AZ
N
AA
AA
AP
AD
N
AF
AE
AG
AS
AD
AB
AD
AB
AD
AH
PARTS CODE
PCOVP0084QSZZ
CPWBF0082QSE1
XEBSD30P08000
DHAI-0392QSZZ
NBRGC0100FCZ1
MARMP0018QSZZ
PCLC-0014QSZZ
XRESP40-06000
XRESP50-06000
MSPRT0203QSZZ
NGERH0119QSZZ
NGERH1207FCZZ
CDAIU0024RS54
XEBSD40P30000
XEBSE40P12000
RCORF1036ACZZ
DHAI-0396QSZZ
LPLTM0203QSZ1
NGERH0121QSZZ
NBLTT0029QSZZ
PCLC-0011QSZZ
NPLYZ0027QSZZ
PSHEZ0250QSZZ
NROLP0008QSZZ
PSHEZ0249QSZZ
NBRGC0529FCZZ
LPLTM0176QSZZ
PART
RANK
C
E
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
E
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
DESCRIPTION
2nd bottom cover
2nd cassette interface PWB
Screw(38)
2nd harness
Bearing 6
Body joint arm
2nd paper feed clutch(42T)
E type ring
E type ring
Joint spring
Gear(36T)
Joint gear(40T)
2nd lift up unit
Screw(430)
Screw(412)
Core
LUM harness
Drive plate
Gear(20T/45T/26P)
Vertical delivery belt
Transport clutch
Vertical transport pulley
Frange mylar
Pulley
Frange mylar
Bearing
Crutch earth plate
16
2
3
11
29
30
17
3
25
b
13
32
33
24
31
28
10
12
14
8
26
15 14
15
20
15
15
5
6
9
7
PRP01765
35
PARTS CODE
CMOTV0778FCE3
NGERH0158QSZ1
LDAIU0024QSZ1
NGERH0102QSZZ
NSFTZ0045QSZZ
NGERH0103QSZZ
NSFTZ0044QSZZ
NSFTZ0060QSZZ
NGERH0104QSZZ
NGERH0105QSZZ
PCOVP0061QSZ1
MSPRD0208QSZZ
12
MSPRD0251QSZZ
13 M S P R C 0 2 6 3 Q S Z Z
(Unit)
CDAIU0024RS53
901
CDAIU0024RS54
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AU
N
AE
AH
N
AD
AC
AE
AC
AC
AE
AD
AH
AC
AD
AC
AZ
AZ
N
N
PART
RANK
E
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
E
E
DESCRIPTION
Lift up motor unit
Gear(29T/11T)
Lift up base
Gear(53T/14T)
Shaft
Gear(54T/13T)
Shaft
Shaft
Gear(13T/42T)
Gear(19T)
Lift up cover
1st cassette earth spring
2nd cassette earth spring
Lift up spring
1st lift up unit
2nd lift up unit
1
13
12
2
5
7
8
4
6
9
11
10
36
PRP01766
12
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
101
PARTS CODE
TINSE1005QSZZ
TINSE1003QSZZ
TINSE1001QSZZ
TINSE1031QSZZ
TINSE1029QSZZ
TINSE1027QSZZ
TINSE1053QSZZ
TINSE1091QSZZ
TINSF1006QSZZ
TINSF1032QSZZ
TINSF1055QSZZ
TINSF1093QSZZ
TINSG1008QSZZ
TINSG1034QSZZ
TINSG1056QSZZ
TINSG1095QSZZ
CDSKA0035QS32
TCADZ0015QSZZ
PSHEZ1394FCZZ
TLABH0484QSZZ
UKOGZ0002FCZZ
UYOK-0011FCZZ
CCASZ0067FC01
SPAKA0482QSZZ
SPAKA0480QSZZ
SPAKA0483QSZZ
SPAKA0481QSZZ
SSAKZ0019FCZZ
SPAKA0485QSZZ
SPAKA0484QSZZ
LX-BZ0015QSZZ
TCADZ0010QSZZ
LHLDW1226FCZZ
TCADZ1275FCZZ
SSAKA3001CCZZ
SSAKA2343QCZZ
SPAKA0134RSZZ
CSHEZ0433QS05
PRICE NEW
RANK MARK
AW
N
AW
N
AX
N
AL
N
AL
N
AL
N
AL
N
AQ
N
AZ
N
AP
N
AN
N
AU
N
AZ
N
AP
N
AN
N
AU
N
AW
N
AD
N
AC
AE
N
AD
AA
AD
AW
N
AW
N
AW
N
AW
N
AM
AL
N
BE
N
AF
AC
AB
AB
AA
AA
AL
AG
N
PART
RANK
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
C
D
D
D
D
C
DESCRIPTION
Operation manual (Copy)
Operation manual (Copy)
Operation manual (Copy)
Operation manual (Key)
Operation manual (Key)
Operation manual (Key)
Operation manual (Set up)
Operation manual (NW scanner)
Operation manual (Copy)
Operation manual (Key)
Operation manual (Set up)
Operation manual (NW scanner)
Operation manual (Copy)
Operation manual (Key)
Operation manual (Set up)
Operation manual (NW scanner)
CD-ROM
ECP card
Vinyl sheet
Paper size label
Vinyl gloves
Vinyl bag
Maintenance case
Top packing L
Top packing L
Top packing R
Top packing R
Vinyl bag
Scanner rainforce add
Bottom packing case
2/3 fixing screw
Fixing screw caution card
Turn fastener
Cassett rotation tag
Vinyl bag(140X360)
Vinyl bag(260X380)
OC protect sheet
Key sheet
(English)[U.kingdom]
(English)[Other Countries]
(English)[U.S.A]
(English)[U.kingdom]
(English)[Other Countries]
(English)[U.S.A]
(English)
(English)
(French)
(French)
(French)
(French)
(German)
(German)
(German)
(German)
(GDI)[U.S.A,Other Countries]
(Canada)
(Inch Series)
(AR-M237/M277)
(AR-M236/M276)
(AR-M237/M277)
(AR-M236/M276)
(French)[Canada]
4
3
2
14
13
12
7
10
8
11
9
PRP01767
37
Index
PARTS CODE
[C]
CBOX-0001JS5G
CBRC-0004QS03
CBRC-0004RS51
CBTN-0068QS01
CBTN-0069QS02
CBTN-0070QS01
CBTN-0071QS01
CBTN-0071QS02
CCAB-0077RS51
CCAB-0082QS01
CCASP0005RS55
CCASP0006RS51
CCASZ0067FC01
CCOV-0051QS01
CCOV-0051QS02
CCOV-0051QS07
CCOV-0051QS08
CCOVP0053RS53
CCOVP0072RS54
CCOVP0089RS51
CDAIU0012QS11
"
CDAIU0024RS53
"
CDAIU0024RS54
"
CDOR-0002RS58
CDSKA0035QS32
CFILW0282FC02
CFILW0283FC02
CFILW0284FC02
CFIX-0013QS05
CFRM-0038RS57
"
CFRM-0038RS58
"
CFRM-0043QS02
CFRM-0044QS02
CFRM-0047RS51
CFRM-0048RS53
CFRM-0049RS54
CFRM-0049RS58
CFRM-0049RS61
CFRM-0049RS69
CFRM-0069RS51
CGIDM0067RS51
CGIDM0068RS51
CGIDM0072RS64
CGIDM0106RS51
"
"
CGIDM0116QS02
CHAI-0356RS51
CHAI-0357RS51
CHLDZ0035RS53
CHLDZ0105RS51
CLNS-0003RS54
CMOTV0778FCE3
CPIPP0015RS51
CPLTM0084QS02
CPLTM0160QS01
CPLTM0160RS53
"
CPLTM0161QS01
CPLTM0168QS02
CPLTM0184QS02
CPLTM0184RS52
CPLTM0216QS01
CPLTM0323RS51
CPLTM0336QS01
CPLTM0342QS01
CPLTM0345QS01
CPNLH0029QS05
CPNLH0029QS06
CPNLH0029RS55
CPWBF0081QSE2
CPWBF0082QSE1
"
PARTS CODE
NO.
21- 501
27- 29
27- 502
9- 18
9- 17
9- 19
9- 20
9- 20
6- 501
2- 23
32- 901
15- 901
37- 2
2- 26
2- 26
2- 26
2- 26
17- 502
21- 502
34- 501
12- 2
13- 8
30- 13
36- 901
35- 13
36- 901
18- 901
37- 2
9- 22
9- 23
9- 21
1- 3
26- 901
27- 901
26- 901
27- 901
10- 4
10- 23
28- 502
20- 901
22- 901
22- 901
22- 6
22- 6
6- 901
17- 501
34- 502
28- 501
4- 7
7- 501
8- 501
1- 7
14- 7
14- 8
22- 31
9- 501
13- 28
36- 1
22- 501
12- 17
25- 3
14- 67
25- 901
25- 20
10- 6
27- 3
27- 501
28- 2
8- 502
23- 31
10- 42
20- 27
9- 25
9- 25
9- 901
16- 2
33- 1
35- 2
CPWBF0083QSE5
"
"
CPWBF0095QSE3
CPWBF0106QSE4
CPWBF0138QSE1
CPWBF0139QSE1
CPWBF0145QSE1
CPWBF1501FCE2
CPWBN0135QS31
CPWBN0137QSE1
CPWBN0146QSE2
CPWBX0134QS31
CPWBX0136QS31
CREFL0004QS33
"
CSFTB0073QS01
CSFTZ0023QS01
CSHEZ0244QS02
CSHEZ0433QS05
CSOU-0024RS55
CSOU-0037RS51
"
CSOU-0038RS51
CSW-M0007RS56
CTME-0021RS51
[D]
DHAI-0151QSZZ
DHAI-0167QSZZ
DHAI-0200QSZZ
"
DHAI-0314QSZZ
DHAI-0345QSZZ
"
DHAI-0346QSZZ
"
DHAI-0347QSZZ
"
DHAI-0348QSZZ
DHAI-0350QSZZ
DHAI-0353QSZZ
"
DHAI-0354QSZZ
DHAI-0355QSZZ
DHAI-0359QSZZ
DHAI-0360QSZZ
DHAI-0361QSZZ
DHAI-0362QSZZ
DHAI-0364QSZZ
"
"
DHAI-0365QSZZ
DHAI-0366QSZZ
DHAI-0367QSZZ
DHAI-0368QSZZ
DHAI-0370QSZZ
DHAI-0371QSZZ
"
DHAI-0372QSZZ
DHAI-0373QSZZ
"
DHAI-0374QSZZ
DHAI-0375QSZZ
DHAI-0376QSZZ
DHAI-0377QSZZ
DHAI-0378QSZZ
DHAI-0381QSZZ
DHAI-0382QSZZ
DHAI-0384QSZZ
"
DHAI-0386QSZZ
DHAI-0387QSZZ
DHAI-0388QSZZ
DHAI-0390QSZZ
DHAI-0392QSZZ
"
DHAI-0394QSZZ
DHAI-0395QSZZ
"
DHAI-0396QSZZ
DHAI-0397QSZZ
BL
AF
BA
AF
AF
AN
AM
AM
AZ
AP
BM
BL
AD
AX
AX
AX
AX
AW
AP
AQ
BH
BH
AZ
AZ
AZ
AZ
BH
AW
AK
AH
AF
AN
BT
BT
BT
BT
AX
BB
AV
BH
BK
BK
AZ
AZ
BK
AY
AS
BB
BL
BL
BL
AK
AL
AL
AZ
AU
BQ
AU
AP
AK
AU
BN
BN
AN
AK
AG
AZ
AH
AY
AR
AH
AG
AY
AY
BY
AP
BB
BB
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
E
C
E
C
C
C
C
C
E
D
E
E
D
D
D
D
D
E
E
E
D
D
E
E
E
E
E
D
D
D
D
D
E
E
E
E
D
C
E
E
E
E
D
D
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
C
C
C
E
E
E
E
E
C
C
E
E
C
C
C
E
C
E
C
C
C
D
D
D
E
E
E
38
NO.
13- 7
20- 48
26- 18
33- 4
19- 17
29- 4
5- 1
9- 15
4- 24
29- 33
29- 13
9- 3
29- 10
29- 1
11- 901
12- 8
6- 34
26- 21
32- 15
37- 101
19- 901
4- 501
5- 501
4- 502
14- 36
22- 502
AU
AU
AU
AP
AP
BD
BA
AX
AS
CF
AZ
BU
CF
CG
BL
BL
AF
AH
AE
AG
BK
BQ
BQ
BF
AP
AK
30301129211329132913292916142914141920992627292823232332930291429293025303029578465629353329333533-
AU
BA
AS
AS
AH
AG
AG
AP
AP
AN
AN
AH
AG
AH
AH
AG
AG
AP
AE
AE
AD
AP
AP
AP
AH
AL
AF
AD
AF
AR
AR
AE
AS
AS
AX
AM
AD
AP
AC
AH
BA
AR
AR
AK
AH
AE
AC
AU
AU
AD
AG
AG
AD
AD
19
19
9
37
50
30
22
4
38
4
38
42
21
14
28
55
56
13
49
5
14
19
10
35
10
9
10
7
11
40
7
6
10
39
44
2
25
31
8
43
3
18
2
35
44
13
22
29
4
29
41
31
17
17
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
C
C
C
E
E
E
E
B
E
B
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
PARTS CODE
DHAI-0398QSZZ
DHAI-0399QSZZ
DUNTK0034QSZZ
DUNTK0384RSZZ
DUNTW0375RS12
"
[G]
GCAB-0030QSZA
GCAB-0039QSZB
GCAB-0042QSZB
GCAB-0043QSZB
GCAB-0074QSZZ
GCAB-0075QSZZ
GCAB-0076QSZZ
GCAB-0077QSZZ
GCAB-0078QSZZ
GCAB-0080QSZZ
GCAB-0081QSZZ
GCAB-0083QSZZ
GCAB-0084QSZZ
GCAB-0085QSZZ
GCAB-0086QSZZ
GCASP0005QSZ2
GCASP0006QSZZ
GCOV-0029QSZ1
GCOV-0031QSZZ
GCOV-0034QSZB
GCOV-0042QSZZ
GCOV-0043QSZ1
GCOV-0052QSZZ
GCOV-0053QSZ1
GCOV-0054QSZZ
GCOV-0055QSZZ
GCOV-0056QSZZ
GCOV-0057QSZZ
GCOVA0025QSZB
GCOVA0026QSZB
GDOR-0002QSZC
GDOR-0003QSZ1
GLEGG0064FCZZ
[H]
HPNLH0030QSZZ
[J]
JHNDP0004QSZZ
JHNDP0005QSZZ
JKNBZ0006QSZZ
JKNBZ0009QSZZ
[L]
LANGF0013QSZZ
LBNDJ0013FCZ1
"
LBNDZ0002QSZZ
LBOSZ1508FCZZ
LBOSZ1510FCZZ
LBRC-0002QSZZ
LBRC-0003QSZZ
LBRC-0012QSZZ
LBSHZ0006QSZZ
LBSHZ0303FCZZ
"
"
"
"
LCRA-0002QSZZ
LDAI-0023QSZB
LDAIU0024QSZ1
LFIX-0009QSZZ
LFIX-0011QSZB
LFIX-0012QSZB
LFIX-0014QSZZ
LFIX-0015QSZZ
LFIX-0016FCZZ
LFRM-0037QSZ2
LFRM-0039QSZB
LFRM-0040QSZZ
LFRM-0047QSZZ
LFRM-0048QSZC
LFRM-0058QSZZ
LFRM-0069QSZZ
LFRM-0071QSZZ
LFRM-0072QSZZ
NO.
17- 20
16- 31
11- 8
14- 1
23- 901
24- 901
AE
AF
BC
BW
BZ
BZ
N
N
3122244664112129321522222222229313418231-
1
16
1
6
9
1
1
24
20
2
1
24
6
8
24
5
5
4
10
9
38
17
21
22
20
19
5
1
5
10
2
13
15
AN
AX
AQ
AN
AK
AR
AP
AQ
AV
AN
AN
AW
AV
AZ
AV
BA
BA
AR
AK
AK
AK
AS
AY
AG
AX
AN
AH
AT
AS
AP
AY
AP
AC
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
9-
BC
1532147-
23
23
40
37
AV
AY
AD
AE
N
N
C
C
C
D
21142022020272617201820262728131036111122223014311828202862324-
47
69
43
25
14
17
15
5
44
51
4
13
25
16
23
17
11
3
10
8
17
19
19
32
43
7
16
5
37
6
36
23
16
AD
AE
AE
AC
AG
AF
AD
AD
AD
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
BH
AH
AF
AP
AK
AE
AE
AD
BA
BK
AV
AG
AT
AG
AQ
AY
AU
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
C
C
C
E
E
E
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
D
D
D
D
C
C
C
D
D
D
D
D
D
C
D
D
PARTS CODE
LHLDR0072QSZZ
LHLDW0086QSZZ
"
LHLDW1009ACZZ
LHLDW1057FCZZ
LHLDW1061FCZZ
LHLDW1226FCZZ
"
"
LHLDW1334FCZZ
LHLDZ0001YSZZ
LHLDZ0047QSZ2
LHLDZ0056QSZZ
LHLDZ0057QSZZ
LHLDZ0058QSZZ
LHLDZ0062QSZ2
LHLDZ0065QSZ1
LHLDZ0066QSZZ
LHLDZ0070QSZ2
LHLDZ0071QSZZ
LHLDZ0084QSZZ
LHLDZ0085QSZZ
LHLDZ0090QSZZ
LHLDZ0094QSZZ
LHLDZ0101QSZZ
LHLDZ0102QSZZ
LHLDZ0103QSZZ
LHLDZ0104QSZZ
LHLDZ0105QSZZ
LHLDZ7021XCZZ
LPIN-0026MCZZ
"
LPINS0014QSBZ
LPINS0014QSCZ
LPINS0133FCZZ
LPINS0258FCZZ
LPINS0300FCZZ
LPINS0301FCZZ
LPINS0327FCZZ
LPLTM0001YSZZ
LPLTM0002YSZ2
LPLTM0090QSZZ
LPLTM0091QSZZ
LPLTM0102QSZZ
LPLTM0111QSZZ
LPLTM0149QSZZ
LPLTM0162QSZZ
LPLTM0163QSZZ
LPLTM0165QSZ1
LPLTM0166QSZZ
LPLTM0176QSZZ
LPLTM0179QSZ1
"
LPLTM0180QSZ1
"
LPLTM0181QSZ1
"
LPLTM0194QSZZ
LPLTM0195QSZZ
LPLTM0203QSZ1
LPLTM0232QSZ1
LPLTM0236QSZZ
LPLTM0237QSZZ
LPLTM0240QSZZ
LPLTM0241QSZZ
LPLTM0248QSZZ
LPLTM0249QSZZ
LPLTM0251QSZZ
LPLTM0252QSZZ
LPLTM0276QSZZ
LPLTM0277QSZZ
"
LPLTM0316QSZZ
LPLTM0318QSZZ
LPLTM0322QSZZ
LPLTM0323QSZZ
LPLTM0325QSZZ
LPLTM0326QSZZ
LPLTM0327QSZZ
LPLTM0331QSZZ
LPLTM0332QSZZ
39
NO.
21232913301015323727211112142629141929291814221757813913163399182714145212118181851430101010351532153215321426351031313122143010301715325688777910-
31
11
9
5
30
14
2
2
10
34
35
3
10
9
12
7
37
10
16
12
20
28
36
38
23
27
28
19
9
25
16
22
27
26
6
19
52
52
25
25
26
28
29
19
4
16
5
1
20
22
33
3
3
20
20
8
8
45
9
20
3
8
16
3
4
29
15
24
6
35
27
27
32
12
29
31
16
43
9
30
46
AC
AB
AB
AA
AB
AB
AB
AB
AB
AA
AD
AW
AC
AH
AR
AT
AF
AD
AX
AG
AF
AE
AC
AC
AE
AC
AC
AD
AG
AD
AA
AA
AF
AF
AA
AA
AD
AD
AC
AN
AP
AE
AE
AD
AC
AD
AC
AK
AS
AC
AH
AR
AR
AE
AE
AB
AB
AC
AC
AF
AU
AG
AH
AC
AF
AE
AC
AE
AD
AE
AC
AC
AH
AC
AF
AG
AH
AM
AD
AC
AE
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
PARTS CODE
LPLTM0333QSZZ
LPLTM0334QSZZ
LPLTM0335QSZZ
LPLTM0337QSZZ
LPLTM0338QSZZ
LPLTM0339QSZZ
LPLTM0340QSZZ
LPLTM0344QSZZ
LPLTM0346QSZZ
LPLTM0349QSZZ
LPLTM4715FCZ1
LPLTM6022FCZZ
LPLTP0056QSZ3
LPLTP0117QSZZ
LPLTP0131QSZZ
LPLTP0159QSZZ
"
LPLTP0185QSZ1
LPLTP0230QSZZ
LPLTP0234QSZZ
LPLTP0297QSZZ
"
LPLTP0319QSZZ
LPLTP0320QSZZ
LPLTP0321QSZZ
LPLTP0324QSZZ
LPLTP0328QSZZ
LPLTP0348QSZZ
LRALM0006QSZZ
LRALM0007QSZ1
LRALP0004QSZ2
LRALP0008QSZ1
LRALP0009QSZZ
LSOU-0024QSZB
LSOU-0025QSZB
LSOU-0026QSZB
LSOU-0027QSZB
LSOU-0037QSZZ
"
LSOU-0038QSZZ
LSOU-0039QSZZ
LSOU-0040QSZZ
LSOU-0041QSZZ
LSTPP0003QSZ1
LSTPP0010QSZZ
LSTPP0011QSZZ
"
LSTPP0015QSZZ
LSTPP0016QSZZ
"
LSTPP0017QSZZ
LX-BZ0004QSZZ
"
LX-BZ0015QSZZ
LX-BZ0020QSZZ
LX-BZ0024QSZZ
"
"
"
LX-BZ0026QSZZ
LX-BZ0030QSZZ
LX-BZ0031GCZZ
LX-BZ0031QSZZ
LX-BZ0032QSZZ
LX-BZ0037QSZZ
LX-BZ0040QSZZ
LX-BZ0049FCZZ
LX-BZ0324FCZZ
LX-BZ0406FCZZ
LX-BZ0780FCZZ
LX-BZ0833FCZZ
"
LX-BZ0884FCZZ
"
LX-NZ0002QSZZ
LX-RZ0001QSZZ
LX-WZ0001QSZZ
LX-WZ0119FCZZ
LX-WZ0329FCZZ
LX-WZ7021SCZZ
NO.
10232323232324249301121205715322613191734444771712121817341919191945443427142034646231213371412122921313291831231212222615321532232223122223-
16
16
22
25
13
20
9
7
29
37
14
20
39
40
36
1
1
13
13
15
24
13
33
34
19
41
5
13
13
12
31
18
19
4
18
11
20
14
43
31
21
14
32
6
33
52
18
47
4
21
18
11
29
8
15
34
5
37
15
36
12
33
8
38
23
17
25
28
37
35
14
14
10
10
6
27
37
31
26
21
AX
AE
AF
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AS
AF
AC
AD
AM
AD
AD
AD
AL
AF
AE
AC
AC
AH
AH
AE
AH
AC
AC
AG
AG
AH
AQ
AQ
AT
AS
AU
AT
BE
BE
AW
AN
BB
AP
AC
AD
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AF
AB
AB
AF
AB
AA
AA
AA
AA
AD
AC
AB
AC
AB
AB
AC
AB
AA
AA
AC
AC
AC
AB
AB
AA
AB
AC
AA
AB
AA
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
PARTS CODE
[M]
MARMM0047QSZZ
MARMP0006QSZZ
MARMP0008QSZZ
MARMP0009QSZZ
MARMP0015QSZZ
MARMP0018QSZZ
MARMP0019QSZZ
"
MARMP0021QSZZ
"
MARMP0025QSZZ
MARMP0026QSZZ
"
MARMP0027QSZ1
MARMP0041QSZZ
MARMP0043QSZZ
MARMP0044QSZZ
MARMP0045QSZZ
MARMP0046QSZZ
MARMP0048QSZZ
MCAMP0003QSZZ
MHNG-0021QSZZ
MHNG-0022QSZZ
MLEVF0093QSZZ
MLEVP0023QSZZ
MLEVP0035QSE1
MLEVP0036QSZZ
MLEVP0044QSZZ
MLEVP0055QSZ1
MLEVP0056QSZZ
MLEVP0057QSZZ
MLEVP0058QSEZ
MLEVP0062QSZZ
MLEVP0063QSZZ
"
MLEVP0064QSZZ
"
MLEVP0065QSZZ
MLEVP0067QSZ1
MLEVP0068QSZZ
MLEVP0069QSZZ
MLEVP0071QSZZ
MLEVP0077QSZZ
MLEVP0092QSZZ
MLEVP0095QSZZ
MLEVP0096QSZZ
MLEVP0097QSZZ
MLEVP0098QSZZ
MLEVP0099QSZZ
MLEVP0100QSZZ
MLEVP0101QSZZ
MLEVP0104QSZZ
MLEVP0755FCZ1
"
MLNKP0001QSZZ
MLOKZ0001QSZZ
MSLI-0138FCZZ
MSPRC0040QSZZ
MSPRC0045QSZZ
MSPRC0063QSZZ
MSPRC0141QSZZ
MSPRC0153QSZZ
MSPRC0195QSZZ
MSPRC0200QSZZ
MSPRC0209QSZ1
"
MSPRC0210QSZZ
"
MSPRC0213QSZZ
MSPRC0220QSZZ
MSPRC0250QSZZ
"
MSPRC0262QSZZ
MSPRC0263QSZZ
MSPRC0270QSZZ
"
MSPRC0271QSZZ
MSPRC0291QSZZ
MSPRC0292QSZZ
MSPRC0295QSZZ
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
D
D
D
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
40
NO.
620202034351633163314163320201866623204451719517261617183316331633222832141357664232323201532634111222734714251633153222141942536173414171718-
20
19
38
8
5
6
11
24
15
20
5
9
10
36
18
9
35
49
31
1
21
10
11
11
11
16
10
12
15
5
22
1
7
4
5
3
6
5
25
10
12
35
16
16
30
48
46
22
34
2
3
50
13
13
4
2
4
16
14
17
1
34
48
4
24
11
18
18
30
34
6
27
21
13
26
16
63
4
39
23
AE
AD
AH
AF
AD
AD
AD
AD
AD
AD
AD
AD
AD
AE
AE
AC
AF
AC
AD
AF
AD
AX
AX
AE
AE
AC
AD
AE
AC
AC
AC
AD
AC
AD
AD
AD
AD
AE
AC
AC
AD
AD
AC
AC
AD
AC
AC
AC
AF
AE
AE
AD
AE
AE
AD
AC
AC
AB
AA
AB
AB
AB
AB
AB
AC
AC
AC
AC
AB
AB
AC
AC
AC
AC
AB
AB
AC
AC
AC
AF
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
PARTS CODE
MSPRC0296QSZZ
MSPRC0301QSZZ
MSPRC0307QSZ1
MSPRC0323QSZZ
MSPRC0324QSZZ
MSPRC0325QSZZ
MSPRC0346QSZZ
MSPRC0348QSZZ
MSPRC0349QSZZ
MSPRC1315FCZ1
MSPRC1316FCZ1
MSPRC1318FCZ1
"
MSPRC2175FCZZ
MSPRC2631FCZZ
"
MSPRD0092QSZZ
MSPRD0189QSZZ
MSPRD0190QSZ1
MSPRD0191QSZ1
MSPRD0192QSZ1
MSPRD0194QSZ1
MSPRD0196QSZZ
MSPRD0198QSZZ
MSPRD0201QSZZ
MSPRD0202QSZZ
MSPRD0204QSZZ
MSPRD0205QSZZ
MSPRD0206QSZZ
"
MSPRD0208QSZZ
MSPRD0211QSZZ
MSPRD0216QSZZ
MSPRD0218QSZZ
MSPRD0222QSZZ
MSPRD0224QSZZ
MSPRD0225QSZZ
MSPRD0232QSZZ
MSPRD0233QSZ1
MSPRD0251QSZZ
MSPRD0276QSZZ
"
MSPRD0277QSZZ
MSPRD0287QSZZ
"
MSPRD0302QSZZ
MSPRD0305QSZZ
MSPRD0309QSZZ
MSPRD0310QSZZ
MSPRD0313QSZZ
MSPRD0314QSZZ
MSPRD0316QSZZ
MSPRD0322QSZZ
MSPRD0326QSZZ
MSPRD0327QSZZ
MSPRD0328QSZZ
MSPRD0329QSZZ
MSPRD0340QSZZ
MSPRD0342QSZZ
MSPRD0347QSZZ
MSPRK0001YSZZ
MSPRP0123QSZZ
MSPRP0145QSZZ
MSPRP0306QSZZ
MSPRP0311QSZZ
MSPRP0312QSZZ
MSPRP0315QSZZ
MSPRP0345QSZZ
MSPRP2830FCZZ
MSPRT0091QSZZ
MSPRT0197QSZZ
MSPRT0203QSZZ
MSPRT0214QSZZ
MSPRT0217QSZ1
MSPRT0221QSZZ
MSPRT0229GCAZ
"
"
MSPRT0257QSZ1
MSPRT0308QSZZ
MSPRT0317QSZZ
NO.
18175232424818182020142020153220214141417272716173318163336527281826271317361031311734205666672324242420175202151156843419202635222714226282358-
22
14
34
24
3
6
34
18
17
15
22
51
33
31
12
12
28
11
11
12
13
3
26
23
6
21
30
30
18
19
12
14
13
11
8
14
5
15
10
12
50
24
25
40
27
45
24
5
28
50
14
40
33
17
15
11
46
47
9
20
33
35
6
31
26
21
30
8
14
9
16
10
28
14
39
15
28
7
32
36
27
AF
AD
AC
AC
AC
AB
AC
AD
AD
AD
AE
AA
AA
AA
AC
AC
AE
AB
AD
AD
AD
AD
AC
AC
AC
AB
AC
AE
AC
AC
AC
AC
AD
AD
AC
AB
AC
AB
AC
AD
AS
AS
AN
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AD
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AD
AD
AB
AD
AF
AC
AC
AD
AD
AD
AA
AC
AB
AC
AB
AC
AB
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
PARTS CODE
[N]
NBLTT0002QSZZ
NBLTT0024QSZZ
NBLTT0026QSZZ
NBLTT0029QSZZ
NBLTT0033QSZZ
NBLTT0034QSZZ
NBLTT0035QSZZ
NBLTT0036QSZZ
NBLTT0038QSZZ
NBRGC0017QSZZ
"
NBRGC0018QSZZ
"
"
NBRGC0019QSZZ
NBRGC0020QSZZ
NBRGC0021QSZZ
NBRGC0100FCZ1
"
"
NBRGC0529FCZZ
NBRGM0096FCZ1
NBRGM0501FCZZ
"
"
"
"
NBRGP0011QSZZ
NBRGP0012QSZZ
NBRGP0025QSZZ
NBRGP0041GCZZ
"
"
NBRGP0299FCZZ
NBRGY0022QSZZ
NBRGY2122SCZZ
"
"
NBRGZ0503FCZZ
NCPL-0003QSZZ
NCPL-0009QSZZ
NCPL-0011QSZZ
NCPL-0012QSZZ
NCPL-0049FCBZ
NFANP0004QSZZ
NFANP0011QSZZ
NFANP0015QSZZ
NGERH0001YSZZ
NGERH0002YSZZ
NGERH0010QSZZ
NGERH0011QSZZ
NGERH0027QSZZ
NGERH0036QSZZ
NGERH0037QSZZ
NGERH0038QSZZ
NGERH0039QSZZ
NGERH0061QSZZ
NGERH0067QSZZ
NGERH0068QSZ1
NGERH0074QSZZ
NGERH0080QSZZ
NGERH0082QSZZ
NGERH0083QSZZ
NGERH0084QSZZ
NGERH0085QSZZ
NGERH0086QSZZ
NGERH0087QSZZ
NGERH0090QSZZ
NGERH0091QSZZ
NGERH0092QSZZ
NGERH0093QSZZ
NGERH0095QSZZ
NGERH0096QSZZ
NGERH0097QSZZ
NGERH0102QSZZ
NGERH0103QSZZ
NGERH0104QSZZ
NGERH0105QSZZ
NGERH0107QSZZ
"
41
NO.
1227103568871078144627212116333535626285781212231532522242627283422251420626303212125251222222222202727182727252525252525252525252516363636361633-
29
20
19
25
42
10
18
38
45
39
23
31
13
17
18
11
15
19
18
5
32
7
10
16
28
22
12
33
22
29
21
21
41
23
1
8
17
20
17
7
22
49
47
37
31
38
5
14
10
12
17
30
16
20
21
18
7
8
7
5
21
22
24
7
9
10
11
6
23
13
14
16
19
20
4
6
9
10
17
21
AH
AG
AF
AG
AF
AF
AE
AF
AF
AC
AC
AD
AD
AD
AD
AH
AD
AC
AC
AC
AD
AC
AB
AB
AB
AB
AB
AC
AC
AN
AD
AD
AD
AC
AL
AB
AB
AB
AC
AC
AC
AC
AD
AT
BB
AS
BA
AD
AD
AD
AD
AH
AC
AC
AC
AE
AD
AD
AD
AD
AE
AD
AH
AK
AE
AD
AE
AE
AE
AD
AD
AE
AE
AF
AD
AE
AE
AD
AD
AD
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
B
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
PARTS CODE
NGERH0108QSZZ
"
NGERH0110QSZZ
NGERH0111QSZZ
NGERH0112QSZZ
NGERH0113QSZZ
NGERH0114QSZZ
NGERH0116QSZ1
NGERH0117QSZZ
NGERH0119QSZZ
NGERH0121QSZZ
NGERH0136QSZZ
NGERH0152QSZZ
NGERH0153QSZZ
NGERH0155QSZZ
NGERH0156QSZZ
NGERH0158QSZ1
NGERH0163QSZ2
NGERH0166QSZZ
NGERH0167QSZZ
NGERH0170QSZZ
NGERH0171QSZZ
NGERH0173QSZZ
NGERH0174QSZZ
NGERH0193FCZZ
"
NGERH0495FCZZ
NGERH0972FCZZ
NGERH0990FCZZ
"
NGERH1207FCZZ
NGERP0168QSZZ
NGERP1385FCZZ
NGERR0140QSZZ
NGERR0169QSZZ
NKOM-0005QSZZ
"
"
"
NKOM-0006QSZZ
NKOM-0007QSZZ
"
NKOM-0009QSZZ
NPLYZ0003QSZZ
NPLYZ0004QSZZ
NPLYZ0006QSZZ
NPLYZ0016QSZZ
NPLYZ0018QSZZ
NPLYZ0019QSZZ
"
NPLYZ0027QSZZ
NPLYZ0033QSZZ
"
NPLYZ0034QSZZ
NPLYZ0035QSZZ
NPLYZ0036QSZZ
NROLM0037QSZ4
NROLM0098QSZZ
NROLM0108QSZZ
NROLP0008QSZZ
NROLP0010QSZZ
"
NROLP0011QSZZ
NROLP0036QSZZ
NROLP0049QSZZ
NROLP0072QSZ1
NROLP0079QSZZ
"
NROLP0087QSZZ
"
NROLP1060FCZZ
"
NROLP1122FCZZ
"
"
NROLR0051QSZ1
"
NROLR0052QSZZ
NROLR0054QSZZ
"
NROLR0055QSZ1
NO.
1532282828272788353521252527163618668231010153220201633354191941017313417781712121212878354666102623213556518262126281734234182628262834163316-
17
17
18
17
19
24
25
13
15
11
24
16
18
5
27
23
2
39
2
6
11
28
8
43
11
11
5
26
13
26
12
25
9
7
26
26
27
13
21
6
29
26
45
24
23
4
3
24
25
17
28
6
18
41
38
9
7
27
22
30
30
29
18
12
3
9
4
14
41
28
14
7
15
27
8
24
22
15
10
27
14
AD
AD
AE
AC
AC
AC
AC
AD
AK
AD
AE
AD
AH
AH
AD
AD
AE
AG
AC
AD
AD
AR
AD
AD
AB
AB
AC
AB
AB
AB
AF
AD
AF
AD
AE
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AM
AG
AD
AF
AE
AE
AE
AD
AD
AD
AD
AD
AD
AR
BE
BA
AD
AD
AD
AD
AP
AC
AP
AC
AC
AD
AD
AF
AF
AF
AF
AF
AL
AL
AN
AP
AP
AR
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
PARTS CODE
NROLR0055QSZ1
NROLR0056QSZ1
NROLR0089QSZZ
NROLR0094QSZZ
NROLR0095QSZZ
NROLR0096QSZZ
NROLR0097QSZZ
NROLR0922FCZ2
NROLR1267FCZ1
NROLR1311FCZZ
NROLR1312FCZZ
NROLS0100QSZZ
NSFTB0075QSZZ
NSFTZ0009QSZZ
"
NSFTZ0013QSZZ
NSFTZ0017QSZZ
NSFTZ0020QSZZ
NSFTZ0028QSZ1
NSFTZ0042QSZZ
NSFTZ0043QSZ1
NSFTZ0044QSZZ
NSFTZ0045QSZZ
NSFTZ0047QSZZ
"
NSFTZ0048QSZZ
"
"
"
NSFTZ0050QSZ1
NSFTZ0054QSZZ
NSFTZ0055QSZ1
NSFTZ0060QSZZ
NSFTZ0064QSZZ
"
"
NSFTZ0065QSZZ
NSFTZ0072QSZZ
NSFTZ0074QSZZ
NSRW-0002QSZZ
[P]
PBOX-0001YS13
PBOX-0006QSZZ
PBOX-0016QSZZ
PBRSR0019QSZZ
PBRSR0020QSZ1
PBRSR0021QSZ1
PBRSS0008QSZ1
PCAPH0009QSZZ
PCAPH0023FCZZ
PCAPH1003ACZZ
PCAPH1005ACZZ
PCASZ0010QSZZ
PCLC-0006QSZZ
PCLC-0011QSZZ
PCLC-0012QSZZ
PCLC-0014QSZZ
PCLC-0017QSZZ
"
PCLC-0018QSZZ
PCLC-0316FCZ1
PCOVP0053QSZ2
PCOVP0055QSZC
PCOVP0057QSZZ
PCOVP0061QSZ1
PCOVP0062QSZZ
PCOVP0063QSZB
PCOVP0064QSZZ
"
PCOVP0066QSZZ
PCOVP0070QSZZ
PCOVP0072QSZZ
PCOVP0073QSZZ
PCOVP0075QSZZ
PCOVP0084QSZZ
PCOVP0085QSZZ
PCOVP0088QSZ1
PCOVP0089QSZZ
PCOVP0094QSZZ
PCOVP0095QSZZ
PCOVP0096QSZZ
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
B
B
C
B
B
B
B
C
C
C
C
C
B
B
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
42
NO.
33281477772020662465652022122616363615321017313433341836171734175622-
23
9
30
13
14
12
42
4
10
39
40
2
10
29
30
21
25
22
27
1
29
7
5
19
19
25
28
12
22
13
6
10
8
42
46
29
5
26
15
3
AR
AN
AQ
AR
AR
AR
AR
AR
AH
AN
AN
BB
AF
AE
AE
AF
AG
AL
AS
AF
AH
AC
AC
AP
AP
AG
AG
AG
AG
AH
AE
AN
AC
AD
AD
AD
AD
AP
AF
AE
2133262828722292929131435163546861720223614311633103321211335317346915-
18
8
3
6
4
3
44
2
30
31
32
24
19
26
28
7
5
19
25
3
2
1
17
11
32
10
7
8
21
2
5
38
1
1
2
25
12
32
6
25
AM
AF
AN
AK
AH
AG
AH
AC
AC
AC
AC
AL
AU
AS
AS
AS
AT
AT
AT
AR
AP
AL
AG
AH
AD
AD
AD
AD
AC
AD
AK
AG
AE
AE
AP
AD
AD
AD
AG
AN
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
C
C
C
B
B
B
B
C
C
B
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
D
C
B
B
B
B
D
D
D
D
D
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
C
D
D
D
C
C
C
PARTS CODE
PCOVP0096QSZZ
PCUSF0334FCZZ
PCUSG0190FCZ1
"
PCUSS0011QSZZ
PCUSS0022QSZZ
PCUSS0027QSZZ
PCUSU0203FCZZ
PDUC-0003QSZ1
PDUC-0004QSZZ
PFILZ0004QSZZ
PFILZ0011QSZ1
PFTA-0019QSZZ
PGIDH0095QSZZ
PGIDH0114QSZZ
PGIDM0065QSZ1
PGIDM0067QSZ1
PGIDM0068QSZZ
PGIDM0070QSZ1
"
PGIDM0071QSZZ
"
PGIDM0072QSZ2
PGIDM0074QSZZ
PGIDM0075QSZZ
PGIDM0076QSZZ
PGIDM0085QSZZ
PGIDM0086QSZZ
PGIDM0105QSZZ
PGIDM0106QSZZ
PGIDM0107QSZZ
PGIDM0108QSZZ
PGIDM0109QSZZ
PGIDM0112QSZZ
PGIDM0113QSZZ
PGIDM0115QSZZ
PGLSP0003QSZZ
PGLSP0004QSZZ
PGSK-0008QSZZ
PGSK-0011QSZZ
PGSK-0012QSZZ
PGSK-0013QSZZ
PGSK-0014QSZZ
PGSK-0015QSZZ
PGSK-0016QSZZ
PGSK-0017QSZZ
PGSK-0018QSZZ
PGSK-0021QSZZ
PGSK-0022QSZZ
PGSK-0023QSZZ
PGSK-0026QSZZ
PGUMM0005QSZZ
PGUMS0002QSZZ
PMIR-0009QSZZ
PMLT-0002YSZ1
PMLT-0005YSZZ
PMLT-0006YSZZ
PMLT-0018QSZ1
PMLT-0027QSZZ
PMLT-0088QSZZ
PMLT-0089QSZZ
PMLT-0090QSZZ
PMLT-0091QSZZ
PMLT-0092QSZZ
PMLT-0093QSZZ
PMLT-0094QSZZ
PPIPP0014QSZZ
PPIPP0015QSZZ
PPIPP0109FCZZ
PRDAZ0002QSZZ
PREFL0004QSZZ
PRNGF0106FCZ2
PRNGP0090FCZZ
PSEL-0025QSZZ
PSEL-0035QSZZ
PSEL-0037QSZ1
PSEL-0070QSZZ
PSEL-0071QSZZ
PSEL-0114QSZZ
PSEL-0115QSZZ
PSEL-0116QSZZ
NO.
32111213141112632621712242617341532153228341919212167712123023241113222222292910101010261211212121222621028101011320222027112252121212222212121-
28
11
20
9
22
15
24
5
30
6
32
18
15
39
8
26
9
4
6
6
9
9
21
23
1
2
1
2
23
45
1
35
37
11
35
18
11
19
39
42
43
44
45
46
47
50
45
47
48
49
56
2
18
7
6
8
7
24
33
48
53
30
55
52
26
41
23
13
16
36
1
38
42
21
3
13
11
10
39
40
46
AN
AP
AB
AB
AB
AW
AA
AE
AG
AL
AM
AQ
AE
AH
AH
AY
AR
AP
AM
AM
AL
AL
AU
AK
AF
AF
AP
AQ
AQ
AS
AP
AH
AH
AG
AT
AS
BA
AX
AF
AS
AQ
AP
AM
AL
AP
AH
AH
AQ
AP
AH
AQ
AD
AL
AS
AC
AB
AB
AC
AC
AE
AC
AE
AD
AB
AB
AC
AC
AG
AB
AD
AP
AC
AA
AA
AE
AG
AF
AF
AC
AD
AB
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
B
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
PARTS CODE
PSEL-0117QSZZ
PSEL-0124QSZZ
PSEL-0132QSZZ
PSEN-0001QSZZ
PSHEM0338QSZZ
PSHEM0342QSZZ
PSHEP0035YSZZ
PSHEP0324QSZZ
PSHEP3029FCZZ
"
PSHEZ0065QSZZ
PSHEZ0069QSZZ
PSHEZ0077QSZ1
PSHEZ0088QSZ1
PSHEZ0099QSZZ
PSHEZ0108QSZZ
PSHEZ0133QSZZ
PSHEZ0207QSZZ
PSHEZ0208QSZZ
PSHEZ0217QSZZ
PSHEZ0218QSZZ
PSHEZ0219QSZZ
PSHEZ0220QSZ1
PSHEZ0221QSZZ
PSHEZ0222QSZZ
PSHEZ0241QSZZ
PSHEZ0244QSZ2
PSHEZ0249QSZZ
PSHEZ0250QSZZ
PSHEZ0254QSZZ
PSHEZ0266QSZ1
PSHEZ0269QSZZ
PSHEZ0273QSZZ
PSHEZ0274QSZZ
"
PSHEZ0283QSZZ
PSHEZ0285QSZZ
PSHEZ0286QSZZ
PSHEZ0301QSZZ
"
PSHEZ0302QSZZ
"
PSHEZ0307QSZ1
PSHEZ0314QSZ1
PSHEZ0316QSZZ
PSHEZ0322QSZZ
PSHEZ0325QSZZ
"
PSHEZ0329QSZZ
PSHEZ0330QSZZ
PSHEZ0333QSZZ
PSHEZ0341QSZZ
PSHEZ0378QSZZ
"
"
PSHEZ0391QSZZ
PSHEZ0392QSZZ
PSHEZ0393QSZZ
PSHEZ0394QSZZ
PSHEZ0413QSZZ
PSHEZ0414QSZZ
PSHEZ0415QSZZ
PSHEZ0420QSZZ
PSHEZ0423QSZZ
PSHEZ0424QSZZ
PSHEZ0425QSZZ
PSHEZ0426QSZZ
PSHEZ0436QSZZ
PSHEZ0448QSZZ
PSHEZ0451QSZZ
PSHEZ0452QSZZ
PSHEZ0454QSZZ
PSHEZ0455QSZZ
PSHEZ1394FCZZ
PSHT-0004QSZ1
PSPAP0023QSZZ
PSPAP0036QSZZ
PSPAZ0696FCZZ
PSPO-0003QSZZ
PSPO-0004QSZZ
PSPO-0020QSZZ
43
NO.
212121212912212178105412013171113131311120153535132429131532353173417341817271710312218102717173416161614487137991351377773722212122555-
43
44
23
27
54
38
19
49
26
19
7
38
17
25
3
31
7
20
23
21
20
32
4
18
21
42
15
31
29
34
4
20
38
4
4
20
20
17
33
25
34
26
34
43
35
36
41
22
34
36
40
37
17
23
14
36
37
38
65
16
9
15
43
4
12
13
45
37
22
7
2
46
47
2
12
34
45
15
22
7
19
AB
AB
AG
AC
AH
AU
AB
AC
AA
AA
AB
AE
AE
AD
AC
AC
AD
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AK
AC
AC
AB
AC
AB
AB
AC
AK
AC
AB
AC
AC
AB
AB
AE
AC
AC
AC
AC
AB
AF
AD
AD
AB
AB
AC
AC
AC
AA
AG
AG
AG
AC
AB
AA
AB
AD
AB
AE
AC
AP
AL
AE
AB
AD
AA
AC
AF
AB
AD
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AC
AB
AB
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
PARTS CODE
PSPO-0021QSZZ
PSPO-0022QSZZ
PSPO-0023QSZZ
PSPO-0026QSZZ
PTME-0014QSZZ
PTME-0020QSZ1
PTME-0021QSZZ
PTME-0024QSZZ
PTME-0029QSZZ
PTME-0030QSZZ
PTME-0178FCZZ
PTME-0179FCZZ
PTME-0271FCZZ
"
PTME-0282FCZZ
PTPE-0018QSZZ
PTPE-0021QSZZ
"
PTPE-0026QSZZ
PTPE-0027QSZZ
PTPE-0028QSZZ
PTPE-0029QSZZ
PTPE-0032QSZZ
PTPE-0034QSZZ
PTPE-0035QSZZ
PTPE-0036QSZZ
PTPE-0051QSZZ
PTPE-0052QSZZ
PWIR-0005QSZ1
PWIR-0006QSZZ
[Q]
QACCBR421QCPZ
QACCDR614QCPZ
QACCER624QCPZ
QACCJR614QCPZ
QACCLR421QCPZ
QSW-B0017QSZZ
"
"
"
"
QSW-C9292QCZZ
[R]
RCORF0002QSZZ
"
"
RCORF0011QSZZ
RCORF0012QSZZ
RCORF0013QSZZ
RCORF0014QSZZ
RCORF0026FCZZ
RCORF1036ACZZ
RDENC0011QS11
RDENC0011QS12
RDENC0011QSZZ
RDENC0012QSZZ
RDTCM0015QSZZ
RDTCT0006QSZZ
RH-HX0001QSZZ
RLMPU0012QSZZ
RLMPU0026QSZZ
RLMPU0027QSZZ
RLMPU0028QSZZ
RLMPU0029QSZZ
RMOTD0023QSZZ
RMOTP0024QSZZ
RMOTP0025QSNA
RMOTP0027QSZZ
RMOTP0029QSNA
RMOTS0043QSZZ
RMOTS0045QSZZ
RPLU-0011QSZ1
RPLU-0015QSZ1
RPLU-0024QSZZ
RPLU-0026QSZ1
"
RPLU-0027QSZZ
RPLU-0028QSZZ
RSNSZ0001QSZZ
RTHM-0004QSZZ
NO.
26851724182223672020194238153222292929122929121391212-
20
7
6
37
12
7
25
38
27
20
30
34
5
28
36
3
7
7
35
51
52
53
41
48
49
40
44
8
6
1
AD
AB
AB
AA
AK
AC
AK
AN
AE
AC
AC
AC
AD
AD
AH
AC
AD
AD
AA
AP
AG
AG
AK
AP
AH
AF
AC
AA
AQ
AQ
3030303030141619283330-
19
19
19
19
19
66
22
12
15
14
20
AZ
AS
AW
AW
AW
AF
AF
AF
AF
AF
AN
13299292514285353030303021723112323232314272512278105814163327201323-
26
21
32
47
26
68
29
8
16
28
28
28
29
28
19
12
2
26
19
26
19
47
30
2
15
2
1
44
5
6
50
8
9
28
32
11
8
AE
AE
AE
AG
AC
AG
AK
AL
AP
BY
BY
BY
BN
AY
AL
AS
BG
AZ
AY
AZ
AY
AZ
AW
BF
BG
AV
BG
AR
AQ
AR
AM
AR
AR
AU
AM
BA
AN
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
PARTS CODE
[S]
SPAKA0134RSZZ
SPAKA0480QSZZ
SPAKA0481QSZZ
SPAKA0482QSZZ
SPAKA0483QSZZ
SPAKA0484QSZZ
SPAKA0485QSZZ
SSAKA2343QCZZ
SSAKA3001CCZZ
SSAKZ0019FCZZ
[T]
TCADZ0010QSZZ
TCADZ0015QSZZ
TCADZ1275FCZZ
TCAUA0770FCZZ
TCAUH0007QSZZ
TCAUH0016QSZZ
TCAUH0933FCZZ
TINSE1001QSZZ
TINSE1003QSZZ
TINSE1005QSZZ
TINSE1027QSZZ
TINSE1029QSZZ
TINSE1031QSZZ
TINSE1053QSZZ
TINSE1091QSZZ
TINSF1006QSZZ
TINSF1032QSZZ
TINSF1055QSZZ
TINSF1093QSZZ
TINSG1008QSZZ
TINSG1034QSZZ
TINSG1056QSZZ
TINSG1095QSZZ
TLABG0401QSZZ
TLABH0289QSZZ
TLABH0461QSZZ
TLABH0484QSZZ
TLABZ0058QSZZ
TLABZ0366QSZZ
TLABZ4047FCZZ
TLABZ4312FCZZ
[U]
UCLEZ0011QSZZ
UKOGZ0002FCZZ
UYOK-0011FCZZ
[V]
VHPGP1A71L3-1
VHPGP1S44S/-1
VHPGP1S73P+-1
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
VHPGP2D03//-1
VHPGP2D032/-1
VHPGP2D07//-1
VVLLM065HB1-1
[X]
XBBSD26P03000
XBBSD30P05000
"
"
XBBSD30P08000
XBBSD30P10000
XBBSD40P08000
XBBSF30P08000
"
XBPBZ30P03000
XBPSC30P06ES0
XBPSD30P05K00
XBPSD30P06KS0
"
XBPSD30P08KS0
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
E
E
E
E
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
44
NO.
37- 14
37- 3
37- 4
37- 3
37- 4
37- 7
37- 6
37- 13
37- 12
37- 5
AL
AW
AW
AW
AW
BE
AL
AA
AA
AM
373737214211137373737373737373737373737373737224133723222-
9
2
11
39
58
41
15
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
27
19
18
2
40
25
27
41
AC
AD
AB
AB
AD
AC
AB
AX
AW
AW
AL
AL
AL
AL
AQ
AZ
AP
AN
AU
AZ
AP
AN
AU
AR
AA
AG
AE
AD
AD
AC
AE
22- 32
37- 2
37- 2
AT
AD
AA
D
D
D
2728131617192328345671313139-
9
12
14
30
19
19
14
13
9
23
15
43
32
3
11
3
4
AG
AK
AF
AF
AF
AF
AF
AF
AF
AF
AF
AF
AF
BA
BA
BA
CB
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
E
2714582920211329211412212510-
32
27
12
32
2
35
4
6
5
24
42
14
17
15
27
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AB
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
C
C
C
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
C
C
C
D
D
C
C
D
PARTS CODE
XBPSD30P08KS0
"
"
"
"
"
XBPSD30P08X00
XBPSD30P14KS0
"
XBPSD30P30KS0
XBPSD40P06K00
XBPSD40P08K00
XBPSD40P08KS0
"
XBPSD40P16KS0
XBPSN30P08KS0
"
XBPSN40P06K00
XEBSD20P06000
XEBSD26P05000
XEBSD30P06000
"
XEBSD30P08000
"
"
"
"
"
"
XEBSD30P10000
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
XEBSD40P10000
"
"
XEBSD40P30000
"
"
"
XEBSE30P06000
XEBSE30P08000
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
XEBSE30P10000
"
XEBSE30P12000
"
XEBSE40P10000
"
"
"
"
"
XEBSE40P12000
"
"
"
"
"
"
XEBSE40P14000
XEPSD23P12000
XEPSD30P06000
XEPSD30P06X00
"
XEPSD30P08X00
"
"
XEPSD30P14X00
NO.
14172930313413232430122515321223243026211423202122262734351414161718202133410141730303035191819456789920222315172293291017303134354714111920344814-
41
29
19
42
14
20
12
5
10
39
9
1
24
24
19
4
14
1
34
48
54
15
29
12
1
17
4
9
3
57
6
1
16
27
41
37
4
11
5
53
31
10
12
33
14
22
21
3
18
33
13
28
4
10
16
2
33
2
7
22
8
7
18
22
2
51
1
34
2
24
15
2
33
64
12
8
40
3
29
14
2
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
PARTS CODE
XEPSD30P14X00
XEPSD40P06000
XHBS230P08000
XHBSD30P06000
XHBSD30P08000
"
"
XHBSD30P10000
"
XHBSD30P14000
XHBSD30P16000
XHBSD40P10000
XHBSE30P06000
"
XHBSE30P08000
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
XHBSE40P10000
"
"
"
XNESD30-24000
XPSSJ20-07000
"
XPSSJ30-12000
XPSSP20-07000
XPSSP20-09000
"
XRESP20-04000
XRESP30-06000
"
"
XRESP40-05000
XRESP40-06000
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
XRESP50-06000
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
XRESP60-08000
XRESP70-08000
"
"
"
XUBUZ30P08000
XWHSD30-05070
XWHSD40-08100
"
XWSSD40-10000
XWVSD40-05000
"
45
NO.
311221327272818418182810301012229293045781022628131820126785182127121016182026272835812141626283556781412152532212713303047-
1
16
29
10
1
31
27
24
8
26
25
1
28
4
2
36
3
14
17
9
3
2
11
22
15
35
29
28
2
13
6
26
11
24
16
17
11
30
11
5
18
25
3
12
22
12
24
8
8
21
18
27
11
26
9
27
9
23
20
44
32
16
8
16
29
33
40
35
36
12
35
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AB
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
VARNING
Explosionsfara vid felaktigt batteribyte.
Anvnd samma batterityp eller en ekvivalent
typ som rekommenderas av apparattillverkaren.
Kassera anvnt batteri enligt fabrikantens
instruktion.
(German)
Achtung
Explosionsgefahr bei Verwendung inkorrekter Batterien.
Als Ersatzbatterien drfen nur Batterien vom gleichen Typ oder
vom Hersteller empfohlene Batterien verwendet werden.
Entsorgung der gebrauchten Batterien nur nach den vom
Hersteller angegebenen Anweisungen.
SHARP CORPORATION
Digital Document Systems Group
Products Quality Assurance Department
Yamatokoriyama, Nara 639-1186, Japan
2003 August Printed in Japan t